365
1. Cover document.xls Page 1 AVAYA™ IP Office Product Matrix Revised - June 1, 2011 IP Office Release7.0 Frank Ocasio Kirk Kirk, Peter Gavin ATAC - SMEC Pre-Sales Group Tab Contents: 1. COVER To the best of our knowledge, this document is based on the most current information available. Although every effort has been made to assure freedom from errors, Avaya Inc. is not responsible for the accuracy of all the information contained in this document. Please check at "support.avaya.com" for current IP Office documentation. 23. PARTNER® & IPO COMPARISON 2. FEATURE LIST 24. SYSTEM STATUS APPLICATION 3. IP500 CONTROL UNITS 25. TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 4. IPO CONTROL UNIT COMPARISON 26. UPS VA VALUES 5. EXPANSION MODULES 27. HANDSET CABLE LENGTHS 6. IPO SUPPORTED SETS 28. PROTOCOLS 7. Avaya one-X™ Mobile Client 29. BUTTON FEATURE LIST 8. IP OFFICE VIDEO SOFTPHONE 30. SET BUTTON DISPLAY STATUS 9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES 31. SHORT CODE FEATURES 10. DISCONTINUED MODELS 32. SHORT CODE EXAMPLES 11. IP Office LICENSE DESCRIPTIONS 33. SHORT CODE DEFAULTS 12. APPLICATION PC REQUIREMENTS 34. TAPI FUNCTIONS SUPPORTED 13. SERVER OS SUPPORT 35. IP OFFICE POWER DEMO KITS 14. IPO SOFTWARE COMPATIBILITY 36. MERGEABLE LIST 15. VOICEMAIL FEATURE COMPARISON 37. IP OFFICE PORTS 16. VOICEMAIL PROMPTS 38. LOCALE CODES 17. VOICEMAIL PRO ACTIONS 39. RELEASE HISTORY 18. ONE-X PORTAL FOR IP OFFICE 40. TRAINING 19. USER CALL CONTROL COMPARE 41. IP HARDPHONE POWER OPTIONS 20. CUSTOMER CALL REPORTER 42. 7.0 CD's & SOFTWARE BUILDS 21. IP OFFICE PARTNER® Version 43. IP OFFICE DevConnect APPLICATIONS 22. PARTNER® Version Sets 44. AVAYA Useful Links

[XLS] · Web viewIP Security Document Roadmap. L2TP ... Annex B, Annex AB – CS-ACELP. • Silence Suppression ... • hold the conference while others keep talking

Embed Size (px)

Citation preview

1. Cover

document.xls Page 1

AVAYA™ IP Office Product Matrix Revised - June 1, 2011IP Office Release7.0

Frank Ocasio Kirk Kirk, Peter GavinATAC - SMEC Pre-Sales Group

Tab Contents:• 1. COVER

To the best of our knowledge, this document is based on the most current information available. Although every effort has been made to assure freedom from errors, Avaya Inc. is not responsible for the accuracy of all the information contained in this document. Please check at "support.avaya.com" for current IP Office documentation.

• 23. PARTNER® & IPO COMPARISON• 2. FEATURE LIST • 24. SYSTEM STATUS APPLICATION• 3. IP500 CONTROL UNITS • 25. TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS• 4. IPO CONTROL UNIT COMPARISON • 26. UPS VA VALUES • 5. EXPANSION MODULES • 27. HANDSET CABLE LENGTHS• 6. IPO SUPPORTED SETS • 28. PROTOCOLS• 7. Avaya one-X™ Mobile Client • 29. BUTTON FEATURE LIST• 8. IP OFFICE VIDEO SOFTPHONE • 30. SET BUTTON DISPLAY STATUS• 9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES • 31. SHORT CODE FEATURES• 10. DISCONTINUED MODELS • 32. SHORT CODE EXAMPLES• 11. IP Office LICENSE DESCRIPTIONS • 33. SHORT CODE DEFAULTS• 12. APPLICATION PC REQUIREMENTS • 34. TAPI FUNCTIONS SUPPORTED• 13. SERVER OS SUPPORT • 35. IP OFFICE POWER DEMO KITS• 14. IPO SOFTWARE COMPATIBILITY • 36. MERGEABLE LIST• 15. VOICEMAIL FEATURE COMPARISON • 37. IP OFFICE PORTS• 16. VOICEMAIL PROMPTS • 38. LOCALE CODES• 17. VOICEMAIL PRO ACTIONS • 39. RELEASE HISTORY• 18. ONE-X PORTAL FOR IP OFFICE • 40. TRAINING• 19. USER CALL CONTROL COMPARE • 41. IP HARDPHONE POWER OPTIONS• 20. CUSTOMER CALL REPORTER • 42. 7.0 CD's & SOFTWARE BUILDS• 21. IP OFFICE PARTNER® Version • 43. IP OFFICE DevConnect APPLICATIONS• 22. PARTNER® Version Sets • 44. AVAYA Useful Links

1. Cover

document.xls Page 2

Avaya and the Avaya Logo are trademarks of Avaya Inc. and may be registered in certain jurisdictions. All other trademarks identified by ® and ™ are registered trademarks or trademarks, respectively, of Avaya Inc. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners.

2. FEATURE LIST

document.xls Page 3

IP Office 7.0 Feature List<---- Basic Call Handling

Tones

• Normal, alternate, and secondary; depending on geography• Busy• Unobtainable• Re-order• Conferencing tone depending on geography

Caller ID• Display of the caller’s number on incoming calls, where supplied by the service provider.• Sending of calling number on outgoing external calls.Benefit• Confirmation and recognition of who is calling.• Storage of Caller ID numbers for return calls.• Directory name matching to Caller ID numbers.• Screen-Popping customer records in compatible applications.

Hold

Toggle Calls

Hold Call Waiting

Hold Music (Music on Hold)

IP Office generates the correct user tones for the geography. These tones are generated for all IP Office extension types, analog, digital and IP.

• A call may be placed on hold with optional Hold music. A held call cannot be forgotten as it is presented back to the extension after a timeout set by the system's administrator. See also Park .

• Toggle Calls cycles round each call that the user has On Hold to their extension locally within the system, presenting them one at a time to the user

• Hold Call Waiting is a compound feature combining hold and answer and provides a convenient way to hold an existing call and answer a waiting call through a single button press.

• The IP Office system supports up to 4 sources of music on hold - one system source which may be external, internal (WAV) or tone, plus up to 3 additional internal sources. The internal sources are .WAV files saved either in volatile memory, or on the optional memory card in an IP500 and IP406 V2. The .WAV file must be 16bit PCM mono and sampled at 8Khz with a maximum duration of 30 seconds.

• Alternate sources for music on hold are selectable for use by Incoming Call Routes or Hunt Groups. On IP500 systems, each source can be up to 90 seconds long (30 seconds on IP406 V2 and IP412).

• External music on hold sources connect to the 3.5mm Audio socket on all IP Office control units.

2. FEATURE LIST

document.xls Page 4

Park

Automatic CallbackFeature

Benefit

Direct Inward Dialing (DID/DDI)

• In North America, T1 circuits are required for DID.

Transfer

• As an alternative to placing a call on hold, a call can be parked on the system to be picked by another user.

The call park facility is available through the user's telephone, one-X Portal for IP Office, Phone Manager or SoftConsole. Calls are Parked against a ‘park slot number’ which can be announced over a paging system so the person the call is for can go to any phone and collect the call by dialling the park slot number.

For convenience Phone Manager has 4 pre-defined park buttons. On digital phones with DSS/BLF keys it is possible to program Park keys that will indicate when there is a call in a particular park slot and allow calls to be parked or retrieved.

There is a system configurable timeout that determines how long a call may remain parked before it is represented to the extension that originally parked the call.

• When calling an extension that is busy, set the system to call you when the extension becomes free. This feature is also called "Ringback When Free".

• When calling an extension that just rings, set the system to call you when the extension is next used. This feature is also called "Ringback When Next Used".

• Carry on with other work and let the system initiate a call for you when the extension becomes available.

• This relies on the local telephone exchange passing all or part of the dialed number to the IP Office. This number can then be used by IP Office call routing software to route the call to an individual phone, or groups of phones. This service is typically used to reduce the workload on a reception position by giving members of staff or departments individual numbers so they can be called directly. For convenience it is common to have the extension or group number the same as the digits supplied from the network, but IP Office can convert the number to what ever number is needed by the business, within limits

• Call Transfer allows users to transfer a call in progress to another phone number – either internal extension or external public number. The caller is placed on hold while the transfer is performed.

• If the phone is put down before the destination has answered, the original caller will be automatically transferred. This is called an Unsupervised or Blind Transfer. Alternatively, a user can wait for the destination to be answered and announce the transfer before hanging up to complete the transfer. This is called a Supervised Transfer.

2. FEATURE LIST

document.xls Page 5

Distinctive and Personalized Ringing

• Internal Call: Repeated single-ring.• External Call: Repeated double-ring.• Ringback Call: Single ring followed by two short rings.

Personalized Ringing

Message Waiting Indication

• Unless restricted by the system administrator, the IP Office makes no differentiation between internal or external call transfers.

• The IP Office uses different ringing sequences to indicate the type of call, for example whether internal or external. This feature is called 'distinctive ringing'. For analog phones the distinctive ringing sequences used are adjustable. For digital and IP phones the distinctive ringing sequences are fixed as follows;

• This ring is used for calls returning from park, hold or transfer. It is also used for call back when free and voicemail ringback calls.

• This feature is supported across the IP Office Small Community Network .

• In IP Office the term personalized ringing is used to refer to changing the sound or tone of a phone's ring. On many Avaya digital phones, the ringer sound can be personalized. Changing the ringer sound does not alter the ring sequence used for distinctive ringing. This feature is local to the telephone and not supported on all types of telephones.

• Message waiting indication (MWI) is a method IP Office uses to set a lamp or other indication on compatible telephones when a new message has been left for the user, either in a personal voice mailbox or in a group mailbox or call back message. When the message has been played or acknowledged, the lamp is turned off.

• All Avaya digital and IP phones have in-built message waiting lamps. one-X Portal for IP Office and Phone Manager also provide message waiting indication on screen• For analog phones, from IP Office 3.1 a variety of analog message waiting indication (MWI) methods are provided. Those methods are 51V Stepped, 81V, 101V and Line Reversal. The MWI method must be selected from the IP Office Manager when configuring a system to match the properties of the analog phones. Note that the 101V signaling is only available on IP500 Phone cards and expansion modules plus version 2 IP400 Phone8, 16 and 30 expansion modules, not on the IP406 V2 control unit.

2. FEATURE LIST

document.xls Page 6

Visual VoiceFeature

Benefit• Quick access to voicemails and commonly used messaging features.

Features supported are:• access new/old/saved messages for personal and hunt group mailboxes.• next and previous message.• fast forward and rewind.• pause message.• save, delete and copy message to other users of the system.• change default greeting.• change password.• change email settings (Preferred Edition only).

<---- Advanced Call HandlingAbsence Text

Feature• Display a text message on the user's phone and IP Office Phone Manager application.

Benefit• Inform other internal users of your current status and likely availability.

• There are 10 predefined strings for Absence Text:

• None (no text message) • "Don't disturb until"• "On vacation until" • "With visitors until"• "Will be back" • "With cust. til"• "At lunch until" • "Back soon"• "Meeting until" • "Back tomorrow"• "Please call • Custom

• Provides interface to voicemail through handset display and buttons e.g. Listen, Save, Delete, Fast Forward.

• You can access and control voice messages via the display on Digital or IP telephones. Visual Voice requires Preferred Edition or Essential Edition, and can only be used with large display LCD sets only from the 1400, 1600, 2400, 5400, 4600, 5600, 9500, 9600 and T3 series. (1403, 1603, 1603SW, 2402, 5402, 4601, 4602SW, 5601, 5602SW do not support Visual Voice). On telephones that have a display but do not support visual voice operation, use of the button for user mailbox access using voice prompts and for direct to voicemail transfer during a call is supported (does not include T3 and T3 IP telephones.

• The fixed message button on certain phones can be configured to invoke visual voice (this is the default setting for new configurations). This configurable option frees the button programming required currently for Visual Voice.

• Display the same message on other internal phones and IP Office applications when calling the user.

2. FEATURE LIST

document.xls Page 7

• This feature is supported across the IP Office Small Community Network (SCN).

Call TaggingFeature

Benefit• Provide additional information about the call.

Reclaim CallFeature

Benefit

Hunt Group Enable/DisableFeature• The ability for a user to enable or suspend their membership of hunt groups.Benefit

Call Waiting

Do Not Disturb (DND)

• All may have additional text entered, eg message 4 plus 10:00 will show "Meeting until 10:00" and the text strings are localized to the system language

• Display a text message on the user's phone, one-X Portal for IP Office or Phone Manager, when a call is presented to it.

• The ability to recover, or reclaim, the last call that was at your phone but is now ringing or is connected elsewhere.

• If you just miss a call and it goes to voicemail or call coverage, you can get the call back while it is still being presented or connected through IP Office

• A user may need to temporarily join or leave individual hunt groups, for example to cover a peak of calls without changing the system programming.

A User may not want people calling them to receive busy tone if they are already on another call, but have the call receive ring tone and have some kind of alert that there is a call waiting. The user can then decide to finish or hold the current call and answer the one that is waiting. The amount of information that is available about the call that is waiting depends on the type of phone the user has, or if they are using one-X Portal for IP Office or Phone Manager.

As Call waiting tone can be disruptive it is possible to turn the feature on or off and even suspend it for a single call – useful for conference calls.

This is the ability to temporarily stop incoming calls ringing at a user's telephone. It will prevent the user from receiving hunt group calls and give direct callers either voicemail (if enabled) or a busy signal. This feature can be enabled/disabled from the phone or via one-X Portal for IP Office or Phone Manager.

It is possible to have some calls bypass the DND setting and ring the phone. For example a manager might have their secretary’s extension number on the DND exceptions list. The exceptions list can be easily managed by the one-X Portal for IP Office or Phone Manager. Both internal and external numbers can be on the exception list.

2. FEATURE LIST

document.xls Page 8

Dial Plan

Paging

This feature is supported across the IP Office Small Community Network

Intrude

Inclusion

Private Call

IP Office has a very flexible numbering scheme for extensions, hunt groups and feature commands. While the system has default numbering for feature codes and extensions, they can all be re-defined. Default extensions and hunt groups have 3 digit numbers starting at 200 but these can be changed from 2 to 9 digits through the IP Office Manager. There is a default set of feature access "short codes," but these can be changed to what ever the end user requires, within limits. This is useful for example, if IP Office is replacing a system where DND was accessed by dialing *21, it is possible to change the IP Office Short Code to mimic the code of the replaced system.

In certain countries IP Office can support a Secondary Dial Tone when an access digit is dialed, though this limits some functionality like Alternate Route Selection (ARS). IP Office can also be configured to work without line access digits, by analyzing digits as they are dialed and determining if they are for an internal number or should be sent out on a line – this is valuable in SOHO installations where users will not necessarily be used to dialing an access digit for an outside line.

All Avaya digital and IP phones supported on the IP Office that have loudspeakers can be used to receive broadcast audio messages without having to install a separate paging system. Paging can be to individual phones or groups of phones.

Analog extension ports can be configured for connection to external overhead paging systems, usually through an adapter, such that a port can be included in a paging group to permit mixed phone and overhead paging.

Some Avaya digital and IP phones are able to answer a page by pressing a key while the page is going on, this terminates the page and turns it into a normal call.

The Call Intrude feature allows a user, if permission through IP Office Manager is given, to join an existing conversation whether this is an internal or external call.

A user with the "Can Intrude" option can join a call on any extension on the system, however, a User with "Cannot be Intruded" setting would prevent others from joining their call.

This feature enables selected users to intrude on calls that are already in progress. The intruding party intrudes on the existing call and all parties hear a tone. The speech path is enabled between the intruding party and the called user, the other party is forced onto hold and will not hear the conversation. On completion of the intrusion the called party speech path is reconnected to the original connected party. The feature is enabled or disabled on a per user basis through the Manager.

2. FEATURE LIST

document.xls Page 9

Hot Desking

Remote Hot DeskingFeature

• The ability for a user to Hot Desk to other locations within the Small Community Network.

• Available on Digital, Analog and IP phones.Benefit

• A user can make and receive calls from any office as if using the phone on their own desk.

• Single number, improved mobility and easy access to familiar features.

• Great for consultants, managers, lawyers working on different offices on different days.

Description

• User Settings

• The user’s incoming calls are rerouted across the SCN.• The user’s outgoing calls use the settings of the remote IP Office.

• Break Out Dialing

Users can set a status of private call using short codes or a programmed button. Private calls cannot be recorded, intruded on, bridged into or monitored.

Hot Desking allows a number of users non-exclusive use the same extension. Each user logs in with their own identity so they can receive calls and can access their own Voicemail and other facilities. For example, sales personnel who visit the office infrequently can be provided with telephony and Voicemail services without being permanently assigned a physical extension. When finished, they simply log out to make the extension available to others or if users log in at another phone, they are automatically logged out of the original extension.

• The user has access to the centralized system and personal directory as well as their call log (1400, 1600, 9600 Series and T3 phones only).

IP Office supports remote hot desking between IP Office systems within a Small Community Network (SCN). The system on which the user configured is termed their 'home' IP Office, all other systems are 'remote' IP Offices. No additional licenses are required to support Remote Hot Desking other than the Voice Networking license on each IP500 within the SCN.

When a user logs in to a remote IP Office system, all their user settings are transferred to that system.

• However some settings may become unusable or may operate differently. For example if the user uses a time profile for some features, those feature will only work if a time profile of the same name also exists on the remote IP Office.

In some scenarios a hot desking user logged in at a remote system will want to dial a number using the system short codes of another system. This can be done using either short codes with the Break Out feature or a programmable button set to Break Out. This feature can be used by any user within the Small Community Network but is of significant use to remote hot deskers.

Note: Remote Hot Desking is not supported for use with Customer Contact Center (CCC) or Customer Call Reporter (CCR). Features handled by the telephone itself are not affected by Hot Desking (e.g. call log and phone speed dials).

2. FEATURE LIST

document.xls Page 10

Relay On/Off/Pulse

Pickup

• Pick up any call ringing on another extension.

• Pick up a ringing call at a specified extension.

This feature is supported across the IP Office Small Community Network (SCN).

Call Recording

Note: for IP phones, a VCM channel will be required for the duration of the recording.

Telecommuter Mode

IP Office is fitted with two independent switch outputs for controlling external equipment such as door entry systems. Control of these switches is via allotted handsets allowing the switches to be opened, closed or pulsed as required. Control of switches is also accessible via Phone Manager Pro, SoftConsole and VoiceMail Pro.

Call Pickup allows a user to answer a call presented to another extension. Types of call pickup include:

• Pick up a hunt group call ringing on another extension, where the user must be a member of that hunt group.

• Pick up any call ringing on another extension that is a member of the hunt group specified.

Where IP Office has VoiceMail Pro installed it is possible to record a call and save the recording to the user’s mailbox, a group mailbox or the voice recording library. For example, this is useful when a caller is going to give detailed information like an address or phone number and the caller will hear a warning message or tone that the call is being recorded in some countries. Where call recording is required for Quality Assurance, it is possible to set the IP Office system to automatically record a percentage of calls for later review.

Beginning with IP Office R4.0, any call (normal, conference, or intrusion) and any phone type (including IP) can be recorded. Where "advice of recording" needs to be played, IP Office will ignore Voicemail port licensing if an insufficient number of voicemail channels have been licensed.

Avaya one-X™ Portal for IP Office for IP Office allows the making and receiving of calls and the retrieving of voicemails from an external phone number as if they were in the office, with one-X Portal for IP Office server providing the call control. The typical scenario is the remote worker that occasionally works from home or from a hotel room.

This feature also provides billing convenience and potential cost savings for remote workers and mobile work force as all the calls are established by IP Office: there is no need to check bills, nor to pay for expensive hotel calls.

2. FEATURE LIST

document.xls Page 11

Twinning and Mobility

Internal Twinning

The following features are supported with internal twinning• Follow Me To• Follow Me Here• Forwarding• Do Not Disturb (inc exceptions)

• Voicemail On / Off / Access• Call Log (Central Call Log for T3 and 1600 phones only)• Redial (Central Call Log for T3 and 1600 phones only)• Personal Directory Entries (for T3 and 1600 phones only)

Mobility Features include:• Mobile (external) Twinning• Mobile Call Control• Mobility Callback• Avaya one-X Mobile Client Support

<---- Key and Lamp Operation

This is typically used in scenarios like workshops or warehouses where team supervisors may have a desk with a fixed phone but also have a wireless extension (e.g. DECT). When a call is made from either twinned phone, the call will appear to have come from the primary phone (when the secondary is an extension on the IP Office system). Other users of the system need not know that the supervisor has two different phones. The supervisor’s Coverage Timer and No Answer Time are started for the call and if the call is not answered within that time, the call will be delivered to available coverage buttons (if applicable) and then Voicemail (if applicable).

• Context less hunt group actions: Membership / Service Status / Fallback Group configuration

2. FEATURE LIST

document.xls Page 12

<---- Outbound Call Handling Features

2. FEATURE LIST

document.xls Page 13

<---- Forwarding<---- Avaya Digital and IP Phones

2. FEATURE LIST

document.xls Page 14

<---- Inbound Call Handling

2. FEATURE LIST

document.xls Page 15

<---- Contact Center Features<---- Miscellaneous Features

Conference Calls

Only two calls connecting through analog trunks are permitted in any single conference.

Dial On Pickup

Off Hook Operation

E911

Calls can be placed on hold and a conference created using either the phone or desktop applications. Additional conference members may be added, however a single conference may not have more than 64 members.

For the IP500 and IP500 V2 the total conferencing capacity is 128 channels. This could be alternatively 2 conference of 64 users, 3 conferences of 42 users or any other combination (maximum 64 participants per conference call).

Also known as "Hotline". Automatically dials a specified extension when the phone is taken off hook. This facility is commonly used in unmanned reception areas or for door entry systems to allow visitors to easily gain assistance.

Off-Hook Station is designed for users who want their analog phone to operate like digital or IP feature phone, to isolate the user’s phone idle state from the Hook state. This is a useful feature when using one-X Portal for IP Office, Phone Manager or SoftConsole to control the phone state when using a headset on an analog telephone and with call control and dialing from one-X Portal for IP Office, Phone Manager or SoftConsole.

This is a specific service for North America. When an emergency call is connected, IP Office provides calling party information to an external line interface unit. The external unit carries out a number to text translation and forwards this to the emergency services bureau so that the originating location of the call is clearly identified.

3. IP500 Control Units

document.xls Page 16

IP Office IP 500 Control Units

<--- IP Office IP500/IP 500V2 Control Unit

• Digital Station 8 card

• Phone 2 and Phone 8 cards• VCM-32 and VCM-64 cards• 4-Port Expansion card.

IP500 and IP500 V2 Front View

• Optional trunk daughter card support:• Analog Trunk Module 4 card

• Single and Dual Universal PRI cards

• Memory/Feature Key card support:

IP500 Back View

• 9-pin DTE Port for maintenance.• Support for up to 12 IP500 Expansion Modules:

• Phone modules (16, 30)

• Analog Trunk Module 16• BRI So8 module

• Audio input port for external music on hold source.• 48 Data channels• Up to 40 VoiceMail Pro ports IP500 V2 Back View• Two 10/100 switched Ethernet ports (Layer 3).

The IP500 V2 control unit is compatible with all IP500 base extension and Voice Compression Modules (VCM) cards as well as all external IP500 expansion modules.The IP500 and IP500 V2 are stackable units with an optional 19" rack mounting kit and an optional wall mounting kit for smaller configurations. They provide:

• 4 slots to house a mixture of extension cards and VCM cards

• TCM8 Station card supporting select Nortel digital telephones (IP500 V2 control unit only)

• ETR 6 port phone card. (IP500 V2 only, North America only)• Combination Card with 10 VCM channels, 4 analog trunks, 6 Digital Station (DS) and 2 Phone ports. (IP500 V2 only)• Combination Card with 10 VCM channels, 2 BRI trunk interfaces (4 channels), 6 Digital Station (DS) and 2 Phone ports. (IP500 V2 only)

• IP500 Legacy Card Carrier: this card allows up to two IP400 Trunk or VCM Cards to be used with the IP500 control unit (1 Daugther card per Carrier)

• BRI-4 and BRI-8 cards (2 x 2B+D and 4 x 2B+D channels respectively)

• Support for IP400 trunk and VCM cards using a Legacy Card Carrier

• IP500: Slot for smart card Feature Key – required for system operation as well as licensing of optional features.• IP 500: Slot for Compact Flash card – used for embedded messaging as part of Essential Edition.• IP500 V2 : 2 Slots for SD cards (System and optional) – System SD card is required for system operation as well as licensing of optional features and storage for embedded voicemail in Essential Edition.

• Digital Station modules (16, 30) supporting IP Office telephones with RJ45 connector• Digital Station modules (16A, 30A) supporting Nortel telephones with RJ21 connector (IP500 V2control unit only)

• IP400 expansion modules (not WAN3 10/100 or Network Alchemy modules)

• External O/P socket supporting two relay on/off switch ports, e.g. for door entry systems.

3. IP500 Control Units

document.xls Page 17

<--- IP Office 500 Base Cards

3. IP500 Control Units

document.xls Page 18

<--- IP Office 500 Trunk Cards

4. IPO Control Unit Comparison

document.xls Page 19

The following table summarizes the capacities of the IP Office control units supported by IP Office R7 software.

IP500 IP500 Control Unit Digital Station Ports Up to 24 Up to 24 Up to 30 Up to 24 Up to 30Control Unit Analog Phone Ports Up to 32 Up to 32 Up to 32 Up to 24 Up to 26Control Unit ETR Phone Ports - - - - 18Embedded Voicemail Card Slot √ √ √ √ √Integral WAN Port X X X X X

12 12 12 12 1

Audio In (MOH) Port √ √ √ √ √√ √ √ √ √

Conference PartiesConfiguration Memory 1024KB 1024KB 2048KB 2048KB 2048KBVoicemail Pro/TAPI WAV Channels -

48264 384 264 384 46

Analog Phones only. 272 384 272 384 42ETR Phones only. - - - - 18IP Phones only. 384 384 -

-Analog trunk cards √ √ √ √ -Quad BRI trunk cards √ √ √ √ -Single PRI trunk cards √ √ √ √Dual PRI trunks cards √ √ √ √ -

IP500 Analog trunksIP500 BRI trunk channels -IP500 PRI trunk channels

-

138 20

* Note:

FeatureIP500 (4) IP500 V2

Plus 4 Port Exp Card

Plus 4 Port Exp Card

PARTNER® Version

External Expansion Ports DTE Port 9-way 9-way 9-way 9-way 9-way

External O/P Switch Port 128 (3) 128 (3) 128 (3) 128 (3) 128 (3)

40 (1) 40 (1) 40 (1) 40 (1)

Maximum Extension Capacity 384 (2) 384 (2) 384 (2) 384 (2)

Digital Phones only.

384 (2) 384 (2)

IP400 Trunk Cards Supported 2 2 2 2

√ (6)

IP500 Daughter Trunk Cards 4 4 4 4 4 √ 16 √ 12 √ 16 √ 12 √ 12√ 32 √ 24 √ 32 √ 24√ 240 √ 180 √ 240 √ 180 √ 24

VCM Cards - IP400 VCM Cards 2 2 2 2 - IP500 VCM Cards 2 2 2 2 2 (7)

Maximum voice compression channels 128 128 148 (5)

Dimensions Height x Width x Depth 73x445x365mm

2.9"x17.5"x14.4" 73x445x365mm 2.9"x17.5"x14.4"

73x445x365mm 2.9"x17.5"x14.4"

73x445x365mm 2.9"x17.5"x14.4"

73x445x365mm 2.9"x17.5"x14.4"

1. IP500 VoiceMail Pro/TAPI WAV channels increased from 30 to 40 for IP Office R5 and 2. IP500 Maximum extensions increased from 272 to 384 for IP Office R5 and higher.3. IP500 Conference capacity increased from 64 to 128 for IP Office R5 and higher.4. For IP Office R5 and higher, the IP500 no longer runs in separate Standard or 5. For IP Office R4.0 to R5.0 128 VCM channels maximum. For IP Office R6 or higher 148 6. Only ONE (1) T1/PRI supported on the IP Office Essential Partner Edition.7. IP500v2 in Partner Version mode only supports VCM channels provided by fitting IP500

5. EXPANSION MODULES

document.xls Page 20

IP500 Modules Still Sold

FRONT PORTSDigital Station Ports 0 0 DS16 V2 or 30 V2 0 DS16A or DS30AAnalog Station Ports 0 Phone 8, 16 or 30 V2 0 0 0Analog Trunks 0 0 0 0Euro ISDN BRI "S" Ports 0 0 0 8 0

REAR PORTS

DTE Port IP400 V2 25-Way D-Type socket 9-Way D-Type socket 9-Way D-Type socket 1 - DB25 NADTE Port IP500V1 & V2 25-Way D-Type socket 9-Way D-Type socket 9-Way D-Type socket 1 - DB25 9-Way D-Type socketPower Fail Over Pots 2 0 0 0 0Wan Ports 0 0 0 0 0Expansion Ports 1 1 1 1 1

Stations Supported

Terminals N/A N/A

Manufacture DiscontinuedThe following equipment is no longer sold by Avaya but

is still supported by IP Office Release 7.

IP400 Analog Trunk 16 Module

IP400 Phone V2 Modules 8,10 & 11

IP400 Digital Station V2 Modules

9,14IP400 So8 Module

12,16

IP500 Analog Trunk 16 Module 13,14

IP500 Phone V2 Modules 8,10,11, 14 & 15

IP500 Digital Station V2 Modules

9,14

IP500 BRI So8 Module 12,14

IP500 Digital Station A Modules

16 Loop Start or Ground Start

Rear View IP400

Rear View IP500

NA

6211, 6219, 622110

1403, 1408, 1416, DBM3218, 2402, 2410, 2420, 4406D+, 4412D+1, 4424D+2, 4450DSS3&4, 5402, 5410, 5420 ,EU243&5, 6408D+, 6416D+, 6416D+M, 6424D+M & XM243&6, 3810, T3 Compact, Classic, Comfort, T3 DSS

M-Series and T-Series digital stations

4100 and 7400 Series with Digital Mobility

Solution (DMS)19

5. EXPANSION MODULES

document.xls Page 21

Included with ModulePower Supply Unit YES YES YES YES YES

NO NO NO NO NO

YES YES YES YES YES

Maximum Expansion Modules per IP-Office SystemsIP Office 500, IP500V2IP Office 403 3 3 3 3 0IP Office 406 6 6 6 6 0

IP Office 412 12 12 0

Rack Size 19" 19" 19" 19" 19"Space on Rack 2U 2U 2U 2U 2U

Power Lead - As of July 1, 2002, the power cord must be ordered separately. The base units and all other module prices have been reduced accordingly.

Interconnect cable (Blue, for linking back to base unit)

12 17 12 17 12 17 12 17 12 17

Any combination of 8,16 or 30 port modules not to exceed 360 ports

Any combination of 16 or 30 port modules not to exceed 360 ports

Rack Mounting 7

5. EXPANSION MODULES

document.xls Page 22

Notes

3. DSS4450, XM24 and EU24 requires external power supply to the Telephone set it's attached to.

5. IP Office supports a maximum of eight EU24/EU24 BL's on each IP Office system.

9. DS (V2) Modules are supported by IP Office Software Release 2.1(31), 3.0 and 3.0(DT) and above.

13. IP500 ATM16 only supported in North America utilizing the older V1 un-earth power lead (2 Pin).14. Use on the IP Office 500 control unit requires the unit to be configured with an IP500 Upgrade Standard to Professional license.

15. The IP500 Phone 8 Module is not available. Should use the IP500 Phone 8 base card instead.16. The IP400 So8 Module and the IP500 So8 module have been discontinued.

18. Up to 3 units can be connected in a chain from a single 1416 and you will need a 1151C power supply.19. See Tab 6 for a list of all the Nortel sets currenly supported on these expansion modules.

1. A maximum of twenty-seven 4412D+ telephones are supported on the DS30 (version 2) expansion module at PCS level 5. Earlier DS30 expansion modules will only support sixteen of these telephones.2. A maximum of twenty-four 4424D+ telephones are supported on the DS30 (version 2) expansion module at PCS level 5. Earlier DS30 expansion modules will only support sixteen of these telephones.

4. IP Office supports a maximum two 4450 units on each Digital Station expansion module, including the 406 V2 control unit, Maximum 10 4450 units per system

6. IP Office supports a maximum two XM24 units on each Digital Station expansion module, including the 406 V2 control unit. Maximum 10 XM24 units per system7. The IP Office control units and expansion modules are designed to be stacked free-standing. However they can also be rack mounted using optional rack mounting kits. The Small Office Edition cannot be rack mounted but can be wall mounted if required. The IP500 expansion modules use IP500 Rack Kits.8. Phone (V2) Modules are supported by IP Office Software Release 3.0(44) onwards and also by the August 2005 Administration Maintenance Release Software R2.1(44).

10. Avaya would like to stress that although most analog phones will work on IP Office - Avaya cannot guarantee thatall analog phones in every region of the world will work on the IP Office.11. IP Office Phone Modules provide support for a variety of analog MWI methods. These methods are 51V Stepped, 81V, 101V and Line Reversal. The 101V method is only supported when using a Phone V2 expansion module. 12. The IP Office So8 expansion module supports both point-to-point and point-to-multipoint connections. A maximum of 10 terminal endpoints identifiers (TEIs) are supported on each bus.

17. The IP500 and IP500V2 can reach 12 expansion modules by using the new IP500 4-Port Expansion Card in the base unit. The 4-Port Expansion Card comes with 4 Yellow cables. The new DS16A/DS30A only work on IP500V2 with IP Office Software Release 7.0(5).

6. IPO SUPPORTED SETS

document.xls Page 23

IP OFFICE SUPPORTED TERMINALSIP Office 14XX; 16XX and 16XX-I series Telephones<--- 1403 DS Hardphone;1603/1603-I & 1603SW/1603SW-I IP Hardphone -

6. IPO SUPPORTED SETS

document.xls Page 24

<--- 1408 Digital; 1608/1608-I IP Hardphone -

6. IPO SUPPORTED SETS

document.xls Page 25

<--- 1416 Digital; 1616/1616-I IP Hardphone -

<--- New Feature Set for Regional EMEA Markets (supported on 1600 series sets only) <--- DBM32 1 (DS) Button mdule; BM32 1 (IP) Button module -

6. IPO SUPPORTED SETS

document.xls Page 26

<--- 9608, 9621G & 9641G IP Hardphone IP Office 96XX series Telephones - IP500 and IP500V2 Only

6. IPO SUPPORTED SETS

document.xls Page 27

<--- 9620L & 9620C IP Hardphone <--- 9630, 9640, 9640G IP Hardphone <--- 9650 & 9650C IP Hardphone

6. IPO SUPPORTED SETS

document.xls Page 28

<--- 9600 Gigabit Ethernet Adapter (all phone except 9620L)<--- 9600 Bluetooth Adapter (all phones expept 9620L)

<--- SBM24 1 (9630G/9640/9650/9650C only) & BM12 1 (9508, 9608 and 9641G only)

6. IPO SUPPORTED SETS

document.xls Page 29

10XX, 11xx, 12xx and Expansion Modules SIP Series Telephones<--- 1010, 1040 Telephones

6. IPO SUPPORTED SETS

document.xls Page 30

<--- 1120, 1140 SIP Telephones

6. IPO SUPPORTED SETS

document.xls Page 31

<--- 1220, 1230 SIP Telephones<--- 11XX & 112XX Expansion Modules

6. IPO SUPPORTED SETS

document.xls Page 32

95xx Digital Phone Series Telephones<--- 9504, 9508 Telephones

<--- System Button Module Support1 System Button Module Support

6. IPO SUPPORTED SETS

document.xls Page 33

IP Wireless Supported Worldwide Terminals:<--- 3641 Ruggedized Wireless Telephone<--- 3645 Ruggedized Wireless Telephone<--- 3720 DECT R4 Telephone

6. IPO SUPPORTED SETS

document.xls Page 34

<--- 3725 DECT R4 Telephone<--- 3740 Ruggedized DECT Telephone & 3749 Intrinsically Safe DECT R4 Telephone

6. IPO SUPPORTED SETS

document.xls Page 35

<--- 3720, 3725, 3740 & 3749 DECT R4 Telephone Feature Overview

6. IPO SUPPORTED SETS

document.xls Page 36

Norstar/BCM Telephones<--- Norstar/BCM M-Series & T-Series & IP Series

How do the sets work on the IPO - see this link:Nortel Heritage Digital telephones Nortel Heritage IP telephones: T7000 1120 IP phoneT7100 1140 IP phoneT7208 LCD KEM for 1100 telephonesT7316; T7316e 1220 IP phoneT24 KIM– Key Indicator Module 1230 IP phoneM7000 LCD KEM for 1200 telephonesM7100 LED KEM for 1200 telephonesM7208 M7310 M7324 CAP (48 buttons) – Central Answering PositionT7406, T7406E BXT cordless Telephone, North America

<--- Norstar/BCM Digital mobility components-Series

How do the sets work on the IPO - see this link:Digital Mobility 2.4 GHz solution - North America and CALA

Digital Mobility Base Station 10Digital Mobility Repeater 40

Digital Mobility External Antenna 51DMC 080DMC 320

Digital Mobility 1.9 GHz solution - North America (1929-1930 MHz)Digital Mobility Base Station 19 (NAR)

Digital Mobility Repeater 49 (Canada, US)Digital Mobility External Antenna 51

DMC 080DMC 320

Digital Mobility Base Station 15Digital Mobility Repeater 25Digital Mobility Repeater 45

Digital Mobility External Antenna 51DMC 081DMC 321

Digital Mobility 1.8 GHz solution - South America (1900-1930 MHz)Digital Mobility Base Station 14

Digital Mobility Repeater 24Digital Mobility External Antenna 51

DMC 081DMC 321

The following Norstar/BCM telephones are fully supported on IP Office R7 but might require special interface cards/modules. Not all of them are available for new sales and they are not available to all channels.

IP Office & BCM Phone Detailed Comparison

7420/7430/7440 Digital Mobility 7439/7449 Digital Mobility Handset, 4135/4145/4145EX Digital Mobility 4136/4146/4146EX Digital Mobility 7420/7430/7440 Digital Mobility

The following Norstar/BCM Digital mobility components are supported on IP Office R7 but might require special interface cards/modules. Not all of them are available for new sales and they are not available to all channels

IP Office & BCM Phone Detailed Comparison

(2.4GHz, Compatible with Handset 7430/7440, (2.4GHz, Compatible with Handset 7430/7440, Digital Mobility Controller - N.A.Digital Mobility Controller - N.A.

Digital Mobility Controller - N.A.Digital Mobility Controller - N.A.Digital Mobility 1.8 GHz solution - Europe, Hong Kong, Australia, New Zealand (1880-

1900MHz)

Digital Mobility Controller - InternationalDigital Mobility Controller - International

Digital Mobility Controller - InternationalDigital Mobility Controller - International

7. Avaya one-X™ Mobile Client

document.xls Page 37

Avaya one-X™ Mobile Client for Small Business

IP Office supports the Avaya one-X Mobile 'Single Mode' Clients running on selected Symbian Single-Mode orWindows Mobile 5 or 6.x handsets. This provides a graphical interface for call control and allows a one-numberservice for both incoming and outgoing calls.

For a full list of supported handsets see http://support.avaya.com.

Mobile Call Control

• IP500 PRI-U (single or dual) daughter cards• IP500 Dual or Quad BRI daughter cards• SIP trunks (RFC 2833)

This feature requires one instance of the Mobile Worker or Power User License.

One-X Mobile Compatibilty ListIP Office systems supporting one-X Mobile require a dedicated DID/DDI number for each feature required (e.g. hold, transfer).

This allows a user who has answered a twinned call on their

Mobile Call Control is a mobility feature similar to but independent of one-X Mobile. It allows any mobile phone user to access IP Office features without using the one-X Mobile client application.

Mobile users can gain access to the “Star Star Service” dial tone when they receive a twinned call. After receiving a twinned call, the mobile user can dial ** to place that call on hold and get dial tone from the IP Office. Once the mobile user receives IP Office dial tone, any subsequent dialing done is interpreted as if the user is logged into an analog extension on the IP Office.

To gain access to the “Star Star Service” dial tone, the mobile user can dial the FNE 31 DID/DDI that has beenprogrammed in the IP Office. Similarly, once dial tone is heard, the user can dial numbers and short codes asif the user is logged into an analog extension on the IP Office.

Mobile Call Control and one-X Mobile require twinned calls to be routed through specific trunk types on IP500 & IP500v2 only:

7. Avaya one-X™ Mobile Client

document.xls Page 38

<--- FNE Supported Functionality

8. IP Office Video Softphone

document.xls Page 39

IP Office Video Softphone

New Features R7.0:With Release 7 a number of new features have been added to Video Softphone:

• Cannot set DND reasons• Agent can not be logged in using the CCR Control Panel

New Features R6.1:

With Release 6.0 IP Office introduces – as part of the Teleworker and Power User profiles – a new Softphone application.The IP Office Video Softphone is a full feature telephony client that supports standard telephony features on a PC running supported Microsoft operating systems including new Microsoft Windows 7.Support of several audio options including support of wireless headsets with full hook-switch support provides a flexible telephone option, especially for people on the move.IP Office Video Softphone forms part of the Teleworker and the Power user profiles. A Teleworker or Power User license for the user of the IP Office Video Softphone is required; however IP Office Video Softphone does not require any additional license, e.g. no (Avaya) IP-station license.

• The Avaya Video Softphone can now be used as an Agent extension for the Avaya Customer Call Reporter with the following limitations:

• Busy Lamp Field allowing to see telephone status of colleagues including pickup of alerting calls• HD Video support, delivering high quality Video conferences between Softphone users as well as with other supported Video endpoints.

BLF with Pickup feature – The Speed Dial feature allows the user to configureextension numbers onto the speed dial buttons. If these entries match Usersin the IP Office configuration the button will display Busy/Idle indication onthat button. The button when selected can be used to call the programmeddestination. The same BLF button can be used to pickup a ringing call from thatprogrammed User.Do Not Disturb – This is enabled/disabled by use of an icon displayed in thetop left of SoftphoneUpdated HD Video Codec – provides better video quality and compatibilitywith other SIP video conferencing telephones.

8. IP Office Video Softphone

document.xls Page 40

IP Office Video Softphone can run in two different operating modes:Softphone client mode:

The IP Office Video Softphone provides its own User interface, similar to a standard IP Office telephone for making calls, transferring calls, multiple call appearances or making conference calls. A programmable feature button list allows one-touch access to standard IP Office features. This is the preferred usage scenario for customers not running one-X Portal for IP Office. It is also the preferred operation mode for users who want to smoothly migrate from their desktop phone or who use Softphone only occasionally and prefer a phone-centric user-interface, with optional dial pad and standard phone feature keys. The user interface is flexible, allowing adjustment for personal preferences with detachable specific windows like the directory and call log window. The attached picture shows the Softphone with dial pad and feature keys, plus a view of the contacts of Softphone.

Softphone can also be configured to be minimized to the system tray when not in use to smaller or larger configurations to save desk-space.

8. IP Office Video Softphone

document.xls Page 41

Application mode:

Video Support

the IP Office Video Softphone runs in the background and standard call control is accomplished through one-X Portal for IP Office.If run with one-X portal it provides the following additional value:• Consistent user interface when using one-X Portal with a desktop phone, in telecommuter mode or in combination with Softphone.• Off-line call log with updates even when Softphone is not logged in• Additional features of one-X Portal e.g. presence and instant messaging.

As well as audio calls, IP Office Video Softphone supports end to end video calls on a single IP Office or within an IP Office Small Community Network. Currently, video is limited to end to end calls, no multi-party conferencing is supported.

Video adds a new level of interaction to the standard phone communication so this is especially useful for users working from a remote location, needing to get in touch with colleagues in the main site or when used in an IP Office Small Community Network.

8. IP Office Video Softphone

document.xls Page 42

Feature overview

Standard Telephone Features

• Conference Add• DND on• DND off• DND Exception Add• DND Exception Delete• Cancel All Forwarding• Forward Unconditional On• Forward Unconditional Off• Forward On Busy On• Forward On Busy Off• Forward On No Answer On• Forward On No Answer Off• Forward Number• Follow Me Here• Forward Me To• Forward Hunt Group Calls On• Forward Hunt Group Calls Off• VoiceMail on• VoiceMail off• Set Hunt Group Night Service• Clear Hunt Group Night Service• Call Pick up any• Call Pick up group• Call Pick up Members• Directed Call Pick up• Call Steal• Call Queue• Hold Music• Park• Ride Call/Un-park• Relay On• Relay Off• Relay Pulse• Forward On Busy Number• Call Record

The following feature overview is applicable when using the IP Office Video Softphone in Client mode. When used in application mode, available functionality depends on the one-X Portal for IP Office application.

• Making and receiving calls• Audio Conference (IP Office based)• Redial• Speakerphone and Mute.• Hold, transfer (attended and unattended)• Do Not Disturb.• End/Disconnect/Drop• Call display• Call forward.• Call transfer.• Message waiting with direct voicemail access• Call history – list of received, missed, and dialed calls.• Multiple Call Appearances (No bridged or line appearances)• Dial Pad with Alpha/Numeric Keypad• Local Softphone call log, local Softphone directory/Personal Contacts• Access to IP Office directory (system, corporate, personal)• 12 Speed Dial / User BLF• Feature keys for up to 12 IP Office features:

8. IP Office Video Softphone

document.xls Page 43

Enhanced Features and Functions

Licensing and Provisioning

Username and Twinning

The IP Office Softphone also supports the following features and functions:• Video• Support for several languages in addition to English: French, German, Italian, Portuguese, and Spanish.• Contact list containing the individual user’s contacts• Directory containing names from central and personal IP Office directory.• Automatic detection and configuration of audio and video devices.• Acoustic echo cancellation, automatic gain control, voice activity detection.• Support for DTMF (RFC 2833, inband DTMF or SIP INFO messages).• Support for the following audio codecs: G.711, G.723.1, G.729a• Support for the following video codecs: H.263, H.263+, H.264• Compliance to 3261 SIP standard.• Support for these firewall traversal solutions: STUN, TURN, or ICE.

IP Office Video Softphone forms part of the Teleworker or Power User profile. A user can log onto the IP Office Video Softphone using their normal username and password. License entitlement will be checked against that user before the login is accepted.Unlike Avaya hard phones, IP Office Video Softphone does not require an Avaya IP Phone License to work on IP Office.While the IP Office Video Softphone is a thick client application, it is extremely easy to install and provision. Installation of the application on a standard PC requires minimal to no configuration as all provisioning of the product is done from the IP Office as a provisioning server.

If a DHCP server is present and set up correctly, Softphone will completely configure itself. The user only needs to enter the username and password to get connected.If DHCP is not available, the user needs to enter a single IP address of the IP Office; all other parameters will be set automatically.Softphone can be set up so that, when the PC starts up, the application is automatically started with the default username and password. The user can disable automatic login as well as interrupt it any time.

When logged in to IP Office Video Softphone with their username and password, the user will automatically be logged off from their existing desktop extension, so the user is fully available on their normal number without any additional steps.For users that are using a physical telephone e.g. in the office, this is very convenient as they do not use a different extension for Softphone calls. All calls will be routed automatically to the Softphone when logged in. There is no need to use twinning to tie the IP Office Video Softphone to the standard desktop phone.

8. IP Office Video Softphone

document.xls Page 44

Supported Audio and Video Hardware

For alerting, in addition to that the PC speakers can be activated to ring the phone.

Audio Devices:

Video Cameras:

Video Cameras for HD Video.• Logitech Webcam Pro 9000:

Supported Audio and Video Codecs:

Supported languages

Currently the following languages are supported:

Over the time, new languages can be added to the product.

IP Office Video Softphone can run with any Windows sound device supporting full-duplex quality.If possible, audio devices are automatically detected and allocated to the IP Office Video Softphone.IP Office Video Softphone supports simultaneous operation of two sound devices, e.g. a headset or USB handset for normal calls and a USB hands free unit for hands free operation. It is possible to switch between the sound devices at any time during the call.

For easy use, similar to a desktop phones, Softphone supports USB devices for audio as well as for call control, e.g. accepting and terminating a call. Softphone supports the “HID” standard for USB devices allowing generic HID devices to be configured.A number of USB devices have been tested with Softphone for interoperability, including Hook switch control as well as dialing (if supported by that device)

• Plantronics DSP (USB headset)• Plantronics 510 (Bluetooth headset with USB base)• Plantronics CS50 (USB wireless headset)• GN Netcom 8120 (USB headset adapter for GN Netcom headsets)• Yealink W1DL (Cordless USB phone with Dialpad)• Yealink P1K (Corded USB Phone with Dialpad)• Generic USB soundcard and USB HID interface support (with configuration assistant)

• Logitech QuickCam Pro 4000, 5000, 9000• Creative Webcam NX Pro• Microsoft Lifecam VX-3000

Softphone supports G.711 and G.729 audio Codecs. Audio Codec negotiation is done by IP Office in order to ensure best quality for local or SCN calls. At login, user can select the default mode, e.g. best quality or low bandwidth for remote operation.For Video, Softphone supports H.263, H.263+ and H.264 Video Codecs with resolution of up to 1280*768 pixels and 30 frames per second.

Note: The above numbers show an average bandwidth requirement but peak usage might be higher. The above numbers do not include the audio-bandwidth.

• English,• French,• German,• Spanish,• Italian,• Portuguese• Simplified Chinese

8. IP Office Video Softphone

document.xls Page 45

PC requirements.

Processor:

Memory:

• Minimum: Pentium 4 2.4 GHz or equivalent, Video Card with DirectX 9.0c support• Optimal: Intel Core 2 Duo or equivalent, Video Card with DirectX 9.0c support.

• Minimum: 1 GB RAM• Optimal: 2 GB RAM

Hard Disk Space: 50 MBOperating System: • Microsoft Windows XP Service Pack 2.• Microsoft Windows Vista (32-bit and 64-bit).Vista support is only on Business, Enterprise and Ultimate versions.• Microsoft Windows 7 (32-bit and 64-bit).Windows 7 support is only on Professional, Enterprise and Ultimate versions.Additional: Microsoft Windows Installer 3.1, Microsoft .NET 3.5 SP1, Microsoft VC 9.0 Runtime Service Pack 1Connection: IP network connection (broadband, LAN, wireless) Sound Card: Full-duplex, 16-bit or use USB headset

Multimedia Device Requirements

The IP Office Softphone requires both speakers and a microphone to make calls. Any of the following configurations are acceptable:• External speakers and microphone• Built-in speakers and microphone• Dual-jack multimedia headset• USB multimedia headset• USB phone.

HID-compliant devices can be configured to work with the IP Office Softphoneto support e.g. hook-switch functionality.Video CamerasCalls made with the IP Office Softphone will work without a video camera, but a video camera is necessary to allow other parties to see your image. The IP Office Softphone will work with most USB video cameras.

Note that these are recommendations. Depending on other applications on the PC, Softphone cannot guarantee uninterrupted voice and Video quality. While Softphone runs with high priority on the PC in order not to be impacted by normal applications other programs with similar priority could impact Softphone performance. Sample applications could be other Multimedia or communication applications like web-sharing programs or programs that are essential for PC performance like some Virus-scanners or firewall programs.

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 46

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of Sale

*** Note: All items with a lavander background are scheduled to go End of Sale*** Note: All items with a blue background are new with Release 7.0

<---- Upgrade LicensesControl Unit Upgrades

To release R7.0262645

262644

To release R6.1262695

262694

To release R6.0229421

229420

<---- System EditionsSystems

700343460

171991

229424 IPO LIC R6 ADV EDITION

227043 $2,295.00

AVAYA™ IP OFFICE PRODUCT LINE LIST

IPO LIC UPG 7.0 SML - IP500 & IP500V2 only!This license can be used to upgrade IP500 systems with up to 32 users and no external expansion modules.

IP OFFICE LICENSE UPGRADE R7.0 SMALL

IPO LIC UPG 7.0 - IP500 & IP500V2 Only!This license can be used to upgrade system with more than 32 users or external expansion modules.

IP OFFICE LICENSE UPGRADE R7.0

IPO LIC UPG R6.1 SML - IP500 only!This license can be used to upgrade IP500 systems with up to 32 users and no external expansion modules.

IP OFFICE LICENSE UPGRADE R6.1 SMALL

IPO LIC UPG R6.1 - IP406V2, IP412 and IP500This license can be used to upgrade system with more than 32 users or external expansion modules.

IP OFFICE LICENSE UPGRADE R6.1

IPO LIC UPG R6.0 SML - IP500 only!This license can be used to upgrade IP500 systems with up to 32 users and no external expansion modules.

IPO LIC UPG R6.0 - IP406V2, IP412 and IP500This license can be used to upgrade system with more than 32 users or external expansion modules.

IPO - Essential Edition (formerly Embedded Voicemail) - Essential Edition Compact Flash version for IP500v1 and IP406V2 Control Units only. Release R6 with the IP500V2 Control Unit the SD card, also provides the Essential VM functionality with two (2) ports of voicemail!Memory Expansion Kit is a plug in 512MB Compact Flash PCMCIA card required for the embedded voicemail/auto-attendant option.

IPO MC ESSNTL (EMBD MSGING) EXP KIT - Renaming of: IPO MC EMBD MSGING EXP KIT

IPO - Preferred Edition (formerly VoiceMail Pro) In addition to the features provided by the Essential Edition, Preferred Edition includes: • "Meet-Me" Conferencing(Professional Edition is no longer required with Release 5.0 and above)

IPO LIC PREFRD (VM PRO) RFA LIC:DSRenaming of: IPO LIC VM PRO RFA LIC:DS

IPO - R6.0 Advanced EditionPreferred Edition required.In addition to the features provided by the Preferred Edition, Advanced Edition includes: • Support for Customer Call Reporter (1 Supervisor).• Voicemail Pro database interaction (IVR).• Voicemail Pro call flow generic TTS (8 ports).[1]

• Voicemail Pro Visual Basic Scripting.• Voicemail Pro call recording to ContactStore.[2]

1.Note: Provides up to 8 ports of TTS for use with Speak Text actions within Voicemail Pro call flows. Not used for user TTS email reading.2.Note: In a Small Community Network using centralized voicemail, this license only enables ContactStore support for the central IP Office. Remote IP Offices in the network require their own Advanced Edition license or a VMPro Recordings Administrator license.

IPO - R5.0 Advanced EditionPreferred Edition required.In addition to the features provided by the Preferred Edition, Advanced Edition includes: • Customer Service Supervisor - 1 User• VoiceMail Pro Contact Store License• VoiceMail Pro VB Script License• VoiceMail Pro 3rd-party Database Interface License (IVR)• Voicemail Pro 3rd party TTS (Licenses for 8-ports)

IPO LIC ADVANCED RFA LIC:DS

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 47

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of SaleVoice Networking Option (SCN, H.232 & Qsig)

205650 $695.00

<---- User Productivity ProfilesR6.x Office Worker

229438

229439

229440

R6.x Mobile Worker

229434

229435

229436

IPO 500 Multi-Site Networking - The Voice Networking Base license allows unlimited Q.Sig calls but restricts IP and SCN trunks to a maximum of 4 outbound calls. Also now includes Advanced Networking features (Hot-Desking & distributed groups across SCN).For IP500 on release 4.0 to 4.2, adds support for 4 additional outbound calls for IP or SCN trunksalso requires IPO LIC IP500 VCE NTWK START4 LIC:DS (202960) License before this license can be applied (Release 4.0 to 4.2 only).

Renaming of: IP500 VCE NTWKG ADD 4

This license will enable the following functionality for the user: • one-X Portal for IP Office (with Telecommuter mode disabled) • Unified Messaging Service (web and email access to voicemail)This license has to be applied to a particular user to be valid.Note 1: Full feature capability requires Preferred Edition. No specific System Edition license is required as a prerequisite for this license to be valid. However, the Unified Messaging Service (UMS) function will not work without the Preferred Edition license.Note 2: For migration purposes, any existing Phone Manager Pro license can enable the Office Worker functionality (instead of Phone Manager Pro).

Enables one named user to use all office worker functionality.

IPO LIC R6 OFFWORKER 1

Enables 5 named users to use all office worker functionality.

IPO LIC R6 OFFWORKER 5

Enables 20 named users to use all office worker functionality.

IPO LIC R6 OFFWORKER 20

This license will enable the following functionality for the user: • Mobility including Mobile Twinning, Mobile Call Control and one-X Mobile Client support • Text-to-Speech (TTS)This license has to be applied to a particular user to be valid.Note: Full feature capability requires Preferred Edition. No specific System Edition license is required as a prerequisite for this license to be valid. However, the TTS function will not work without the Preferred Edition license.

Enables one named user to use all mobile worker functionality.

IPO LIC R6MOBILEWORKER 1

Enables 5 named users to use all mobile worker functionality.

IPO LIC R6MOBILEWORKER 5

Enables 20 named users to use all mobile worker functionality.

IPO LIC R6MOBILEWORKER 20

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 48

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of SaleR6.x Teleworker

229430

229431

229432

R6.x Power User

229426

229427

229428

Receptionist

171987 IPO LIC RECEPTIONIST RFA 1 LIC:CU R6.x Customer Service Supervisor

229442

R6.x Customer Service Agent

217650 IPO LIC CUSTMR SVC AGT RFA 1 LIC:CU217651 IPO LIC CUSTMR SVC AGT RFA 5 LIC:CU217653 IPO LIC CUSTMR SVC AGT RFA 20 LIC:CU

CCC to CCR Migration 217658

Release R5.0 Mobile Worker

195569 IPO LIC MOBILE WORKER RFA 1

195570 IPO LIC MOBILE WORKER RFA 5

195572 IPO LIC MOBILE WORKER RFA 20

Release R5.0Teleworker

227047 IPO LIC TELEWORKER RFA 1 LIC:CU227054 IPO LIC TELEWORKER RFA 5 LIC:CU227057 IPO LIC TELEWORKER RFA 20 LIC:CU

This license will enable the following functionality for the user: • one-X Portal for IP Office • Unified Messaging Service (web and email access to voicemail) • IP Office Video SoftphoneThis license has to be applied to a particular user to be valid.Note: Full feature capability requires Preferred Edition. No specific System Edition license is required as a prerequisite for this license to be valid. However, the UMS function will not work without the Preferred Edition license.

Enables one named user to use all teleworker functionality.

IPO LIC R6TELEWORKER 1

Enables 5 named users to use all teleworker functionality.

IPO LIC R6TELEWORKER 5

Enables 20 named users to use all teleworker functionality.

IPO LIC R6TELEWORKER 20

This license will enable the following functionality for the user: • Mobility including Mobile Twinning, Mobile Call Control and one-X Mobile Client support • one-X Portal for IP Office • Unified Messaging Service (web and email access to voicemail) • IP Office Video Softphone • Text-to-Speech (TTS)This license has to be applied to a particular user to be valid.Note: Full feature capability requires Preferred Edition. No specific System Edition license is required as a prerequisite for this license to be valid. However, the UMS and TTS functions will not work without the Preferred System package The above 4 profiles are mutually exclusive, only one may be selected per user. In addition, the user may have one of the licenses below.

Enables one named user to use all power user functionality.

IPO LIC R6 PWRUSER 1

Enables 5 named users to use all power user functionality.

IPO LIC R6 PWRUSER 5

Enables 20 named users to use all power user functionality.

IPO LIC R6 PWRUSER 20

Renaming of IP Office SoftConsole, eliminating "additional SoftConsole RFA 1". Available as a single user (just purchase additional license to a maximum of 4 users per system).

Enables one customer service supervisor, only for R6 and higher and requires Advanced Edition.

IPO LIC R6CUSTMR SVC SPV 1

Renaming of Customer Call Reporter agent. Available in 1,5, and 20 users.

IPO CUSTMR CALL REPORTER UPG LIC - This upgrade license will convert ALL CCC licenses to Customer Call Reporter (CCR). This includes all supervisors and agents.

Renaming of Mobile Twinning. Each user also has 1 license of 3rd party (Generic) TTS. Available in 1,5, and 20 users.

IPO LIC MOBILE WORKER RFA 1IPO LIC MOBILE WORKER RFA 5IPO LIC MOBILE WORKER RFA 20

Includes VPN phone license, one-X Portal and Phone Manager Pro. Available in 1,5, and 20 users.

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 49

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of SaleRelease R5.0 Power User

227046 IPO LIC POWER USER RFA 1 LIC:CU227051 IPO LIC POWER USER RFA 5 LIC:CU227056 IPO LIC POWER USER RFA 20 LIC:CU

Receptionist

171987 IPO LIC RECEPTIONIST RFA 1 LIC:CU Release R5.0 Customer Service Supervisor

217655 IPO LIC CUSTMR SVC SPV RFA 1 LIC:CU217656 IPO LIC CUSTMR SVC SPV RFA 10 LIC:CU217657 IPO LIC CUSTMR SVC SPV RFA 20 LIC:CU

Release R5.0 Customer Service Agent

217650 IPO LIC CUSTMR SVC AGT RFA 1 LIC:CU217651 IPO LIC CUSTMR SVC AGT RFA 5 LIC:CU217653 IPO LIC CUSTMR SVC AGT RFA 20 LIC:CU

CCC to CCR Migration 217658

<---- IP Office 500V2 SD Cards & Essential VM UpgradesIP500V2 SD Cards

IP Office Edition700479710

700479702

IP Office PARTNER® Version700479728

IP Office Norstar700500948

Essential Edition Voicemail Port upgrade229423

<---- IP Office 500V1 SmartcardsIP500 Smartcards - IP500 R4.0 to 6.x

700417470

700417488

Everything in Teleworker and Mobile Worker PLUS Unified Messaging (UMS) and PC softphone. Available in 1,5, and 20 users. Full feature functionality requires Preferred Edition.

Renaming of IP Office SoftConsole, eliminating "additional SoftConsole RFA 1". Available as a single user (just purchase additional license to a maximum of 4 users per system).

Renaming of Customer Call Reporter Supervisor. Available in 1,10, and 20 users.

Renaming of Customer Call Reporter agent. Available in 1,5, and 20 users.

IPO CUSTMR CALL REPORTER UPG LIC - This upgrade license will convert ALL CCC licenses to Customer Call Reporter (CCR). This includes all supervisors and agents.

IPO IP500V2 SYSTEM IP Office Essential Edition SD CARD MU-LAW NARNA, CALAIncludes two (2) port Essential VM, upgradeable to a maximum of six (6) ports.IPO IP500V2 SYSTEM IP Office Essential Edition SD CARD A-LAWAPAC, CALA, EMEAIncludes two (2) port Essential VM, upgradeable to a maximum of six (6) ports.

IPO IP500V2 SYSTEM PARTNER® Version SD CARD PARTNERNA, CALAIncludes two (2) port Essential VM, upgradeable to a maximum of six (6) ports.

IPO IP500V2 SYSTEM SD CARD NORSTAR (available for Middle East Africa region)

IP OFFICE IP500 R6.1 SYSTEM SD CARD NORSTAR

IPO LIC R6 ESSNTL EDITION ADD 2CHIP500V2 only. 2 embedded voicemail ports are already enabled by default; this license increases the capacity by 2 ports (up to a maximum of 6).

IPO 500 FEAT KEY MU-LAW - NARRequired with every IP 500 Control Unit for system operation and licensing of applications.Not supported on the IP500V2!IPO 500 FEAT KEY A-LAW - ROWRequired with every IP 500 Control Unit for system operation and licensing of applications.Not supported on IP500V2!

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 50

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of Sale<---- IP Office 500V1/V2 Control Unit, Modules and Cards

IP Office 500V2 Control Unit700476005

IP Office 500V1 Control Unit700417207

700429194IP500V2 Base Cards Only

TCM-8700500758

Combo Card Global700476013

Combo Card APAC & EMEA700476021

Partner ETR Card NA & CALA700476039

IPO IP500V2 CONTROL UNITGlobal

IPO 500 SYSTEM UNIT - On the IP Office 500 R5 does not requires IP Office Standard to Professional upgrade RFA (202959 ). However, IP500 release 4.0 to 4.2 does require the IP Office Standard to Professional upgrade RFA (202959 ).The following requires IP Office Standard to Professional upgrade RFA (Release 4.0 to 4.2 only).• Use of Expansion ports• 64-way Meet me Conference Bridge• VMLite or VMPro• ContactStore• Conference Center• CCC• TAPI WAV

IPO 500 BLANKING PLATE KIT

IPO IP500 EXTN CARD TCM-8 - Internal Extension card for 8 Nortel digital phones

IPO IP500 EXTN CARD TCM-8 DGTL STA 8

IPO IP500V2 COMBINATION CARD ATM Global· Supports· 6 Digital Station ports.· 2 Analog Extension ports. With port 8 Power Failover port 12· 4 Analog Trunk ports.· 10 VCM channels.· Maximum per IP500 V2 Control Unit: 2.· IP500 Daughter Card Support: 1. The trunk daughter card is preinstalled and cannot be replaced with another card type.Provides DS ports for digital stations (except 4406D, 4412D and 4424D). In PARTNER® Version only 14xx digital sets are supported.The Combination card is only supported in the IP500v2 control unit. A maximum of two cards are supported.

IPO IP500V2 COMBINATION CARD BRI APAC,EMEA· Supports· 6 Digital Station ports.· 2 Analog Extension ports.· 2 BRI Trunk ports (4 BRI channels).· 10 VCM channels.· Maximum per IP500 Control Unit: 2.· IP500 Daughter Card Support: 1. The trunk daughter card is preinstalled and cannot be replaced with another card type.The Combination card is only supported in the IP500v2 control unit. A maximum of two cards are supported.

IPO IP500V2 EXTN CARD ETR 6 NA, CALA· SupportsPARTNER® ETR and analog phones.· Maximum per IP500 Control Unit: 3.· The ETR 6 Card is only supported in the IP500v2 control unit and only when it is running in Essential Edition – PARTNER® Version mode.· IP500 Daughter Card Support: 1.The IP500 BRI trunk daughter card is not supported.

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 51

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of SaleIP500V1/V2 Base Cards

Analog Stations700431778

700417231

Digital Stations700417330

VCMs700417389

700417397

Legacy Carrier700417215

IPO 500 EXTENSION CARD PHONE 2 - To connect up to 2 Analog station sets. The card can be fitted with an IP Office 500 daughter trunk card, which then uses the additional 4 RJ45 ports for trunk connections. Maximum of 4 per IP500/IP500V2 Control Unit• This card accepts one IP Office 500 trunk daughter card of any type.

IPO 500 EXTENSION CARD PHONE 8 - To connect up to 8 Analog station sets. The card can be fitted with an IP Office 500 daughter trunk card, which then uses the additional 4 RJ45 ports for trunk connections. Maximum of 4 per IP500/IP500V2 Control Unit• This card accepts one IP Office 500 trunk daughter card of any type.

IPO 500 EXTENSION CARD DGTL STA 8 - To connect up to 8 of the IP Office supported Digital sets except the 44xx series. The card can be fitted with an IP Office 500 daughter trunk card, which then uses the additional 4 RJ45 ports for trunk connections. Maximum of 3 per IP500/IP500V2 Control Unit• This card accepts one IP Office 500 trunk daughter card of any type.

IPO 500 MC VCM 32 - Comes with 4 VCM channels enabled, the rest are enabled with licensing. The card can be fitted with an IP Office 500 daughter trunk card, which then uses the additional 4 RJ45 ports for trunk connections. Maximum of 2 per IP500/IP500V2 Control Unit and no more than 128 VCM channels per Control Unit.• This card accepts one IP Office 500 trunk daughter card of any type.

Note: For Release R4.0 to 5.0 comes with 4 VCM channels enabled. Additional channels can be enabled through licensing.For release 6.0 and higher comes with 32 VCM channels enabled and 12 Avaya IP Endpoint licenses.

IPO 500 MC VCM 64 - Comes with 4 VCM channels enabled, the rest are enabled with licensing. The card can be fitted with an IP Office 500 daughter trunk card, which then uses the additional 4 RJ45 ports for trunk connections. Maximum of 2 per IP500/IP500V2 Control Unit and no more than 128 VCM channels per Control Unit.• This card accepts one IP Office 500 trunk daughter card of any type.

Note: For Release R4.0 to 5.0 comes with 4 VCM channels enabled. Additional channels can be enabled through licensing.For release 6.0 and higher comes with 64 VCM channels enabled and 12 Avaya IP Endpoint licenses.

IPO 500 LEGACY CARD CARRIER • This card supports, one each, of the following IP400 cards:• PRI T1• Dual PRI T1• NA E1 PRI• PRI 30 E1 (1.4)• Dual PRI E1• PRI 30 E1R2 RJ45• Dual PRI E1R2 RJ45• ANLG 4 Uni• BRI-8 (UNI)• VCM 4• VCM 8• VCM 16• VCM 24• VCM 30Maximum of 2 per IP500/IP500V2 Control Unit

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 52

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of SaleExpansion Card

700472889 IPO IP500 EXP CARD 4PT

IP500 Trunks CardsAnalog Trunks

700417405

BRI Trunks - Euro ISDN700417413

700417421

S0 Converter Cable700458649

T1/PRI/E1/E1R2 Trunks700417439

700417462 IPO 500 TRNK PRI UNI DUAL

IP OFFICE IP500 EXPANSION CARD 4 PORT· SupportsProvides 4 additional expansion ports for connection of external expansion modules.· Supported Expansion Modules: The following external expansion modules are supported:· IP500 Analogue Trunk Module· IP500 BRI So Module· IP500 Digital Station Module· IP500 Phone Module· IP400 Digital Station V2 Modules· IP400 Phone V2 Modules· Maximum per IP500/IP500V2 Control Unit: 1 - Right hand slot 4 only.

IPO 500 TRUNK ANLG 4 UNI - This card can be added to an IP Office 500 Digital Station card, IP Office 500 Analog Phone base card, or IP Office 500 VCM card. It allows that card to then also support 4 analog loop-start trunks. It also provides one analog V.32 modem. • When fitted to an IP Office 500 Analog Phone 8 base card, the combination supports 1 power failure extension to trunk connection.

IPO 500 TRUNK BRI 4 UNI (Euro ISDN) - This type of card can be added to an IP Office 500 Digital Station card, IP Office 500 Analog Phone card, or IP Office 500 VCM card. It allows that card to then also support up 2 BRI trunk connections, each trunk providing 2B+D digital channels. IPO 500 TRUNK BRI 8 UNI (Euro ISDN) - This type of card can be added to an IP Office 500 Digital Station card, IP Office 500 Analog Phone card, or IP Office 500 VCM card. It allows that card to then also support up 4 BRI trunk connections, each trunk providing 2B+D digital channels. The card is

IPO IP500 BRI S0 CONVTR CBL - Converter cable for use with IP500 BRI in S0 mode

IPO 500 TRNK PRI UNI SINGLE - Support up to 24 T1 channels or up to 30 E1 channels. Eight (8) channels are enabled by default. Further channels may be enabled by the purchase of additional licenses in 2-channel or 8-channel increments.• Up to four Universal PRI cards can be installed in any combination in the IP500 chassis.• The IP500 PRI daughter card works on any IP500 VCM or extension base card (not the Legacy Card Carrier).

IPO 500 TRNK PRI UNI SINGLE

IPO 500 TRNK PRI UNI DUAL - Support up to 48 T1 channels or 60 E1 channels. Eight (8) channels are enabled per T1/PRI port by default. Further channels may be enabled by the purchase of additional licenses in 2-channel, 8-channel increments, 22-channels or 32-channels.• Up to four Universal PRI cards can be installed in any combination in the IP500 chassis.• The IP500 PRI daughter card works on any IP500 VCM or extension base card (not the Legacy Card Carrier).

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 53

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of SaleIP500 Expansion Modules

Analog Stations700449507 46USC0002UKRE

700426224

IP500 Digital Expansion ModulesIP Office Digital Stations

700449499 46USC0002UKRA

700426216

Nortel Digital Stations700500699

700500698

IPO 500 EXP MOD PHONE 16 - Adds an additional 16 Plain Ordinary Telephone ports to the IP500/IP500V2. Not Included: Power Lead.On the IP500 release 5.0 does not requires IP Office Standard to Professional upgrade RFA (202959 ). However, IP500 release 4.0 to 4.2 does require the IP Office Standard to Professional upgrade RFA (202959 ). Included: IP400 EXP RJ45/RJ45 1M Blue For Connecting Expansion Module to Base Unit

IPO 500 EXP MOD PHONE 30 - Adds an additional 30 Plain Ordinary Telephone ports to the IP500?IP500V2. Not Included: Power Lead.On the IP500 release 5.0 does not requires IP Office Standard to Professional upgrade RFA (202959 ). However, IP500 release 4.0 to 4.2 does require the IP Office Standard to Professional upgrade RFA (202959 ). Included: IP400 EXP RJ45/RJ45 1M Blue For Connecting Expansion Module to Base Unit.

IPO 500 EXP MOD DGTL STA 16 - Adds an additional 16 Digital Station ports to the IP500/IP500V2, to support 24xx or 44xx or 54xx or 64xx Series Digital sets. Not Included: Power Lead.On the IP500 release 5.0 does not requires IP Office Standard to Professional upgrade RFA (202959 ). However, IP500 release 4.0 to 4.2 does require the IP Office Standard to Professional upgrade RFA (202959 ). Included: IP400 EXP RJ45/RJ45 1M Blue For Connecting Expansion Module to Base Unit

IPO 500 EXP MOD DGTL STA 30 - Adds an additional 30 Digital Station ports to the IP500/IP500V2, to support 24xx or 44xx or 54xx or 64xx Series Digital sets. Not Included: Power Lead.On the IP500 release 5.0 does not requires IP Office Standard to Professional upgrade RFA (202959 ). However, IP500 release 4.0 to 4.2 does require the IP Office Standard to Professional upgrade RFA (202959 ). Included: IP400 EXP RJ45/RJ45 1M Blue For Connecting Expansion Module to Base Unit

IPO IP500 EXP MOD DS16A DGTL ST RJ21 - External Expansion module for 16 Nortel digital phonesNot Included: Power Lead. Included: IP400 EXP RJ45/RJ45 1M Blue For Connecting Expansion Module to Base Unit

IPO IP500 EXP MOD DS30A DGTL ST RJ21 - External Expansion module for 30 Nortel digital phonesNot Included: Power Lead. Included: IP400 EXP RJ45/RJ45 1M Blue For Connecting Expansion Module to Base Unit

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 54

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of SaleAnalog Trunks

700449473 46USC0002UKRQ

IP500 Mountings700500923

700429202700430150

<---- IP Office 500 RFAsIP500 Standard to Professional Upgrade

202959

IP500 Voice Networking (SCN,Qsig, H450 )202960

205650

202961Note:

T1/PRI215180 IPO LIC IP500 T1 CHANNELS ADD 2215181 IPO LIC IP500 T1 CHANNELS ADD 8215182 IPO LIC IP500 T1 CHANNELS ADD 32

E1215183 IPO LIC IP500 E1 CHANNELS ADD 2215184 IPO LIC IP500 E1 CHANNELS ADD 8215185 IPO LIC IP500 E1 CHANNELS ADD 22

E1R2215186 IPO LIC IP500 E1R2 CHANNELS ADD 2215187 IPO LIC IP500 E1R2 CHANNELS ADD 8215188 IPO LIC IP500 E1R2 CHANNELS ADD 22Note:

IPO 500 EXP MOD ANLG TRNK 16 provides an additional 16 Analog trunks (loop start, LS-ICLID or ground start) and two power fail sockets. On the IP500 release 5.0 does not requires IP Office Standard to Professional upgrade RFA (202959 ). However, IP500 release 4.0 to 4.2 does require the IP Office Standard to Professional upgrade RFA (202959 ). Not Included: Power Lead and Trunk Cable(s). Included: IP400 EXP RJ45/RJ45 1M Blue For Connecting Expansion Module to Base Unit

IPO IP500 WALL MNTG KIT V2 - New Wall Mount with cable management IPO 500 RACK MOUNTING KIT IPO 500 WALL MOUNTING KIT

IPO LIC IP500 IPO STD UPG TO PROOn the IP Office 500 R5 and higher do not requires IP Office Standard to Professional upgrade RFA (202959 ). However, IP500 release 4.0 to 4.2 does requires the IP Office Standard to Professional upgrade RFA (202959 ).The following requires IP Office Standard to Professional upgrade RFA (Release 4.0 to 4.2 only).• Use of Expansion ports• 64-way Meet me Conference Bridge• VMLite or VMPro• ContactStore• Conference Center• CCC• TAPI WAV

IPO LIC IP500 VCE NTWK START4 LIC:DS The Voice Networking Base license allows unlimited Q.Sig calls but restricts IP trunks to a maximum of 4 outbound calls.• Starting with release 4.0.10, IP500 no longer requires IPO LIC IP500 IPO STD UPG TO PRO (202959) License. This license is used with IP500 Systems on release 4.0 to 4.2 only, Not to be used on IP500 with R5 system.

See above to add support for 4 additional outbound calls for IP or SCN trunks• IP500 requires IPO LIC IP500 VCE NTWK START4 LIC:DS (202960) License before this license can be appliedIP500 VCM RFAs * IPO LIC IP500 VCM LIC 4 CH This license is to add four (4) additional VCM channels to the IP500 VCM32/64 base cards release R4.0 to 5.0 only. This license is not required with release R6.0 or higherIP500 T1/E1 Channel RFAs *

These licenses are to add additional T1/PRI/E1/E1R2 channels to the IP500 PRI daughter card only.• The IP500 PRI daughter card works on any IP500 VCM or extension base card (not the Legacy Card Carrier).

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 55

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of Sale<---- IP400 and IP 500 Advanced Networking/SIP Trunking RFAs

IP400 and IP500 Advanced Networking202966

IP400 and IP500 SIP Trunking202967202968202969202970<---- R6 Avaya IP Endpoint RFA

R6.x IP Telephone RFA229444 Enables the use of one Avaya IP telephone.

229445 Enables the use of 5 Avaya IP telephones.

229447 Enables the use of 20 Avaya IP telephones.

<---- IP Office Applications, Feature Keys & CDsIP 400 Feature Key Dongles - Only used with IP400 Series Control Units

700293095 IP400 FEATURE KEY - SERIAL

Application CD'sIP Office Phone Status

700411184

VMPro CD700459357 VoiceMail Pro 4.2 CD

IP Office Application Server DVD700501420 IP OFFICE R7.0 APPLICATION SERVER DVD IPO 7.0 APPL SRVR DVD700501078 IP OFFICE R6.1 APPLICATION SERVER DVD IPO R6.1 APPL SRVR DVD

IP Office Admin SET DVD700500928 IP OFFICE R7.0 APPLICATION SERVER DVD

700500949 IP OFFICE R6.1 USER/ADMIN SET DVD

700480569 IPO DVD R6.0 USER/ADMIN SET IP OFFICE R6.0 ADMIN DVDTTS CDs

700478068 IPO DVD TTS SET

The following licenses are supported with IP Office release 4.0 - 4.2 and only on the following

IPO LIC ADVANCED NTWKG LIC -The following new features are supported with IP Office Release 4.0. and provides the following features: This license is used with IP500V1 Systems on release 4.0 to 4.2 only, Not to be used on IP500 with R5 system.• Hot Desking across the Network• Distributed Hunt Groups• Break Out Note that these features require entry of an IP Office Advanced Networking License into each of the IP Office systems within the network.

IPO LIC SIP TRNK RFA 1 IPO LIC SIP TRNK RFA 5 IPO LIC SIP TRNK RFA 10 IPO LIC SIP TRNK RFA 20

IPO LIC R6 AV IPENDPOINT 1IPO LIC R6 AV IPENDPOINT 5IPO LIC R6 AV IPENDPOINT 20

Feature Key with unique serial number. One Feature Key is required per IP Office system for all software licenses (RFA product codes). Connects to IPO Serial port (No PC Key Server required). Connects to Small Office Edition, IPO 406 V2 and IPO 412 only.

IP Office Phone Status has been created to assist people who are blind or visually impaired to use IP Office telephones. It is available for use with IP Office R3.2 and above. The IP Office Phone Status application “speaks out” information about calls using the Microsoft Speech Engine. Events are spoken as they occur (in real time) or status items can be requested by pressing a key on the keyboard. Special keys can be defined to control various speaking functions. The information to be spoken is user selectable. All activities can be logged for later review.

IP OFFICE PHONE STATUS SOFTWARE

This a a client application and purchased once per IP Office control unit for all Users on the same IP Office.

CD-ROM containing the VoiceMail Pro application for IP Office. Licence keys are required to enable VoiceMail Pro functionality for the appropriate number of ports (4.2 Release).

IPO 7.0 USER/ADMIN SET DVDIPO R6.1 USER/ADMIN SET DVD

IP OFFICE DVD TEXT TO SPEECH SET

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 56

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of Sale<---- 60 Day Free ApplicationTry-It-Buy-It License RFA

Trial licenses allow applications to run in fully functional form for 60 days (from the date of license generation), after which time they cannot be used until upgraded at cost to the full license but can be ordered at any time during the product ownership.

Release 6.1 Specific Trial RFA's263128

Release 6.0 Specific Trial RFA's229425

229441

229437

229433

229429

229443

229449

Release 5 Specific Trial RFA's189782 IP Office Preferred Edition (formerly VoiceMail Pro)

227044 IPO LIC ADVANCED RFA TRIAL195574 IPO LIC MOBILE WORKER RFA 5 TRIAL227055 IPO LIC TELEWORKER RFA 5 TRIAL227052 IPO LIC POWER USER RFA 5 TRIAL189783 IP OFFICE LICENSE RECEPTIONIST RFA 1 TRIAL227053 IPO LIC CUSTMR SVC AGT RFA 5 TRIAL227040 IPO LIC IP ENDPOINT RFA 5 TRIAL

IP500 Specific Trial RFA's205822205823 IPO LIC IP500 VCE NTWK START 4 TRIAL

IP400/500 Trial RFA's217890 Unified Messaging Service (for 10 Users) IPO LIC UMS 10 USER TRIAL205821205820 SIP Trunking (1 Trunk)189776 VoiceMail Pro Networked Messaging

189778 Avaya Text-to-Speech (1 port)

189781 3rd party Text-to-Speech(1 port)

189786

189806 IPSec Virtual Private Networking

<---- CTI RFA LicensesComputer Telephony Interface (CTI) Link

171988 IP400 CTI RFA

TAPI Wav177466 IP400 TAPI WAV RFA 4

<---- Embedded VoicemailIP406 V2 and IP500 Embedded Voicemail

IP OFFICE LICENSE CTI RFA TRIAL LIC:DS - Also known as 3rd Party TAPI trial license, needed to trial DevConnect Solutions with IP Office

IPO LIC CTI RFATRIAL

IPO LIC R6 ADV EDITION TRIAL(includes 1 Supervisor and 20 Agents)IP Office - Office Worker solution (for 5 Users) for a 60-day trial period.

IPO LIC R6 OFFWORKER 5TRIAL

IP Office Mobile Worker solution (for 5 Users; formerly Mobility) for a 60-day trial period.

IPO LIC R6MOBILEWORKER 5TRIAL

IP Office Teleworker solution (for 5 Users) for a 60-daytrial period.

IPO LIC R6TELEWORKER 5TRIAL

IP Office Power User solution (for 5 Users) for a 60-day trial period.

IPO LIC R6 PWRUSER 5 TRIAL

IP Office Customer Service Supervisor solution for a 60-day trial period. (includes 1 additional Supervisor)

IPO LIC R6CUSTMR SVCSPV 1 TRIAL

IP Office Avaya IP Endpoint (for 5 endpoints) for a 60-day trial period.

IPO LIC R6 AV IPENDPOINT 5 TRIAL

Renaming of: IPO TRIAL VM PRO RFA LIC:DS

IPO LIC IP500 STD UPG TO PRO TRIAL

IPO LIC ADVANCED NTWKG TRIAL

IPO TRIAL NTWKD MSGING RFA LIC:DS IPO TRIAL AVAYA TTS RFA 1 LIC:CU IPO TRIAL 3RD PRTY TTS RFA LIC:CU

Centralized Voicemail with Avaya Messaging (Modular Messaging and Intuity AUDIX)

IPO TRIAL ACM CENTRAL VM LIC:DS IPO TRIAL IPSEC VPN RFA LIC:DS

NOTE: The ContactStore application has a 45 day trial built into the software and therefore does not require a separate license key, but this 45 day trial runs from the date the software is installed.

Enables CTI Link Pro functionality (TAPILink Pro & DevLink Pro). Does not include TAPI WAV ports, add RFA 177466 for TAPI WAV ports.

Enables 4 Voice Processing ports via TAPI WAV (Requires CTI Link Pro RFA). Up to 28 ports.• IP500 requires IPO LIC IP500 IPO STD UPG TO PRO (202959) License.

See "Essential Edition above"

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 57

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of Sale<---- Voicemail & VoiceMail Pro License RFA

Intuity Audix behind MultiVantage/ACM177467

VoiceMail Pro171991 IP400 VoiceMail Pro RFA

Add additional VoiceMail Pro Ports174459 Adds 2 VoiceMail Pro ports. IP400 VoiceMail Pro RFA 2174460 Adds 4 VoiceMail Pro ports. IP400 VoiceMail Pro RFA 4174461 Adds 8 VoiceMail Pro ports. IP400 VoiceMail Pro RFA 8174462 Adds 16 VoiceMail Pro ports. IP400 VoiceMail Pro RFA 16

VoiceMail Pro Networking182297

VoiceMail Pro Unified Messaging (UMS)217880

217881

217883

Text to Speech 182299 IP400 AVAYA TTS RFA 1

182303 IP400 3rd PARTY TTS RFA 1

ContactStore187166

<---- Phone Manager License RFAPhoneManager PRO

177468

iPhoneManager171992 IP400 IPPRO RFA 1

Enables IP Office to use Intuity Audix behind the MultiVantage/ACM (requires CLAN & Media Processor integrated to MultiVantage/ACM for IP or DS1 for T1 integrated to MultiVantage/ACM) as Centralized Voice Mail when IP Office is Qsig to MultiVantage/ACM (MultiVantage/ACM requires Qsig Supplemental). (Does Not require VoiceMail Pro).

IP400 AUDIX RFA

Basic VoiceMail Pro with 4 Ports. - Now called Preferred EditionSee "Preferred Edition above"

Enables VoiceMail Pro to inter-operate with other Avaya compliant voice messaging systems.

IP400 Networked Messaging RFA

IPO LIC VMPRO UMS 1 USER - Enables 1 user to access voicemail through the web or IMAPIPO LIC VMPRO UMS 5 USER - Enables 5 users to access voicemail through the web or IMAPIPO LIC VMPRO UMS 20 USER - Enables 20 users to access voicemail through the web or IMAP

Enables VoiceMail Pro to use Avaya/Scansoft Text To Speech (TTS) engine within VM Pro callflows (IVR) and/or for listening to Emails (MS-Exchange). One TTS RFA is required per concurrent user up to the number of licensed VM Pro ports.Enables VoiceMail Pro to use Microsoft or any other 3rd Party SAPI 5 Text To Speech (TTS) engines within VM Pro callflows (IVR) and/or for listening to Emails (MS-Exchange). One TTS RFA is required per concurrent user up to the number of licensed VM Pro ports.

IP Office ContactStore compliments VMPro recording capabilities by storing and cataloging the recordings into a database so that users can easily search and replay call recordings through a Web browser based graphical user interface (GUI). (Requires VoiceMail Pro RFA)• Required on each IP Office in an SCN• IP500 R4.2 and below requires IPO LIC IP500 IPO STD UPG TO PRO (202959) License.• Included in the IP Office Advanced Edition with IP500 R5..

IPO IP400 CONTACTSTORE FOR IPO RFA

NOTE: ContactStore has a 45 day trial built into the software and therefore does not require a separate license key. A fully featured IP Office ContactStore system can be installed and used for 45 days from the creation of the first recording.

Enables PhoneManager Pro for 1 user (or 1 additional user).

IP400 PhoneManager Pro RFA 1

Enables iPhoneManager Pro (IP Soft-Phone) for 1 additional user (or 1 additional user). Requires at least the same number of PhoneManager Pro licenses (IP400 Phone Manager Pro RFA) to be installed.

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 58

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of Sale<---- VPN Phone Software License RFA

VPN Phone License213980 IPO LIC VPN PHONE 1 LIC

<---- 3 Rd Party End Points License RFA3rd Party IP End points

174956 IP400 IP ENDPOINT RFA 1

174957 IP400 IP ENDPOINT RFA 5

174958 IP400 IP ENDPOINT RFA 10

174959 IP400 IP ENDPOINT RFA 20

174960 IP400 IP ENDPOINT RFA 50

<---- CCC License RFACompact Contact Center (CCC)Note: CCC is "End of Sale" and not supported on Release 6.0 and higher

Additional Supervisors171996 IP400 CCC SUP RFA

Additional Agents171995 IP400 CCC AGT RFA 5

Physical Wallboards176196 IP400 CCC Wallboard 4 RFA

<---- IPSec Licence RFAIPSec VPN

182301 IP400 IPSec VPN RFA

<---- Rack Mounts, Barrier Box, Cables & Physical WallboardsIP500 Mountings

700500923

700429202700430150

PHONE BARRIER BOX700385495

700293905

T1/Analog CO Trunk Cable700213440 Cable - 3 meters for BRI / PRI / T1 / Analogue Trunks.

Expansion Module Cable700213457

700472871 Only for use with the 4-Port Expansion card.

LAN Cables700213481 LAN Cable - 3 meters.

enables 1 remote 46xx/56xx VPN phone to connect to IP OfficeNote: The VPN Phone license is only valid up to release 5.0. With release R6.0 and above the Avaya IP Endpoint license is required.

Enables 3rd party IP end points. The Avaya 4600 series hardphones do not require this license key and iPhoneManager Pro (IP Office IP Soft-Phone) is enabled separately by IPPRO RFA. Enables 1 3rd party end point (or 1 additional 3rd party end point).

Enables 3rd party IP end points for 5 end points (or 5 additional end points).Enables 3rd party IP end points for 10 end points (or 10 additional end points).Enables 3rd party IP end points for 20 end points (or 20 additional end points).Enables 3rd party IP end points for 50 end points (or 50 additional end points).

Enables an additional supervisor for Compact Contact Centre - Requires IP400 CCC SVR RFA (171994) before additional Supervisors can be added (up to 21 Supervisors in total with CCC V5 and 5 with CCC V4), including the one supervisor in CCC SVR).

Enables reporting for 5 CCC agents (or 5 additional CCC agents). (Requires CCC V5)

Provides software activation for up to 4 physical wallboards for use with the Compact Contact Centre, up to a maximum of 16. Please note that this activation does not apply to the WB 22 product. For a list of approved readerboard displays, please refer to the CCC System Administrator's Guide.

Enables IP Office and Small Office Edition to initiate and terminate L2TP and IPSec VPN tunnels

IPO IP500 WALL MNTG KIT V2 - New Wall Mount with cable management IPO 500 RACK MOUNTING KIT IPO 500 WALL MOUNTING KIT

Use with Phone V2 module. Includes an RJ45 to RJ11 cable and functional earth lead.

IP400 Phone Barrier Box V2 (101V)

Flat Panel with mounting holes for 8 x Barrier Boxes on 19 inch racking

IP400 BARRIER BOX 1U PANEL

IP400 ISDN RJ45/RJ45 3M Red

Spare Cable - For connecting Expansion Modules to Base Units - 1 meter (Cable is included in all Expansion Modules).

IP400 EXP RJ45/RJ45 1M Blue

IPO EXP CBL RJ45/RJ45 2M YELLOW

IP400 LAN RJ45/RJ45 3M Gray

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 59

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of Sale

Wireless Keyboard - INFRARED WIRELESS KEYBOARD

<---- Power Supplies and LeadsSpare earthed 60W PSU Power Supply

700357387

Power Leads Earthed Power Cords

North, Central and South America700289770

Czech Republic, Ireland, United Kingdom.700289747

Europe and South Africa700289762

<---- B100 Conference phonesB100 Conference phones - Requires IPO release 7.0 or higherB100 Conference phones

700501533 AVAYA B149 ANALOG CONFERENCE PHONE

700501530 AVAYA B159 ANALOG CONFERENCE PHONE

700501532 AVAYA B179 SIP CONFERENCE PHONE

B100 Conference Accessories700501534 AVAYA B100 SER PWR ADPTR

700501536

700501537

700501538 AVAYA B100 SERIES MEMORY CARD 2GB

700501539

700501540

700501541

700501542 AVAYA B100 SERIES POWER EXTENSION CABLE 7.5M

700501543

700501544 AVAYA B100 SERIES USB CBL 1.5M

700501545

700501546

700501547

700501548

700501549

700501551

700501552 AVAYA B100 SERIES ETHERNET NETWORK CABLE 6.5M

700501553

Physical Wallboards*

Spectrum Wallboard - WALLBD 2X20 CHARS 40.2" LONG 115V SERIAL

3214C1 MSRP $2,455

Spectrum Wallboard Master Kit - MASTER KIT 115 VOLTS FOR SERIAL WALLBD

M2-MK001MSRP $295.00 M2-IK055$115.00

* Spectrum Wall Boards must be ordered directly from Spectrum:

Spare earthed 60W PSU Power Supply (Power Supply is included with Control Units & V2 expansion modules).For IP412, IP500, and V2 Expansion Units

IPO SPR - PWR SUPP EARTHED

IP412, IP500, DS16/30V2, Phone 16/30V2 and ATM16 V2 For IPO 412, IP500, and V2 Expansion Units Power Lead

Power Lead (Earthed) NEMA5-15P / CS22.2 No.42

IP412, IP500, DS16/30V2, Phone 16/30V2 and ATM16 V2 For IP412, IP500, and V2 Expansion Units Power Lead

Power Lead (Earthed) - BS1363

IP412, IP500, DS16/30V2, Phone 16/30V2 and ATM16 V2 For IP412, IP500, and V2 Expansion Units Power Lead

Power Lead (Earthed) - CEE7/7 (Schuko)

AVAYA B149 ANLG CONF PHONEAVAYA B159 ANLG CONFERENCE PHONEAVAYA B179 SIP CONF PHONE

AVAYA B100 SERIES AC 100-240V/14 DC POWER ADAPTER AVAYA B100 SERIES CONFERENCE PHONE WALL MOUNTING BRACKET

AVAYA B100 SER WALL MNTG BRKT

AVAYA B100 SERIES INTERFACE BOX W/SFTW FOR AUDITORIUM PA SYSTEM

AVAYA B100 SER PA SYS INTF BOXAVAYA B100 SER MEMORY CARD 2GB

AVAYA B100 SERIES EXPANSION MICROPHONES 1PR FOR CONFERENCE PHONE

AVAYA B100 SER EXP MIC 1PR

AVAYA B100 SERIES SECURITY LOCK AND CABLE FOR CONF PHONE

AVAYA B100 SER SECURITY LOCK/CBL

AVAYA B100 SERIES DUAL ANALOG LINE AND POWER CABLE 7.5M

AVAYA B100 SER ANLG/PWR CBL 7.5MAVAYA B100 SER PWR EXT CBL 7.5M

AVAYA B100 SERIES DUAL ANALOG LINE AND POWER EXTENSION CABLE 7.5M

AVAYA B100 SER ANLG/PWR EXT CBLAVAYA B100 SER USB CBL 1.5M

AVAYA B100 SERIES MOBILE PHONE CABLE FOR GSM SONY ERICSSON 1.5M

AVAYA B100 MOBILE CBL SONY ERICSSON

AVAYA B100 SERIES MOBILE PHONE CABLE FOR GSM NOKIA N95 1.5M

AVAYA B100 MOBILE CBL NOKIA N95

AVAYA B100 SERIES MOBILE PHONE CABLE FOR GSM NOKIA 2.5MM 1.5M

AVAYA B100 MOBILE CBL NOKIA 2.55MM

AVAYA B100 SERIES MOBILE PHONE CABLE FOR DECT/GSM/2.5MM 1.5M

AVAYA B100 MOBILE CBL DECT/2.5MM

AVAYA B100 SERIES MOBILE PHONE CABLE FOR GSM HTC USB 1.5M

AVAYA B100 MOBILE CBL HTC USB

AVAYA B100 SERIES POWER CABLE CONNECTION 7.5M EIJA-5320 CLASS IV

AVAYA B100 SER PWR CBL CONN 7.5MAVAYA B100 SER ETH CBL 6.5M

AVAYA B100 SERIES MOBILE PHONE CABLE FOR GSM IPHONE 4/3GS 1.5M

AVAYA B100 MOBILE CBL IPHONE

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 60

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of Sale<---- 14xx IP OFFICE DIGITAL SETS

IP OFFICE 14xx Digital SETS - Requires IPO release 6.0 or higher700469927

700469851

700469869

700469968

<---- 95xx & 96xx IP OFFICE Digital/IP SETSIP OFFICE 95xx Digital SETS - Requires IPO release 7.0 or higher

700500206

700500207

IP OFFICE 96x1 IP SETS - Requires IPO release 7.0 or higher700480585

700480601

700480619

700480627

700480635

700480643

700500725

Country Power Cords405362641 US Plug (15A, 120V) 17505407786623 Europe Plug (10A) 12013S407786599 UK Plug (10A) 14012407786631 Australia/NZ (10A) Plug 15012407790591 India Plug (10A) SPC-P250CIM408161453 Argentina

Faceplates700500723 FACEPLATE KIT 9621G/9641G PACK OF 25

Replacement Stands700500726 IP PHONE 9608/9611G REPLACEMENT STAND 700500727 BUTTON MODULE 12 REPLACEMENT STAND

96xx Handsets700416548 96XX REPLACEMENT HANDSET700446370 IP PHONE 96XX AMPLIFIED SPEECH HANDSET

96xx Handset Cords700383318 IP PHONE 96XX REPLACEMENT HANDSET CORD 9FT 700383821 IP PHONE 96XX REPLACEMENT HANDSET CORD 25FT

96xx Handset Ethernet Cable700383326 IP PHONE 96XX REPLACEMENT LINE CORD (CAT5)

Avaya 1403 - Available in April. Digital 3-button phone for IP Office only

1403 TELSETFOR IPO

Avaya 1408 -Available in April. Digital 8-button phone for IP Office, Communication Manager and Integral 55

1408 TELSETFOR CM/IE/IPOUpN

Avaya 1416 -Available in April. Digital 16-buttonphone for IP Office, Communication Manager and Integral 55

1416 TELSETFOR CM/IE/IPOUpN

Available in the first half of 2010. 32 button module for 1416 digital phone

BUTTON MODFOR 1400SERIES

9504 TELSET FOR IP OFFICE - New 4/12 keys paperless digital phone for IP Office9508 TELSET FOR IP OFFICE - New 8/24 keys paperless digital phone

IP PHONE 9608 - New 8/24 -button LCD-paperless IP-phone. Order Ethernet cable separatelyIP PHONE 9621G - New touch-screen Gigabit IP-phone. Order Ethernet cable separately.IP PHONE 9621G W/O FCPLT - 9621G phone without faceplateIP PHONE 9641G - New touch-screen Gigabit IP-phone with Bluetooth for future use. Order Ethernet cable separately.IP PHONE 9641G W/O FCPLT - 9641G phone without faceplateBUTTON MOD 12B - Button module with 12 paperless keys for 9508, 9608 and 9641GNote: 9508 set will require 1151C (700356447) to power set.Note: 9608 & 9641G sets will require Single port POE Injector (700500725) to power set.IP PHONE SNGL PT POE INJCTR SPPOE-1A - New Power injector for 9608, 9621G and 9641G phone. The current power supplies of the 1151-series cannot be used. Power cord, which is not included, must be ordered separately or obtained elsewhere.

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 61

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of SaleIP OFFICE 96xx IP SETS - Requires IPO release 6.0 or higher

700461197 IP PHONE 9620 LITE WITH CHARCOAL GREY FACEPLATE

700461205

700383938

700461213

700405673

700383920

700419195 IP PHONE 9640G GRY

700462518

700461239 IP PHONE 9620 LITE WITHOUT FACEPLATE IP PHONE 9620L W/O FCPLT

700461247 IP PHONE 9620 COLOR WITHOUT FACEPLATE IP PHONE 9620C W/O FCPLT

700408602 IP PHONE 9630G WITHOUT FACEPLATE IP PHONE 9630G W/O FCPLT

700408610 IP PHONE 9640 W/O FCPLT

700429095 IP PHONE 9640G W/O FCPLT

700408628 IP PHONE 9650 WITHOUT FACEPLATE IP PHONE 9650 W/O FCPLT 700461254 IP PHONE 9650 COLOR WITHOUT FACEPLATE IP PHONE 9650C W/O FCPLT

700462526

700383789

700383870

700383888

700383375 9620/08/11 WALL MNT

IP PHONE 9620L CHARCOAL GRY

IP PHONE 9620 COLOR WITH CHARCOAL GREY FACEPLATE

IP PHONE 9620C CHARCOAL GRY

IP TELEPHONE 9650 AVAYA CHARCOAL GRAY 9650D01A IP PHONE 9650 GRY 9650D01A

IP PHONE 9650 COLOR WITH CHARCOAL GREY FACEPLATE

IP PHONE 9650C CHARCOAL GRY

IP TELEPHONE 9630G AVAYA CHARCOAL GRAY 9630GD01A - The 9630G is ideal for those customers who require 10/100/1,000 Mbps bandwidth to the desktop. And with its built-in Ethernet switch, the 9630G also provides GigE support to a co-located laptop or workstation.

IP PHONE 9630G GRY 9630GD01A

IP TELEPHONE 9640 AVAYA CHARCOAL GRAY 9640D01A IP PHONE 9640 GRY 9640D01A

IP PHONE 9640G CHARCOAL GRAY - The 9640G is ideal for those customers who require 10/100/1,000 Mbps bandwidth to the desktop. And with its built-in Ethernet switch, the 9640G also provides GigE support to a co-located laptop or workstation.IP PHONE BUTTON MODULE FOR 9600 SERIES MODELS GREY

9600 SBM24 BUTTON MOD GRY

IP PHONE 9640 WITHOUT FACEPLATE - The 9640 is shipped without the standard charcoal gray faceplate. This material code is intended for those customers who plan to deploy alternate color faceplates.

IP PHONE 9640G WITHOUT FACEPLATES - The 9640G is shipped without the standard charcoal gray faceplate. This material code is intended for those customers who plan to deploy alternate color faceplates.

IP PHONE BUTTON MODULE FOR 9600 SERIES MODELS WITHOUT FACEPLATE

9600 SBM24 BUTTON MOD W/O FCPLT

IP TELEPHONE BLUETOOTH ADAPTER SBTA -Integrated Bluetooth Adapter for one-X Deskphone Edition IP Telephones seamlessly integrates into the bottom of the 9600 series telephones, providing wireless bluetooth connectivity to other bluetooth enabled communications devices - including 3rd party bluetooth headsets. Note: A wedge stand is required for all 9600 phones when using any adapter - including Gigabit Ethernet.

IP PHONE BLUETOOTH ADPTR SBTA

IP PHONE 9620 WEDGE STAND Wedge stand for 9620 IP Telephone. Replaces the default flip stand which comes standard with the 9620 itself. The Wedge stand places the phone in a more horizontal position, while holding any installed adapters securely to the back of the phone.Note: A wedge stand is required for all 9600 phones when using any adapter - including Gigabit Ethernet.

IP PHONE 9620 WEDGE STAND

IP PHONE 9630/40/50/21/41 WEDGE STAND Wedge stand for 9630, 9640, 9650, 9621,9641 IP Telephones. Replaces the default flip stand which comes standard with the phones themselves. The Wedge stand places the phone in a more horizontal position on the desk, while holding any installed adapters securely to the back of the phone.Note: A wedge stand is required for all 9600 phones when using any adapter - including Gigabit Ethernet.

IP PHONE 9630/40/50 WEDGE STAND

IP PHONE 9620, 9608/11 AND DIGITAL 94XX, 95XX WALL MOUNT

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 62

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of Sale700383383 IP PHONE 9630/40/50 AND 9621/41 WALL MOUNT 9630/40/50/21/41 WALL MNT

700446370 96XX SERIES AMPLIFIED SPEECH HANDSET ROHS

700383771

Faceplates for 96xx series phonesGrey

700430838 FCPLT KIT 9620 GRY W/O LABEL PK25700430846 FCPLT KIT 9630/40 GRY W/O LABEL PK25700430853 FCPLT KIT 9650 GRY W/O LABEL PK25

Yellow700431018 FCPLT KIT 9620 YELLOW PK25700431026 FCPLT KIT 9630/40 YELLOW PK25700431034 FCPLT KIT 9650 YELLOW PK25700431042 FCPLT SBM24 YELLOW PK25

Red700431067 FCPLT KIT 9620 RED PK25700431075 FCPLT KIT 9630/40 RED PK25700431083 FCPLT KIT 9650 BLUE PK25700431091 FCPLT SBM24 RED PK25

Blue700431117 FCPLT KIT 9620 BLUE PK25700431125 FCPLT KIT 9630/40 BLUE PK25700431133 FCPLT KIT 9650 BLUE PK25700431141 FCPLT SBM24 BLUE PK25

Silva700431315 FCPLT KIT 9620 SLV PK25700431323 FCPLT KIT 9630/40 SLV PK25700431331 FCPLT KIT 9650 SLV PK25700431349 FCPLT SBM24 SLV PK25

White700431364 FCPLT KIT 9620 WH PK25700431372 FCPLT KIT 9630/40 WH PK25700431380 FCPLT KIT 9650 WH PK25700431398 FCPLT SBM24 WH PK25

<---- 54xx IP OFFICE DIGITAL SETSIP OFFICE 54xx DIGITAL SETS - Requires IPO release 3.0 or higher

700381981 5402 - RoHS 1-Aug-11

700382005 5410 - RoHS 1-Aug-11

700381627 5420 - RoHS 1-Aug-11

<---- 24xx ACM DIGITAL SETSDEFINITY/ACM DIGITALSETS

700381973 2402 - RoHS

700381999 2410 - RoHS

700381585 2420D - RoHS

<---- Recorder Interface ModuleRecorder Interface Module

700381635

700381650 TELSET MODULE ADAPTER 20B-003 TELSET MOD ADPTR 20B-003

96XX AMPLD SPEECH HANDSET RHS

IP PHONE 9600 GIGABIT ETHERNET ADAPTER - Note: A wedge stand is required for all 9600 phones when using any adapter - including Gigabit Ethernet.

IP PHONE 9600 GIGABIT ETHERNET ADPTR

IPO 5402 DCP TELSET GREY LIC:DS ROHS - Requires IPO release 3.0 or higherIP OFFICE 5410 DCP TELSET GREY LIC:DS ROHS - Requires IPO release 3.0 or higherIPO DCP TELSET 5420 D01A-2001 ROHS LIC:DS - Requires IPO release 3.0 or higher

TELSET 2402D GLOBAL DIGITAL VOICE TERMINAL - Requires IPO release 3.0 or higherTELSET 2410D GLOBAL DIGITAL VOICE TERMINAL - Requires IPO release 3.0 or higherTELSET 2420D GLOBAL DIGITAL VOICE TERMINAL - Requires IPO release 2.0 or higher

The 201B Recorder Interface Module (RIM) is supported for use with 2420 and 5420 phones. It provides the phone with a 3.5mm mini-RCA jack socket for connection of recording devices. It also provides two headset sockets which can be used in place of the phones existing headset socket (the phone and the RIM sockets can not be used at the same time).To install the 201B, the phones existing stand must be removed and be replace by a 20B stand (also called the 20B Module Adapter Base). This is an expanded stand that includes two slots, into one of which the 201B can be inserted. However only one 201B is supported per phone. Use of the 20B and therefore the 201B requires the phone to be powered by a 1151C1 or 1151C2 power supply unit. Full installation instructions are included with the 20B Stand.

TELSET MODULE RECORDER INTERFACE 201B-003

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 63

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of Sale<---- EU24 Expansion Modules

700381817 EU24 - RoHS

<---- 16xx IP OFFICE IP SETS 700476849 IP PHONE 1603-I BLK

700458524 IP PHONE 1603SW-I BLACK IP PHONE 1603SW-I BLK700458532 IP PHONE 1608-I BLACK IP PHONE 1608-I BLK700458540 IP PHONE 1616-I BLACK IP PHONE 1616-I BLK700415573

16XX & 96XX Add-Ons700383326

700436710

700415623

700415631

16XX POWER ACCESSORIES700415607

700451230 POWER ADAPTER FOR 1600 IP PHONES 5V US700451248 POWER ADAPTER FOR 1600 IP PHONES 5V UK700451255 POWER ADAPTER FOR 1600 IP PHONES 5V EU700451263 POWER ADAPTER FOR 1600 IP PHONES 5V ARGENTINA

700451271 POWER ADAPTER FOR 1600 IP PHONES 5V KOREA700451289 POWER ADAPTER FOR 1600 IP PHONES 5V CHINA700451297 POWER ADAPTER FOR 1600 IP PHONES 5V AUSTRALIA

16XX REPLACEMENT PARTS700415581 1600 SERIES BM32 CABLE - REPLACEMENT700415599

700419831

700415664

700415672

700415615

700415714 1608 FLIP STAND - REPLACEMENT700415722 1616 FLIP STAND - REPLACEMENT700432800 1600 SERIES BM32 FLIP STAND - REPLACEMENT700427495

700429707

700383821 9600/1600 SERIES 25' HANDSET CORD (GREY)700446388 16XX SERIES AMPLIFIED SPEECH HANDSET ROHS

EU24 - 1XU-A Expansion module - ROHS for 2420/5420, 4620/5620 and 4621/5621 - Requires IPO release 3.0 or higher or higher

1603-I IP PhoneBLK - Available in APAC in February (Australia/New Zealand in March),EMEA in March, NA & CALA in April

1600 SERIES 32 BUTTON MODULE (BM32) - For 1616 only. Includes bond bridge.

Supported with 4.2 Q4 2008 Maintenance Release

CAT5 ETHERNET CORD (14 FT) For desktop usage of 1600 series phones if CAT5 cord does not exist at desktop already.CAT5 ETHERNET CORD (1FT) - For wall-mounting applications. Optional add-on for 1603 when wall-mounted. Replacement for 1608, 1616 cord included in wall-mount kits.1608 WALL MOUNT KIT - Includes 1 ft Ethernet cord and screws1616 WALL MOUNT KIT - Includes 1 ft Ethernet cord and screws

1603 PoE adapter - Fits inside 1603 wedge stand to add PoE capabilities. No wall plug needed.

1600 SERIES BM32 BOND BRIDGE - REPLACEMENTIncludes screws1603 PLASTIC LABEL COVERS (10) - REPLACEMENTQuantity = 10 pieces (covers 10 phones)1608 PLASTIC LABEL COVERS (10) - REPLACEMENTQuantity = 10 pieces (covers 10 phones)1616 BM32 PLASTIC LABEL COVERS (20) - REPLACEMENTQuantity = 20 pieces (covers 10 1716s or 5 BM32s)1603 WEDGE STAND - REPLACEMENTFor desktop and wall mount configuration. Ethernet cord sold separately.

1600 SERIES HANDSET - REPLACEMENTHandset cord sold separately.1600 SERIES 9' HANDSET CORD - REPLACEMENT (BLACK)

16XX AMPLD SPEECH HANDSET RHS

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 64

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of Sale16XX PAPER LABELS

700415706

700415649

700415656

700434210

700434228

700434236

HEADSETS AND HEADSET ADAPTERS

<---- T3 IP OFFICE DIGITAL SETS (EMEA – select regions only)Requires IPO release 3.1 or higher!

T3 Compact700380264 NA700380298 NA

T3 Classic700380272 NA700380306 NA

T3 Comfort700380280 NA700380314 NA

T3 DSS700380322 NA700380330 NA

T3 DSS Expansion700380348 NA700380355 NA

T3 Headset Link700380363 NA

<---- 3810 Avaya Wireless Telephone700313067 AVAYA 3810/3910 - Battery (1300MAH) BT2499A700313075 AVAYA 3810/3910 - Wall Mount Plate EXP9660

1603 PAPER DESI LABELS - PACKAGE OF 50 LABELS (8.5" x 11")25 sheets, 2 labels per sheet. Covers 50 1703 phones.

1608 PAPER DESI LABELS - PACKAGE OF 50 LABELS (8.5" x 11")25 sheets, 2 labels per sheet. Covers 50 1708 phones.

1616 BM32 PAPER DESI LABELS - PACKAGE OF 50 LABELS (8.5" x 11")25 sheets, 4 labels per sheet. Covers 50 1716 phones (2 per phone) or 25 BM32s (4 per unit)1603 PAPER DESI LABELS - PACKAGE OF 50 LABELS (A4)25 sheets, 2 labels per sheet. Covers 50 1603 phones.

1608 PAPER DESI LABELS - PACKAGE OF 50 LABELS (A4)25 sheets, 2 labels per sheet. Covers 50 1703 phones.

1616 BM32 PAPER DESI LABELS - PACKAGE OF 50 LABELS (A4)25 sheets, 4 labels per sheet. Covers 50 1716 phones (2 per phone) or 25 BM32s (4 per unit)

Click to access the Avaya Headset Wizard

IPO T3 TELSET COMPACT UPN DGTL BLK IPO T3 TELSET COMPACT UPN DGTL WH

IPO T3 TELSET CLASSIC UPN DGTL BLK IPO T3 TELSET CLASSIC UPN DGTL WH

IPO T3 TELSET COMFORT UPN DGTL BLK IPO T3 TELSET COMFORT UPN DGTL WH

IPO T3 TELSET DSS MOD DGTL BLK IPO T3 TELSET DSS MOD DGTL WH

IPO T3 TELSET DSS EXP MOD DGTL BLK IPO T3 TELSET DSS EXP MOD DGTL WH

IPO T3 HEADSET LINK

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 65

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of Sale<----

700471121 3920 Wireless Telephone

700501144 3920 Wireless Telephone w/Repeater Package

700501142

<---- 36XX Avaya IP Wireless 3641 Handsets

700430408700430481 AWTS HANDSET 3641 BELT CLIP700430499 AWTS HANDSET 3641 SWIVEL BELT CLIP700430507 AWTS HANDSET BELT CLIP FOR 3641700430523 AWTS SWIVEL CASE 3641 BLK W/KYPD CVR

3645 Handsets700430416700430515 AWTS HANDSET 3645 SWIVEL BELT CLIP700430556 AWTS SWIVEL CASE 3645 BLK W/KYPD CVR

3641/3645 Handset Accessories700430424 AWTS SINGLE CHRGR FOR 3641/3645700430432 AWTS DUAL CHRGR FOR 3641/3645700430440 AWTS QUAD CHRGR FOR 3641/3645700480957 AWTS 3624x PWR SUPP QUAD CHRGR GLOB700430457 AWTS BATTERY STD FOR 3641/3645700430465 AWTS BATTERY EXTD FOR 3641/3645700430473 AWTS BATTERY ULTRA FOR 3641/3645700430549 AWTS CASE 3641/3645 RUGGED HOLSTER700430572 AWTS CORD LANYARD W/QUICK DISCONNECT700430580 AWTS COILED LANYARD W/CLOTHING CLIP700430622 AWTS USB CBL 464x DUAL CHARGER

Processors/Rack Mount/Chargers/AVPP PowerAVPP

700413164 AWTS NETLINK AVPP 10 RHS AVPP10 (Max.. 10 Users) SVP011A

700413172 AWTS NETLINK AVPP 20 RHS AVPP20 (Max.. 20 Users) SVP021A

700413073 AWTS NETLINK VCE PRIORITY SRVR AVPP 100 RHS SVP101ARack Mount Kit

700412976 AWTS RACK MNT KIT RHS MKR151Phone Chargers Power Supply

700480932 AWTS BATTERY CHARGER PWR SUPP (N.A.) 700480940

AVPP PWR SUP700480965

3920 Avaya Wireless Telephone - PARTNERâ Version OnlyAVAYA 3920 WIRELESS PHONEAVAYA 3920 WIRELESS PHONE AND REPEATER

3920 RepeaterThe new wireless repeater replaces the current repeater. It is compatible with the existing 3920 wireless handset and provides:• Smaller size• Weatherproof housing• Easier setup without any special tools

AVAYA 3920 WIRELESS REPEATER

A range of accessories and spare parts for this phone can be ordered directly on-line at the following WEB-page of our product Partner. They are not available through AVAYA:

www.unidendirect.com/avayaAccessories include headset, leather carrying case, spare power adapters, batteries and chargers as well as paper labels and plastic covers.

AWTS 3641 WRLS PHONE

AWTS 3645 WRLS PHONE

AWTS BATTERY CHARGER PWR SUPP INTEURO RHS , UK HK RHS, AUST NZ

AWTS AVPP PWR SUPP GLOBN.A., CONT EURO RHS, UK HK RHS, AUST NZ

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 66

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of Sale<---- 37xx IP DECT Wireless R4

Handsets374x Handsets

700479454 DECT 3740 HANDSET - Ruggedized DECT Handset700479462 DECT 3749 HANDSET - Intrinsically Safe DECT handset

372x Handsets700466105 DECT 3720 HANDSET

700466139 DECT 3725 HANDSET

Basic Charger374x Basic Charger

700500871

700479470

700500872

700500873

372x Basic Charger700500011

700500012

700500013

700500014

700466253

700466261

Advanced Cradle Charger374x Advanced Charger

700500875

700479488

700500874

700500876

700500877

700500878

372x Advanced Charger700466295

700466279

700466287

700466303

Six Handset Charger

Avaya 3720 DECT handset (BW display, four way navigation key, half duplex speaker phone, 2.5mm wired headset connector), standard belt clip, battery pack include, charger not includedAvaya 3725 DECT handset (Color display, five way navigation key, half duplex speaker phone, 2.5mm wired headset connector, BlueTooth headset interface, text message support, additional side keys for volume and mute), standard belt clip, battery pack included, charger not included

DECT 374x HANDSET BASIC CHARGER KIT UK/NAR/AUSTRALIA - Basic Charger (374x handsets) for UK, North America, AustraliaDECT 374x HANDSET BASIC CHARGER KIT EUROPEAN - Basic Charger (374x handsets) for countries using the “EU-Style” connectorDECT 374x HANDSET BASIC CHRGR MX - Basic Charger (374x handsets) for MexicoDECT 374x HANDSET BASIC CHRGR AR - Basic Charger (374x handsets) for Argentina

DECT HANDSET BASIC CHARGER MEXICO - Basics Handset Charger for 372x handsets for MexicoDECT HANDSET BASIC CHARGER ARGENTINA - Basics Handset Charger for 372x handsets for Argentina

DECT HANDSET ADVANCED CHARGER KIT BRAZIL/MEXICO - Advanced Handset Charger for 372x handsets for Brasil and MexicoDECT HANDSET ADVANCED CHARGER KIT ARGENTINA - Advanced Handset Charger for 372x handsets for ArgentinaCharger cradle for one DECT handset (3720 and 3725 are both possible), Western European power supply included

DECT HANDSET BASIC CHRGR EU

Charger cradle for one DECT handset (3720 and 3725 are both possible), universal power supply for United Kingdom, North America and Australia included

DECT HANDSET BASIC CHRGR UK/NAR/AU

DECT 374x HANDSET ADVANCED CHARGER KIT NORTH AMERICA REGION - Advanced Charger (374x handsets) for the North American RegionDECT 374x HANDSET ADVANCED CHARGER KIT EUROPEAN - Advanced Charger (374x handsets) for countries using the “EU-Style” connectorDECT 374x HANDSET ADV CHRGR UK - Advanced Charger (374x handsets) for the United KindgomDECT 374x HANDSET ADV CHRGR AU - Advanced Charger (374x handsets) for the AustraliaDECT 374x HANDSET ADV CHRGR BR MX - Advanced Charger (374x handsets) for Brasil and MexicoDECT 374x HANDSET ADV CHRGR AR - Advanced Charger (374x handsets) for Argentina

Same as 700466279 DECT HANDSET ADV CHRGR KIT EU but with power supply for North America

DECT HANDSET ADV CHRGR KIT NAR

Charging cradle for one DECT handset (3720 and 3725 are both possible), contains also a USB connector and an Ethernet connector to use the charger for phone configuration either with a PC attached via standard USB cable or using the centralized management offered by the AIWS server via Ethernet

DECT HANDSET ADV CHRGR KIT EU

Same as 700466279 DECT HANDSET ADV CHRGR KIT EU but with power supply for United Kingdom

DECT HANDSET ADV CHRGR KIT UK

Same as 700466279 DECT HANDSET ADV CHRGR KIT EU but with power supply for Australia

DECT HANDSET ADV CHRGR KIT AU

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 67

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of Sale374x Rackmount Charger

700479496

372x Rackmount Charger700466311

Multi Battery Charger374x Multi Battery Charger

700479504

372x Multi Battery Charger700466329

374X Headsets and Adapters700479512

700500879

700479520

700479538

Spare Battery700500841

700500842

700500843

700466683 Additional battery pack for 3720 handset

700466691 Additional battery pack for 3725 handset

Leather Case700479546

Belt Clip700479553

700479561

700466568 Spare basic belt clip for 3720 and 3725 handset

700466337 Swivel belt clip for 3720 and 3725 handset

DECT 374x HANDSET RACKMOUNT CHARGER KIT - 374x rack-mount charger

Charger to charge six DECT handsets (3720 and 3725 are both possible), contains also a USB connector and an Ethernet connector to use the charger for phone configuration either with a PC attached via standard USB cable or using the centralized management offered by the AIWS server via Ethernet, up to four Rack mount Chargers can be serially connected to the same power source with Ethernet pull through possible, universal power supply for Western Europe, United Kingdom, North America and Australia included

DECT HANDSET RACKMOUNT CHRGR KIT

DECT 374x MULTIPLE BATTERY CHARGER KIT -374x multi-battery charger

Charger to charge six 3725 battery packs (not usable for 3720 battery packs), universal power supply for Western Europe, United Kingdom, North America and Australia included

DECT MULT BATTERY CHRGR KIT

DECT 374x HEADSET MICROPHONE ON BOOM - Headset for 374x with Microphone on the BoomDECT 374x HEADSET ADAPTER QD - QD- Headset Adapter for 374xDECT 374x HEADSET INDUSTRY - Industrial Headset for 374xDECT 374x HEADSET ADAPTER INDUSTRY AND ATEX - Headset Adapter for 374x

DECT 3740 HANDSET BATTERY PACK - Spare Battery Pack for 3740 handsetsDECT 3749 HANDSET BATTERY PACK - Spare Battery Pack for 3740 handsetsDECT 3749 BATTERY PACK OPENER - Battery pack opener for 3749 handsets (special tool required due to intrinsically safe design)

DECT 3720 HANDSET BATTERY PKDECT 3725 HANDSET BATTERY PK

DECT HANDSET LEATHER CASE 374x - Leather Case for 374x handsets

DECT 374x HANDSET BASIC BELT CLIP - Basic Belt-Clip for 374x HandsetsDECT 374x HANDSET SWIVEL BELT CLIP - Swivel Belt-Clip for 374x Handsets

DECT HANDSET BASIC BELT CLIPDECT HANDSET SWIVEL BELT CLIP

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 68

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of SaleIndoor Radio Station

700480080

700466394 DECT IP RBS W/INT ANTNA

Outdoor Radio Station700466402 DECT IP RBS W/EXTL ANTNA

Radio Base Station Power Supply700466436 DECT RBS PWR SUPP UK

700466444 DECT RBS PWR SUPP EU

700466451 DECT RBS PWR SUPP US

700466469 DECT RBS PWR SUPP AU

Housing for Outdoor Radio Base Station700466477

RSB Antennas700466576

700466535

700466543

700466550

RSB Pole & Mounting Bracket700466063 DECT RBS POLE MNTG KIT

700466071 DECT RBS BRACKET KIT 10PK

DECT IP RBS COMPACT IP OFFICE NA, EMEA, APACIP Office Release 6.0 supports lower cost/functionality base-stations for the IP Office DECT R4 system released with IP Office 5.0. The compact base station, which is exactly the same size as the current DECT R4 base station, supports a maximum of 4 channels per base station with a maximum of 5 base stations being supported per IP Office.Standard and Compact base stations may be mixed as long as no more than 5 compact base stations are installed.

Indoor IP radio base station with internal antenna for usage with CM and IP Office only, requires external power either via separately purchased power adapter or via Power over Ethernet, for outdoor usage separate outdoor housing has to be bought separately

Indoor IP radio base station with external antenna for usage with CM and IP Office only, two standard Omni-directional antennas included, usage not allowed in the US and Canada, requires external power either via separately purchased power adapter or via Power over Ethernet, for outdoor usage separate outdoor housing has to be bought separately

Power supply for IP and ISDN radio base stations for Western Europe, only needed if Power over Ethernet is not usedPower supply for IP and ISDN radio base stations for United Kingdom, only needed if Power over Ethernet is not usedPower supply for IP and ISDN radio base stations for North America, only needed if Power over Ethernet is not usedPower supply for IP and ISDN radio base stations for Australia, only needed if Power over Ethernet is not used

Outdoor housing for all IP and ISDN radio base stations with feed-through for data and power cable (if external power supply is used), does not have heating or lightning protection

DECT RBS OUTDOOR HOUSING

10 standard standard Omni-directional antennas (only needed as spare parts, IP and ISDN radio base stations with external antennas have two of these antennas included), usage not allowed in the US and Canada

DECT RBS STD ANTNA KIT 10PK

Directional dual antenna for usage with IP and ISDN radio base stations, usage not allowed in the US and Canada

DECT RBS DIRECTIONAL DUAL ANTNA

Directional single antenna for usage with IP and ISDN radio base stations, usage not allowed in the US and Canada

DECT RBS DIRECTIONAL SNGL ANTNA

Omni-directional single antenna for usage with IP and ISDN radio base stations, usage not allowed in the US and Canada

DECT RBS OMNIDIRECTIONAL DUAL ANTNA

Mounting kit for mounting the outdoor housing on a pole with a circumference of up to 750 mm 10 mounting brackets for IP and ISDN radio base stations (only needed as spare parts, all IP and ISDN radio base stations have one bracket included)

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 69

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of SaleSite Survey Kits

700466089 EMEA Site Survey Kit DECT SITE SURVEY KIT EMEA

700466097 NAR Site Survey Kit DECT SITE SURVEY KIT NAR

700471501 DECT SITE SURVEY KIT SPARE BATTERY

700471519 DECT SITE SURVEY KIT SPARE CHARGER

Server Licensing700501480700466493 DECT AIWS BASIC 7-Nov-11

700477466 DECT AIWS BASIC+ 7-Nov-11

700471527 DECT AIWS STD 7-Nov-11

700471535 DECT AIWS OAP 7-Nov-11

700471543 DECT AIWS ENTPRS MGMT 7-Nov-11

AIWS Power Supply700471550 DECT AIWS SPR PSU (UNI) 7-Nov-11

Handset Carry Case700471576 Leather carry case for the 3720 handset

700471584 Leather carry case for the 3725 handset

SARI Certificate700471568 DECT SARI CERTIFICATE

Spare Headset connector Plugs700471592

<---- 62xx Avaya ANALOG SETSAvaya 6200 Analog Telephone (North America)

6211700287642700287667

6219700058662

6221700287717700287758

DECT SITE SURVEY KIT SPR BATTERYDECT SITE SURVEY KIT SPR CHRGR

DECT AVAYA INBUILDING WIRELESS SERVER BASIC - Server hardware plus preinstalled set of licenses (see details in product description), universal power supply for Western Europe, United Kingdom, North America and Australia includedDECT AVAYA INBUILDING WIRELESS SERVER BASIC+ Server hardware plus preinstalled set of licenses (see details in product description), universal power supply for Western Europe, United Kingdom, North America and Australia includedDECT AVAYA INBUILDING WIRELESS SERVER STANDARD - Server hardware plus preinstalled set of licenses (see details in product description), universal power supply for Western Europe, United Kingdom, North America and Australia includedDECT AVAYA INBUILDING WIRELESS SERVER OPEN APPLICATION PROTOCOL - Server hardware plus preinstalled set of licenses (see details in product description), universal power supply for Western Europe, United Kingdom, North America and Australia includedDECT AVAYA INBUILDING WIRELESS SERVER ENTERPRISE MANAGEMENT - Server hardware plus preinstalled set of licenses (see details in product description), universal power supply for Western Europe, United Kingdom, North America and Australia included

DECT AVAYA INBUILDING WIRELESS SERVER SPARE UNIVERSAL PSU - Universal power supply for Western Europe, United Kingdom, North America and Australia for AIWS server

DECT HANDSET LEATHER CASE 3720DECT HANDSET LEATHER CASE 3725

DECT SARI CERTIFICATE - SARI (Secondary Access Rights Identifier) printed on paper, unique identifier needed once per DECT installation, can be use for multiple sites within one installation

DECT 372x SPARE HEADSET PLUG 5 PACK -5 spare plugs to cover the headset connector of the 3720 and 3725

DECT 372x SPR HEADSET PLUG 5PK

TELSET ANALOG 6211 GLOBAL WHITETELSET ANLG 6211 GLOBAL GRY

TELSET 6219 GRAY ANALOG USA - FCC ENGLISH

TELSET ANALOG 6221 GLOBAL WHITETELSET ANLG 6221 GLOBAL GRY

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 70

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of Sale<---- Interquartz Gemini Analog Phones (EMEA and APAC)

<---- Replacement and Specialty Handsets 16xx Series

700446388 1600 Amplified Speech Handset- RoHS

700427495 1600 SERIES HANDSET - REPLACEMENT

700410004 HANDSET REPLACEMENT AK1D DARK GRAY ROHS AK1D-1001 700229727700229735700229743

108216177

407327170 2523A <---- Replacement Long Handset Cords

Handset Cords - 24XX, 46XX, 54XX and 56XX 108004359 Handset Cords 9ft Gray H4DU108004367 Handset Cords 12ft Gray H4DU

<---- Power for IP Hard Phones1151x Stand alone Power Adapters

Without Battery Back-Up700434897

700356447

With Battery Back-Up700434905

700356454

Country Power Cords405362641 US Plug (15A, 120V) 17505407786623 Europe Plug (10A) 12013S407786599 UK Plug (10A) 14012407786631 Australia/NZ (10A) Plug 15012407790591 India Plug (10A) SPC-P250CIM408161453 Argentina

9330-AV offers incredible value for money without compromising on quality. Its stylish new design and rugged build quality are sure to make it a popular choice for buyers on a limited budget.9335-AV offers a whole host of benefits to business users and homeworkers including Caller ID, handsfree and headset compatibility, all for a very reasonable price.9281 AV - A dedicated hotel guest-room handset for the IP Office

To order these phones, please contact your local authorised Interquartz distributor, or Interquartz.Interquartz (UK) Ltd, Pennine House, Salford Street,BURY, Lancashire, BL9 6YA, United Kingdom.Tel: +44 (0)161 763 3122 Fax: +44 (0)161 763 4029Email: [email protected]: www.interquartz.co.uk

Amplified Handset for 1600 Series PhonesHandset cord sold separately.

2400 Series, 4601, 4602, 4610, 4620, PARTNER® refresh(6D, 18D & 34D), 5400s & 5600s use the same as 2400s and 4600s

Push-to-Talk - Dark Gray AK5A-1001 Amplified VARIABLE VOLUME - Dark Gray AK6A-1001 Noisy Location - Dark Gray AK8A-1001 6400 Series, 6200 Series, 302D, 4606, 4612, 4624, 4630, 44xx series, PARTNER® ETR(7311*, 7515*) HANDSET BLACK 150 OHM AB1C-003 2500, 2554, 8100 Series, 8400 Series, 8500 Series Amplified Hearing Handset-Black

Note: The stand alone Power Supply is required for Digital sets when used inconjuction with XM24 or EU24 expansion adjuncts.The 1151C1/C2 can be used on Digital sets, the 1151D1/D2 can not be used on digital sets.The 1151D1, 1151D2, 1151C1 and 1151C2 products will include a CAT5 cable. However, the old 1151B1 and 1151B2 included a standard North American power cord which is not included anymore (must be ordered separately or obtained elsewhere).

POWER SUPPLY 1151D1 TERMINAL POWER WITH CAT 5 CABLE - For IP Hard Phone and not Digital Set and requires appropriate power cordPOWER SUPPLY 1151C1 TERMINAL POWER WITH CAT 5 CABLE - For IP Hard Phone or Digital Set and requires appropriate power cord

POWER SUPPLY 1151D2 TERMINAL POWER WITH BATTERY AND CAT 5 CABLE - For IP Hard Phone and not Digital Set and requires appropriate power cordPOWER SUPPLY 1151C2 TERMINAL POWER WITH BATTERY AND CAT 5 CABLE - For IP Hard Phone or Digital Set and requires appropriate power cord

9. MODELS & ORDERING CODES

document.xls Page 71

SAP Code Description Model NPL End of Sale<---- Integrated Management for IP Office

205701

<---- Gigabit AdapterGigabit Ethernet Adapter

700383771 IP PHONE 9600 GIGABIT ETHERNET ADAPTER

Avaya Integrated Management for IP Office works with Avaya IP Office Manager to provide a complete management solution for enterprises with distributed IP Office deployments. Designed for retailers, financial firms and other enterprises that deploy groups of locations with similarly configured hardware and dial plans, Avaya Integrated Management can significantly reduce total cost of operations by centralizing management for key ongoing management, provisioning, and maintenance tasks.* Note: Only supported with IP Office Release 4.1 and AIM 4.1. AIM 5.2.1 (scheduled for Nov 2009) will support IP Office 5.0)

Integrated Management for IP Office - 250 licenses Avaya Integrated Management for IP Office for up to 250 sites

INTGR MGMT NETWORK MANAGEMENT 250 IP OFFICE SYSTEMS LIC:DS

IP PHONE 9600 GIGABIT ETHERNET ADPTR

10. DISCONTINUED MODELS

document.xls Page 72

SAP Code Description Model End of Sale

<---- R6 Upgrade Licenses<---- IP Office 500 RFAs<---- IP 400 Base Modules

AVAYA™ IP OFFICE PRODUCT LINE LIST

10. DISCONTINUED MODELS

document.xls Page 73

SAP Code Description Model End of Sale<---- Internal Daughter Cards, Interface Cards and PCMCIA card

10. DISCONTINUED MODELS

document.xls Page 74

SAP Code Description Model End of Sale<---- IP 400 Expansion Modules<---- IPO 500 Control Unit, Modules and Cards<---- IPO Small Office Edition Expansion Options

10. DISCONTINUED MODELS

document.xls Page 75

SAP Code Description Model End of Sale<---- IP Office Applications, Feature Keys & CDs

10. DISCONTINUED MODELS

document.xls Page 76

SAP Code Description Model End of Sale<---- Customer Call Reporter (CCR)<---- 60 Day Free ApplicationTry-It-Buy-It License RFA

10. DISCONTINUED MODELS

document.xls Page 77

SAP Code Description Model End of Sale<---- Avaya Unified Communications for Small Business<---- DEMO Kits<---- SoftConsole Remote Feature Activation (RFA) Licenses

10. DISCONTINUED MODELS

document.xls Page 78

SAP Code Description Model End of Sale<---- 40 User Vertical Pack Bundle

10. DISCONTINUED MODELS

document.xls Page 79

SAP Code Description Model End of Sale<---- <---- <----

80 User Vertical Pack Bundle Remote Voice Access to Data S/W Pack Bundle Contact Center S/W Pack Bundle

10. DISCONTINUED MODELS

document.xls Page 80

SAP Code Description Model End of Sale<---- <---- Embedded Voicemail<---- Voicemail & VoiceMail Pro License RFA<---- Conferencing Center License RFA<---- Phone Manager License RFA

Productivity S/W Pack Bundle

10. DISCONTINUED MODELS

document.xls Page 81

SAP Code Description Model End of Sale<---- VPN Phone Software License RFA<---- 3 Rd Party End Points License RFA<---- CBC & CCC License RFA

10. DISCONTINUED MODELS

document.xls Page 82

SAP Code Description Model End of Sale<---- MS-CRM RFA<---- WiFi Access Point, MS-CRM & VPN Licence RFA<---- Rack Mounts, Barrier Box, Cables & Physical Wallboards

10. DISCONTINUED MODELS

document.xls Page 83

SAP Code Description Model End of Sale<---- Power Supplies and Leads<---- Mobility License RFA (Previously Mobile Twinning)<---- IP OFFICE 54xx DIGITAL SETS<---- 44xx Merlin Magix DIGITAL SETS<---- 24xx ACM DIGITAL SETS<---- 64xx ACM DIGITAL SETS

10. DISCONTINUED MODELS

document.xls Page 84

SAP Code Description Model End of Sale<---- IP OFFICE 56xx IP SETS<---- 46xx ACM IP SETS<---- EU24 Expansion Modules

10. DISCONTINUED MODELS

document.xls Page 85

SAP Code Description Model End of Sale<---- 16xx IP OFFICE IP SETS <---- 3810 Avaya Wireless Telephone<---- TransTalk 9040

10. DISCONTINUED MODELS

document.xls Page 86

SAP Code Description Model End of Sale<---- Avaya 36XX IP Wireless

10. DISCONTINUED MODELS

document.xls Page 87

SAP Code Description Model End of Sale<---- 37xx IP DECT Wireless

10. DISCONTINUED MODELS

document.xls Page 88

SAP Code Description Model End of Sale<---- Recorder Interface Module<---- Replacement and Specialty Handsets <---- Replacement Long Handset Cords

10. DISCONTINUED MODELS

document.xls Page 89

SAP Code Description Model End of Sale<---- Power for IP Hard Phones<---- Integrated Management for IP Office

10. DISCONTINUED MODELS

document.xls Page 90

SAP Code Description Model End of Sale<---- Gigabit Adapter<---- CSU/DSU and Cables

11. IPO LICENSE DESCRIPTIONS

document.xls Page 91

IP Office License DescriptionsDescription Type Category Action

IP Office Upgrade License262645 IPO LIC UPG R7.0 SML System Toggle

262644 IPO LIC UPG R7.0 SML System Toggle

262695 IPO LIC UPG R6.1 SML System Toggle

262694 IPO LIC UPG R6.1 System Toggle

229421 IPO LIC UPG R6.0 SML System Toggle

229420 IPO LIC UPG R6.0 System Toggle

IP Office Group Collaboration Licenses171991 System Toggle

227043 System Toggle

229424 System Toggle

Essential Edition Additional Voicemail Ports License (IP500 V2 only)229423 IPO LIC R6 ESSNTL EDITION ADD 2 System Cumulative

Material Code

Upgrading IP500 from R4.0 through R6.1 or IP500V2 from R6.1 to Release 7.0 – up to 32 users. Single control unit with no external expansion modules.Upgrading from R5 or earlier to Release 7.0 – more than 32 users and/or external expansion module(s).Upgrading IP500 from R4.0 through R6.0 or IP500V2 from R6.0 to Release 6.1 – up to 32 users. Single control unit with no external expansion modules.Upgrading from R5 or earlier to Release 6 – more than 32 users and/or external expansion module(s).Upgrading IP500V1 only from R4.0 to R5.0 to Release 6 – up to 32 users. Single control unit with no external expansion modules.

Upgrading from R5 or earlier to Release 6 – more than 32 users and/or external expansion module(s).

R5 and higher Preferred Edition: IPO LIC PREFRD (VM PRO) RFA LIC:DS

Enables 4 ports of VoiceMail Pro, advanced messaging, multi-level automated attendant, secure meet-me conferencing call recording, conditional call routing,Text to Speech (TTS) for e-mail reading for users with appropriate User profiles and· queue announcements

R5 Only Advanced Edition: IPO LIC R6 ADV EDITION RFA LIC:DS

Enables IP Office Customer Call Reporting (CCR 1 Supervisor), ContactStore Call Recording Library, Interactive Voice Response (IVR) with external databases, Visual Basic Scripting, 8 ports of Text-to-Speech (TTS) to allow database queries using IVR to be read over the phone. The Advanced Edition needs a valid Preferred Edition license as a pre-requisite to run.

R6 and higher Advanced Edition: IPO LIC R6 ADV EDITION RFA LIC:DS

Enables IP Office Customer Call Reporting (CCR 1 Supervisor), ContactStore Call Recording Library, Interactive Voice Response (IVR) with external databases, Visual Basic Scripting, 8 ports of Text-to-Speech (TTS) to allow database queries using IVR to be read over the phone. The Advanced Edition needs a valid Preferred Edition license as a pre-requisite to run.

Release 6 onwards each IP500 V2 system supports Essential Edition by default with 2 ports of voicemail enabled. This can be expanded up to 6 channels through licenses in steps of two.

11. IPO LICENSE DESCRIPTIONS

document.xls Page 92

MOBILE WORKER - R6 and Higher229434 IPO LIC R6 MOBILE WORKER 1 User Each User

229435 IPO LIC R6 MOBILE WORKER 5 User Each User

229436 IPO LIC R6 MOBILE WORKER 20 User Each User

MOBILE WORKER - R5 Only195569 IPO LIC MOBILE WORKER RFA 1 User Each User Renaming of Mobile Twinning, each user has 1 license for 3rd party TTS

195570 IPO LIC MOBILE WORKER RFA 5 User Each User Renaming of Mobile Twinning, each user has 5 license for 3rd party TTS

195572 IPO LIC MOBILE WORKER RFA 20 User Each User Renaming of Mobile Twinning, each user has 20 license for 3rd party TTS

OFFICE WORKER - R6 and Higher229438 IPO LIC R6 OFF WORKER RFA 1 User Each User

229439 IPO LIC R6 OFF WORKER RFA 5 User Each User

229440 IPO LIC R6 OFF WORKER RFA 20 User Each User

TELEWORKER - R6 and Higher227047 IPO LIC TELE WORKER RFA 1 User Each User

227054 IPO LIC TELE WORKER RFA 5 User Each User

227057 IPO LIC TELE WORKER RFA 20 User Each User

TELEWORKER - R5 only227047 IPO LIC TELE WORKER RFA 1 User Each User

227054 IPO LIC TELE WORKER RFA 5 User Each User

227057 IPO LIC TELE WORKER RFA 20 User Each User

1 User enabling Mobility including Mobile Twinning, Mobile Call Control and one-X Mobile Client support and 3rd party Text-to-Speech (TTS)

5 Users enabling Mobility including Mobile Twinning, Mobile Call Control and one-X Mobile Client support and 3rd party Text-to-Speech (TTS)

20 Users enabling Mobility including Mobile Twinning, Mobile Call Control and one-X Mobile Client support and 3rd party Text-to-Speech (TTS)

1 User enabling one-X Portal for IP Office (with Telecommuter mode disabled) and Unified Messaging Service (web and email access to voicemail)5 Users enabling one-X Portal for IP Office (with Telecommuter mode disabled) and Unified Messaging Service (web and email access to voicemail)20 Users enabling one-X Portal for IP Office (with Telecommuter mode disabled) and Unified Messaging Service (web and email access to voicemail)

1 User enabling a user to use one-X Portal for IP Office, Unified Messaging Service (web and email access to voicemail) and IP Office Video Softphone.

5 Users enabling them to use one-X Portal for IP Office, Unified Messaging Service (web and email access to voicemail) and IP Office Video Softphone.

20 Users enabling them to use one-X Portal for IP Office, Unified Messaging Service (web and email access to voicemail) and IP Office Video Softphone.

1 User enabling a user to use the VPN phone, Phone Manager Pro and one-X Portal for IP Office.5 Users enabling a user to use the VPN phone, Phone Manager Pro and one-X Portal for IP Office.20 Users enabling a user to use the VPN phone, Phone Manager Pro and one-X Portal for IP Office.

11. IPO LICENSE DESCRIPTIONS

document.xls Page 93

Power User - R6 and Higher229426 IPO LIC R6 PWR USER 1 User Each User

229427 IPO LIC R6 PWR USER 5 User Each User

229428 IPO LIC R6 PWR USER 20 User Each User

Power User - R5 only227047 IPO LIC R6 PWR USER 1 User Each User

227054 IPO LIC R6 PWR USER 5 User Each User

227057 IPO LIC R6 PWR USER 20 User Each User

RECEPTIONIST171987 IPO LIC RECEPTIONIST RFA 1 LIC:DS User Cumulative

Customer Service Agent217650 IPO LIC CUSTMR SVC AGT RFA 1 LIC:CU User Each User Adds one CCR agent to the system217651 IPO LIC CUSTMR SVC AGT RFA 5 LIC:CU User Each User Adds 5 more CCR agent to the system217653 IPO LIC CUSTMR SVC AGT RFA 20 LIC:CU User Each User Adds 20 more CCR agent to the system

Customer Service Supervisor - R6 and Higher229442 IPO LIC R6 CUSTMR SVC SPV 1 System Cumulative

Customer Service Supervisor - R5 Only217655 IPO LIC CUSTMR SVC SPV RFA 1 LIC:CU System Cumulative Adds one CCR supervisor to the system217656 IPO LIC CUSTMR SVC SPV RFA 10 LIC:CU System Cumulative Adds 10 more CCR supervisor to the system217657 IPO LIC CUSTMR SVC SPV RFA 20 LIC:CU System Cumulative Adds 20 more CCR supervisor to the system

CCC to CCR Migration217658 IPO LIC CUSTMR CUSTMR CALL REPORTER UPG LIC System Toggle

Phone Manager177468 IPO LIC IP400 PMGR PRO RFA 1 LIC:CU User Each User Enables 1 user to access Phone Manager Pro

1 User enabling use one-X Portal for IP Office and the IP Office Video Softphone. UMS functionality for voicemail/email integration is also enabled, providing synchronization with any IMAP e-mail client (this requires Preferred Edition).5 Users enabling use one-X Portal for IP Office and the IP Office Video Softphone. UMS functionality for voicemail/email integration is also enabled, providing synchronization with any IMAP e-mail client (this requires Preferred Edition).20 Users enabling use one-X Portal for IP Office and the IP Office Video Softphone. UMS functionality for voicemail/email integration is also enabled, providing synchronization with any IMAP e-mail client (this requires Preferred Edition).

1 User enabling a user with everything in Teleworker and Mobile Worker PLUS Unified Messaging (UMS) and PC softphone5 Users enabling a user with everything in Teleworker and Mobile Worker PLUS Unified Messaging (UMS) and PC softphone20 Users enabling a user with everything in Teleworker and Mobile Worker PLUS Unified Messaging (UMS) and PC softphone

Enables the 1instance of the receptionist - Note with release R7.0 this license is now Cumulative.

This supervisor license enables a supervisor to use IP Office Customer Call Reporter

This upgrade license will convert ALL Compact Contact Center (CCC) licenses to Customer Call Reporter (CCR). This includes all supervisors and agents.

11. IPO LICENSE DESCRIPTIONS

document.xls Page 94

171992 IPO LIC PMGR SFTPHN RFA 1 LIC:CU User Each User Enables 1 user to use the Phone Manager SoftPhone

Additonal VoiceMail Pro Ports174459 IPO LIC IP400 VM PRO RFA 2 LIC:CU System Cumulative Adds 2 more ports to VoiceMail Pro174460 IPO LIC IP400 VM PRO RFA 4 LIC:CU System Cumulative Adds 4 more ports to VoiceMail Pro174461 IPO LIC IP400 VM PRO RFA 8 LIC:CU System Cumulative Adds 8 more ports to VoiceMail Pro174462 IPO LIC IP400 VM PRO RFA 16 LIC:CU System Cumulative Adds 16 more ports to VoiceMail Pro

UMS Web Services Licenses217880 IPO LIC VMPRO UMS 1USER User Each User

217881 IPO LIC VMPRO UMS 5 USER User Each User

217883 IPO LIC VMPRO UMS 20 USER User Each User

VoiceMail Pro Add-ons182297 IPO LIC IP400 NTWKD MSGING RFA LIC:DS System Toggle

187166 IPO LIC CONTACTSTORE RFA LIC:DS System Toggle Enables the use of ContactStore for recordings management182298 IPO LIC IP400 3RD PRTY IVR RFA LIC:DS System Cumulative

182299 IPO LIC IP400 AVAYA TTS RFA 1 LIC:CU System Cumulative

IP500 Universal PRI Additional Channel Licenses215180 IPO LIC IP500 T1 ADD 2CH System Cumulative Enables 2 more channels on the IP500 T1 interface215181 IPO LIC IP500 T1 ADD 8CH System Cumulative Enables 8 more channels on the IP500 T1 interface215182 IPO LIC IP500 T1 ADD 32CH System Cumulative Enables 32 more channels on the IP500 dual T1 interface215183 IPO LIC IP500 E1 ADD 2CH System Cumulative Enables 2 more channels on the IP500 E1 PRI interface215184 IPO LIC IP500 E1 ADD 8CH System Cumulative Enables 8 more channels on the IP500 E1 PRI interface215185 IPO LIC IP500 E1 ADD 22CH System Cumulative Enables 22 more channels on the IP500 E1 PRI interface215186 IPO LIC IP500 E1R2 ADD 2CH System Cumulative Enables 2 more channels on the IP500 E1R2 interface215187 IPO LIC IP500 E1R2 ADD 8CH System Cumulative Enables 8 more channels on the IP500 E1R2 interface215188 IPO LIC IP500 E1R2 ADD 22CH System Cumulative Enables 22 more channels on the IP500 E1R2 interface

IP500 Voice Compression Module Licenses - R4.0 to R5.0202961 IPO LIC IP500 VCM LIC 4 CH System Cumulative Adds 4 more VCM channels to the VCM32 or VCM64 cards

IP500 Voice Networking Licenses205650 IPO LIC IP500 VCE NTWKG ADD 4 LIC:CU System Cumulative

Enables IMAP email client and web browser integration with VoiceMail Pro for 1 userEnables IMAP email client and web browser integration with VoiceMail Pro for 5 usersEnables IMAP email client and web browser integration with VoiceMail Pro for 20 users

Enables VoiceMail Pro to exchange messages with other Avaya voicemail systems

Enables VoiceMail Pro to work with a 3rd party data base for Interactive Voice Response.Enables VoiceMail Pro to offer a Text-to-Speech using the Avaya library, each sesion being a service that can be used by many users but only one session per user at a time

Enables the IP500 to connect to other systems using H.323 or SCN (using up to 4 concurrent connections for outbound calls) or Q.sig (unlimited outbound calls). Four (4) additional concurrent connections can be added this this same license.

11. IPO LICENSE DESCRIPTIONS

document.xls Page 95

SIP TRUNKING202967 IPO LIC SIP TRNK RFA 1 System Cumulative Enables 1 SIP trunk on the IP Office Ethernet port202968 IPO LIC SIP TRNK RFA 5 System Cumulative Enables 5 SIP trunks on the IP Office Ethernet port202969 IPO LIC SIP TRNK RFA 10 System Cumulative Enables 10 SIP trunks on the IP Office Ethernet port202970 IPO LIC SIP TRNK RFA 20 System Cumulative Enables 20 SIP trunks on the IP Office Ethernet port

Avaya IP Endpoint Licenses229444 IPO LIC R6 AV IP ENDPOINT 1 LIC:CU User Each User Enables 1 Avaya IP Endpoint License.229445 IPO LIC R6 AV IP ENDPOINT 5 LIC:CU User Each User Enables 5 Avaya IP Endpoint Licenses.229447 IPO LIC R6 AV IP ENDPOINT 20 LIC:CU User Each User Enables 20 Avaya IP Endpoint Licenses.

3rd Party IP Endpoint Licenses174956 IPO LIC IP400 IP ENDPOINT RFA 1 LIC:CU User Cumulative Enables 1 3rd Party IP phone to register with IP Office call control

174957 IPO LIC IP400 IP ENDPOINT RFA 5 LIC:CU User Cumulative Enables 5 3rd Party IP phones to register with IP Office call control

174958 IPO LIC IP400 IP ENDPOINT RFA 10 LIC:CU User Cumulative Enables 10 3rd Party IP phones to register with IP Office call control

174959 IPO LIC IP400 IP ENDPOINT RFA 20 LIC:CU User Cumulative Enables 20 3rd Party IP phones to register with IP Office call control

174960 IPO LIC IP400 IP ENDPOINT RFA 50 LIC:CU User Cumulative Enables 50 3rd Party IP phones to register with IP Office call control

Other System Licenses171988 IPO LIC IP400 CTI RFA LIC:DS System Toggle177466 IPO LIC IP400 TAPI WAV RFA 4 LIC:CU System Cumulative Enables 4 ports for voice streaming once 171988 is enabled.182301 IPO LIC IP400 IPSEC VPN RFA LIC:DS System Toggle Turns on IPSec encryption for wide area interfaces over IP177467 IPO LIC IP400 ACM CENTRAL VM LIC:DS System Toggle

CCC171996 IPO LIC IP400 CCC SPV RFA LIC:CU System Cumulative

171995 IPO LIC IP400 CCC AGT RFA 5 LIC:CU User Cumulative

176196 IPO LIC IP400 CCC WALLBRD 4 RFA LIC:CU User Cumulative

VPN Phone - Not required R6 and Higher213980 IPO LIC VPN PHONE 1 LIC:CU User Each User

Enables 3rd party TAPI software to control calls on IP Office.

Enables the use of a centralised Intuity Audix system in place of VoiceMail Pro

Adds one CCC supervisor to the system on IP Office running R5 and below.

Enables 5 additional agents to be reported on by a supervisor on IP Office running R5 and below.Enables 4 Wallboards to connect to the CCC server on IP Office running R5 and below.

Enables the use of IPSec encryption software on the Avaya 5610 and 5621 telephones to encrypt calls over public IP connections.

11. IPO LICENSE DESCRIPTIONS

document.xls Page 96

Trial – enables the feature for 60 days, starting from when the license is activated on ADI.263128 IP OFFICE LICENSE CTI RFA TRIAL LIC:DS System Toggle

189782 IPO LIC PREFRD (VM PRO) RFA TRIAL System Toggle Enables 4 ports of VoiceMail Pro229425 IPO LIC R6 ADV EDITION TRIAL LIC:DS System Toggle

229429 IPO LIC R6 PWR USER 5 TRIAL LIC:CU User Each User Enables R6 Power User trial for 5 Users227053 System Cumulative

229449 IPO LIC R6 CUSTMR SVC SPV 1 TRIAL System Cumulative Enables R6 CCR Supervisor trial for 1 User229433 IPO LIC R6 TELEWORKER 5 TRIAL:CU User Each User Enables R6 Teleworker trial for 5 Users229437 IPO LIC R6 MOBILE WORKER 5 TRIAL CU User Each User Enables R6 Mobile Worker trial for 5 Users229441 IPO LIC R6 OFF WORKER 5 TRIAL CU User Each User Enables R6 Office Worker trial for 5 Users189783 IPO LIC RECEPTIONIST RFA 1 TRIAL System Toggle Enables the 1instance of the receptionist189776 IPO TRIAL NTWKD MSGING RFA LIC:DS System Toggle

189778 IPO TRIAL AVAYA TTS RFA 1 LIC:CU System Cumulative Enables VoiceMail Pro to offer Text-to-Speech using an Avaya library

189786 IPO TRIAL ACM CENTRAL VM LIC:DS System Toggle Enables the use of a centralised Voicemail system in place of VoiceMail Pro

189806 IPO TRIAL IPSec VPN RFA LIC:DS System Toggle Turns on IPSec encryption for wide area interfaces over IP205820 IPO LIC SIP TRUNKING TRIAL RFA 1 System Cumulative Enables 1 SIP trunk on the IP Office Ethernet port205823 IPO LIC IP500 VCE NTWK START 4 TRIAL System Toggle

229449 IPO LIC R6 AV IP ENDPOINT 5 TRIAL User Each User Enables R6 Avaya IP Endpoint trial for 5 Users227040 IPO LIC IP ENDPOINT RFA 5 TRIAL System Toggle Enables R6 3rd Party IP Endpoint trial for 5 Users217890 IPO TRIAL UMS 10 USER User Each User

Notes: Type:

Category:

Also known as 3rd Party TAPI trial license, needed to trial DevConnect Solutions with IP Office

Enables R6 Advanced Edition trial with one CCR Supervisor and 20 CCR Agents.

IPO LIC R5 CUSTMR SVC AGT RFA 5 TRIAL Adds 5 more CCR agent to an IP Office system running on R5 only.

Enables VoiceMail Pro to exchange messages with other Avaya voicemail systems

Enables the IP500 to connect to other systems using H.323 or SCN (up to 4 concurrent connections) or Q.sig (unlimited connections),

Enables IMAP email client and web browser integration with VoiceMail Pro for 10 users

System license - shared resource by many users on the systemUser License - exclusive to selected users

Toggle license - license is either ON or OFFCumulative license - can be added together to give a total resourceEach user - a license that is allocated to specific users

12. APPLICATION PC REQUIREMENTS

document.xls Page 97

Applications Intel Pentium Intel Celeron AMD Notes

Application Appliance Server dependencies: (CentOS Linux)IMPORTANT: Compatible Servers

NA

Min PC Resourses

The compatibility of any particular server PC for the operating system cannot be guaranteed. It is the installers responsibility to ensure that the server platform is compatible with CentOS 5 (http://www.centos.org). A list of tested servers is available at https://hardware.redhat.com/. The servers used by Avaya for product testing were: • HP ProLiant DL160 • Dell Optiplex 780MT

one-X Portal for IP Office and Voicemail Pro

2GB RAM 30 GB Hard disk spaceRecommended:4GB RAM 30 GB Hard disk space

Intel Dual Core 2.4GHz

AMD Athlon 64 4000 or equivalent

Operating System:The IP Office Application Server installation installs its own operating system (CentOS Linux), replacing any existing operating system on the PC. If an OS free PC cannot be obtained, Linux based PCs are typically cheaper than equivalent Windows based PCs. Drives DVD Drive or other bootable source for operating system installation.

Other Requirements:

• The server PC must be configurable to boot from DVD or another external source in order to overwrite any existing OS. This may require access to the BIOS in order to change the boot order if the PC is supplied with an operating system already installed.

• The IP Office Application Server is intended to operate as a headless server, i.e without requiring any keyboard, video and mouse (KVM) connections after initial installation. All configuration and user access is done remotely from other PCs.

12. APPLICATION PC REQUIREMENTS

document.xls Page 98

Not tested

Not tested

Server Applications dependencies: (See Note 1, 2 and 3 below)VoiceMail Lite(EOS- 8/3/2009)

256MB RAM Any - 1.4GHz clock speed

Any - 1.7GHz clock speed

Any - 1.4GHz clock speed

Attempting to run the applications on lower specification PC’s may cause degradation of operation and will not be supported.

VoiceMail ProStandalone

256MB RAM, Hard Disk Free Space 2 GB*

Any - 1.4GHz clock speed

Any - 1.7GHz clock speed

Any - 1.4GHz clock speed

To avoid replacing the server when adding new applications we recommend that a Pentium 4 2.8GHz (or equivalent) is used when possible.

VoiceMail Pro +UMS Web Voicemail and/orCampaigns

512MB RAM, Hard Disk Free Space 2 GB*

Pentium 4 2.8GHz clock speed

Athlon XP 3000+All Athlon 64 chips are supported

• Both Web Campaigns and UMS Web Voicemail require the IIS web server on the voicemail server PC to be enabled. • Windows 2008 Server IIS does not support legacy IIS applications such as Campaigns by default. This is rectified by reinstalling IIS from the Windows installation disk, and selecting Legacy IIS support. • UMS Web Voicemail will install PHP is not detected as already installed.

VoiceMail Pro +Customer Call ReporterSEE NOTE 3

Supported on a Dual Core CPU of 2.4Ghz and higher. The separate requirements of Voicemail Pro and Customer Call Reporter must be meet.

Voicemail Pro and IP Office Customer Call Reporter can be run on the same server up to a maximum of 16 Voicemail Pro ports.SEE NOTE 3

VoiceMail Pro +IVRTTS

512MB RAMHard Disk Free Space Min 20 GB*drive

Pentium 4 2.8GHz clock speed

Athlon XP 3000+ All Athlon 64 chips are supported

If the database being queried is located on the VM Pro server the query speed of the database will be affected by the amount of memory available. Please take into account the memory requirements of the database being queried.

12. APPLICATION PC REQUIREMENTS

document.xls Page 99

Not tested

Not tested

Not tested

Not tested

Not tested

VoiceMail Pro +ContactStore

512MB RAM20GB drive.

Pentium 4 2.8GHz clock speed

Athlon XP 3000+ All Athlon 64 chips are supported

If run on the same PC as the VoiceMail Pro, apart from meeting the requirements of VoiceMail Pro:· IP Office ContactStore must use a separate hard disk partition for its message archiving from that used by Voicemail Pro for current mailbox messages. Use of a separate hard disk or installation onto a separate server PC are alternatives.

ContactStoreStandalone

512MB RAM10GB drive.

Pentium 4 2.8GHz clock speed

Athlon XP 3000+ All Athlon 64 chips are supported

The sizing guidelines given assume a sustained recording load of up to 15 concurrent recordings and a moderate replay load of up to 5 concurrent replays.SEE CONTACTSTORE INSTALLATION FOR DETAILS ON SIZING.

VoiceMail Pro +Compact ContactCenter V5CCC (EOS-2/3/2010)

512MB RAMMin10GB*drive

Any Dual Core CPU of 2.4Ghz and higher. The separate requirements of Voicemail Pro and CCC must be meet.

Athlon XP 3000+ All Athlon 64 chips are supported

VM Pro and CCC can be run on the sameserver up to a maximum of 25 agents, 8ports of VM Pro.

Customer Call Reporter

2GB (4GB recommended). Hard Disk Free Space 30GB

D945 Dual Core AMD Athlon 64 4000+

Also requires MS-SQL 2005.If installing a licensed edition of MS-SQL on the IP Office Customer Call Reporter server PC, the separate requirements of the MS-SQL Edition must be meet.

Compact ContactCenterStandalone(EOS-2/3/2010)

512MB RAM20 GB drive.

Any -1.4GHzclockspeed

Any -1.7GHzclockspeed

Any -1.4GHzclock speed

ConferencingCenter(EOS-2/8/2010)

512MB RAMMin 80GBfree diskspace

Pentium 42.8GHzclockspeed

Athlon XP 3000+ All Athlon 64 chips are supported

Windows XP Professional, 2000 Professional can be used but would typically support a maximum of 10 web clients. To support more than 10 clients a server with IIS will be required. Any Dual Core CPU of 2.4Ghz and higher is supported.

12. APPLICATION PC REQUIREMENTS

document.xls Page 100

*Also allow 1MB per minute for message and prompt storage.

one-X Portal for IP Office

2GB RAM10GB free disk space

D945 Dual Core Not tested AMD Athlon 64 4000+

SEE NOTE 3 FOR SINGLE SERVER SPECS WHEN INSTALLING WITH VMPRO AND CCR.

Delta Server(SMDR)See Note 1

256MB RAMMin 10GBfree diskspace.IE5.5 orhigher

Any -1.4GHzclockspeed

Any -1.7GHzclockspeed

Any -1.4GHzclock speed

The Delta Server and CBC can be installed on either the same PC or on separate PC's. In both cases these are the minimum PC specifications.

Feature KeyServer PC See Note 1

256MB RAM1MB free diskspace.

Pentium III 800MHz clock speed

Celeron 3 800Mhz clock speed

Athlon B 650MHz clock speed

Feature key server is not required for IP Office systems with a serial port dongle attached directly to the IP Office control unit or for IP500 systems.

12. APPLICATION PC REQUIREMENTS

document.xls Page 101

Note 1:

Note 2:

Server PC Consolidation: The VoiceMail Pro server application with all its components can be installed on a single server PC together with the Avaya one-X Portal for IP Office server application and the customer Call Reporter application. For this scenario the followinglimits have to be considered:

Note 3:

Key:

Features No Longer Supported:In addition to the ending of Voicemail Lite support in IP Office Release 5, the following applications are no longer supported in IP Office Release 6.0 and higher.• Delta Server • Customer Contact Center (CCC) • Compact Business Center (CBC) • Conferencing Center • Feature Key Server • Call Status

Virtual Server Support:For IP Office Release 6.0 and higher, all applications supported on Windows server operating systems are supported while running on the following virtual servers: • VMWare.• Microsoft Virtual Server. • Microsoft Server Hyper-V.

See Technical Tip 227 for other options

VM Lite – VoiceMail Lite

VM Pro – VoiceMail Pro

IMS – Integrated Messaging Pro

CM – Campaign Manager

CCC – Compact Contact CenterCCR – Customer Call Reporter

12. APPLICATION PC REQUIREMENTS

document.xls Page 102

Client Applications dependencies:Not Tested Not Tested

ANY ANY ANY

800Mhz Celeron3 800Mhz. Athlon B 650MHz.

800MHz

TTS – Text To Speech

IVR – Third Party Database Access

CS – ContactStoreEOS - End of Sale

CBC – Compact Business Center

UMS – Unified Messaging Service

IP Office Softphone

Minimum: 1 GB RAMOptimal: 2 GB RAM

50 MB of free disk space

Minimum: Pentium 4 2.4 GHz or equivalent.Optimal: Intel Core 2 Duo or equivalent, Video Card with DirectX 9.0c support.

Microsoft Internet Explorer 6.0 or later. Sound Card: • Full-duplex, 16-bit or use USB headset Multimedia Device Requirements:The IP Office Softphone requires both speakers and a microphone to make calls. Any of the following configurations are acceptable:• External speakers and microphone • Built-in speakers and microphone • Dual-jack multimedia headset • USB multimedia headset • USB phone.

HID-compliant devices can be configured to work with the IP Office Softphone to support functions such as hook-switch control.

Video Cameras:Calls made with the IP Office Softphone will work without a video camera, but a video camera is necessary to allow other parties to see your image. The IP Office Softphone will work with most USB video cameras.

Conferencing Web Client(EOS-2/8/2010)

Internet Explorer 6.0 or above

Any desktop machine can be used as longas it is capable of running IE6

Phone ManagerLite/Pro

64MB RAMand 160 Mbof free diskspace

A sound card is needed if audio features are required.

Phone Manager PC SoftPhone

128MB RAM1GB free disk space.

Celeron3 800Mhz. Athlon B 650MHz. Phone Manager Pro PC Softphone also requires the user PC to have a speaker and microphone installed and the user associated with an IP extension on the IP Office.

12. APPLICATION PC REQUIREMENTS

document.xls Page 103

ANY ANY ANY

1st Party TAPI Pentium III 800MHz. Celeron 3 800Mhz

3rd Party TAPI Pentium III 800MHz. Celeron 3 800Mhz

Pentium III 800MHz. Celeron 3 800Mhz

Celeron 3 800Mhz

System Monitor Celeron 3 800Mhz

IP Office SSA

Receptionist (formerly SoftConsole)

128MB RAMwith 1GB offree diskspace

Pentium II800MHzclockspeed

Celeron 2800Mhzclockspeed

Athlon B650MHzclock speed

A maximum of four Receptionist applications can be run per system (a license controls the number of simultaneous Receptionist users). A sound card is needed if audio features are required.

ContactStoreWeb client

InternetExplorer 5or above

Any desktop machine can be used as longas it is capable of running IE5

64MB RAM and 50Mb of free disk space

Athlon B 650MHz. In this unlicensed mode the TAPI software supports control of an individual user's associated extension, allowing a TAPI compliant application to answer (requires a phone that supports handsfree answer) and make calls.

64MB RAM and 50Mb of free disk space

Athlon B 650MHz. In this licensed mode, TAPI software can be used to control call function on multiple user extension. This mode is used with CTI Developer applications.

IP OfficeManager

256MB RAMand 1 GBof free diskspace

Athlon Opteron, Athlon64/XP

.NET2 Installed with Manager if not already present.

Call StatusEOSupport for R6

64MB RAM50MB disk space

Pentium III 800MHz. Athlon B 650MHz. Call Status has been replaced by the System Status Application and is included in the IP Office Admin suite to assist with maintenance of pre-4.0 IP Office systems.

128MB RAM10GB disk space

Pentium III 800MHz. Athlon B 650MHz. For IP Office 4.0 and higher, the System Status Application has been added to provide more easily interpreted information than is provided by Monitor.Two versions of Monitor are included in the IP Office Admin applications suite, one for IP Office 4.0 systems and one for pre-4.0 IP Office systems. Care should be taken to ensure that the correct version is used when monitoring an IP Office system.

256MB RAMand 50Mbof free diskspace

PIII 800MHz Celeron 3 800Mhz Athlon B 650MHz Requires Java Virtual Machine 1.4.2 or later. Each SSA session takes about 35M of RAM.

12. APPLICATION PC REQUIREMENTS

document.xls Page 104

ANY ANY ANY

Contact CenterView (CCV)EOSupport for R6

128MB RAMand 10GBof free diskspace

Pentium III800MHzclockspeed

Celeron 3800Mhzclockspeed

Athlon B650MHzclock speed

For OS of Windows XP, minimum RAM increases to 256MB

CCC ReporterEOSupport for R6

InternetExplorer 6or above

Any desktop machine can be used as long as it is capable of running IE6.

WallboardServerEOSupport for R6

128MB RAMand 10GBof free diskspace

Any -1.4GHzclockspeed

Any -1.7GHzclockspeed

Any -1.4GHzclock speed

The Wallboard Server MUST reside on the same PC as the Delta Server

WallboardClientEOSupport for R6

128MB RAMand 10GBof free diskspace

Pentium III800MHzclock speed

Celeron 3800Mhzclock speed

Athlon B650MHzclock speed

For OS of Windows XP, minimum RAMincreases to 256MB

PC WallboardEOSupport for R6

128MB RAMand 10GBof free diskspace

Pentium III800MHzclock speed

Celeron 3800Mhzclock speed

Athlon B650MHzclock speed

For OS of Windows XP, minimum RAMincreases to 256MB

12. APPLICATION PC REQUIREMENTS

document.xls Page 105

ANY ANY ANYone-X Portal for IP Office User Requirements

one-X Portal for IP Office is tested using the current versions of the Internet Explorer, Mozilla Firefox and Safari browsers

• The browser must be JavaScript enabled. • For sounds, Windows Media Player or Quick Time must be installed with the browser. When using a browser other than Internet Explorer, Windows Media Player can be supported by the addition of the Firefox Windows Media Play plugin. This plugin is available from http://port25.technet.com/pages/windows-media-player-firefox-plugin-download.aspx. Currently this plugin is useable with Google Chrome, Mozilla Firefox and Windows Safari. • The Remember me on this computer option requires the browser to allow cookies. • Language one-X Portal for IP Office currently supports English, French, German, Italian, Dutch, Brazilian Portuguese, Russian and Simplified Chinese. The language it uses will be the best match to the browser language preferences. . • Phoneone-X Portal can be used with most phones supported by the Avaya IP Office telephone system but not with Phone Manager PC Softphone. • For analog phone users, the user's Call Waiting On and Off Hook Station settings should be selected in the user's IP Office configuration.

13. SERVER OS SUPPORT

document.xls Page 106

Windows Operating System support for Release 7.0.5IP Office Applications and Windows Operating System support for Release 7.0.5

IP Office Application Windows Clients Windows ServersXP Pro Vista Windows 7 2003 2008/ 2008 R2

32 64 32 64 32 64 32 32 64Preferred Edition Server – –... plus UMS – – – – – –... plus campaigns – – – – – –Preferred Edition clientContactStore – – – –one-X Portal for IP Office – – – – – –Customer Call Reporter – – – – – –SoftConsole – – – –IP Office ManagerSystem MonitorSystem Status ApplicationTAPI - 1st PartyTAPI - 3rd PartyPhone Manager Lite/Pro – – – – –Phone Manager PC SoftPhone – – – – – – – –

The following table gives a summary of the operating systems on which the IP Office applications that are part of the IP Office Release 7.0.5 have been tested and are supported. While the applications may function of other operating systems, they have not been tested by Avaya and are not supported.

• Vista support is only on Business, Enterprise and Ultimate versions. • Windows 7 support is only on Professional, Enterprise and Ultimate versions.

13. SERVER OS SUPPORT

document.xls Page 107

Virtual Server Support

Browser Application SupportThe following applications are accessed using web browsers. The table below details the browsers tested by Avaya. Application Windows Mac

Firefox Opera Safari Chrome Safari

IP Office Application Server 7+ 3+ 2+ 3.2+ – 3.2+Voicemail Pro UMS 7+ 3+ 2+ 3.2+ – 3.2+one-X Portal for IP Office 7+ 3+ 2+ 3.2+ 3.2+Customer Call Reporter 7+ 3+ 2+ 3.2+ 3.2+ContactStore 7.8 7+ – – – – –System Status Application 7+ 3+ – – – –

Microsoft Outlook SupportWhere IP Office applications interact with Microsoft Outlook, for IP Office Release 7.0.5, the version of Outlook supported are 2003, 2007 and 2010.

From Tech Tip 198:

For IP Office Release 7.0.5, all applications supported on Windows server operating systems are supported while running on the following virtual servers: • VMWare. • Microsoft Virtual Server. • Microsoft Server Hyper-V.

Internet Explorer

For IP500v2 systems, SSA is pre-installed on the system's Avaya SD memory card and can be run

by browsing to the IP Office system's IP address.

IP Office Applications Operating System/Service Pack Support PolicyWhen a new PC Operating System or Service Pack is released by Microsoft, Avaya will aim to support the new OS or Service Pack within 6 months of release. This time is required to re-certify the applications through the Software Verification and Field Trial programs. Support will then be announced in a Technical Tip or Bulletin.

13. SERVER OS SUPPORT

document.xls Page 108

IP Office Applications and CentOS 5.5 23 bit Linux Operating System support for R7.0.5

Application Notes

one-X Portal for IP Office

Voicemail Pro

Web Control The IP Office Application Server server is configured and managed remotely using web browser access.

Linux

For Voicemail Pro server running on the IP Office Application Server, the following Voicemail Pro features are not supported: • VB Scripting.• TTS Text to Speech.• MAPI Email.• UMS Exchange Integration.

• 3rd Party Database Integration.• VPNM.• ContactStore.

The IP Office Application Server is a single installer for selected IP Office applications running on Linux. The Linux operating system is included as part of the installation. It requires minimal Linux knowledge due to the inclusion of a web based management interface to allow the server to be managed remotely via web browser. However, experienced Linux System Administrators can extend the value of the solution by installing additional general purpose business applications. Any additional applications installed should be compatible with the base CentOS 5.5 32 bit Linux operating system.

This is a web browser application that user's can use to control making and answering calls on their phone. It also provides a range of gadget for the user to access features such as their directory, call log and voicemail messages.The one-X Portal for IP Office application is configured and managed remotely using web browser access.

This is a voicemail messaging application. It provides mailbox services to all users and hunt groups on the IP Office switch for which it is configured. In addition is can be highly customized to provide a range of call routing and voicemail services. The Voicemail Pro application is configured and managed remotely using the Windows Voicemail Pro client. A copy of the Voicemail Pro client can be downloaded and installed from the IP Office Application Server.

The base operating system installed is CentOS 5, a Linux operating system. However, no specific knowledge of Linux is required for installation and or maintenance of the server.

• UMS Web Voicemail Note: However access via IMAP and one-X Portal are available as alternatives.

14. IPO Software Compatibility

document.xls Page 109

IP Office Software CompatibilityThis page summarizes the hardware components supported on different releases of core software. Control UnitsControl Units 1.0 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 2.0 2.1 3.0 3.1 3.2 4.0 4.1 4.2 5.0 6.0 6.1 7.0

Small Office Edition - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ - - - -IP401 √ √ √ √ √ √ √ - - - - - - - - - - -IP403 √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ - - - - - - -IP406 V1 √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ - - - - - - -IP406 V2 - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ -IP412 - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ -IP500 - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √IP500v2 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √

External Expansion ModulesControl Units 1.0 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 2.0 2.1 3.0 3.1 3.2 4.0 4.1 4.2 5.0 6.0 6.1 7.0

IP400 ATM16 - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √IP400 DS16 - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √IP400 DS30 - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √IP400 DS16 V2 - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √IP400 DS30 V2 - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √IP400 Phone 8 - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √IP400 Phone 16 - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √IP400 Phone 30 - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √IP400 Phone 8 - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √IP400 Phone 16 V2 - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √IP400 Phone 30 V2 - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √IP400 So8 - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √IP400 WAN3 - - - - - - √ √ √ √ - - - - - - - -

- - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √- - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √

IP500 So8 - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √IP500 DS16 - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √IP500 DS30 - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √

- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √

IP500 Phone 16 V2 - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √IP500 Phone 30 V2 - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √

1. Not supported on IP500 and IP500v2 systems.2. North America only.3. IP500v2 systems only.

3.0DT

3.0DT

IP400 WAN3 10/100[1]

IP500 ATM16[2]

IP500 DS16A (RJ21)[3]

IP500 DS30A (RJ21)[3]

14. IPO Software Compatibility

document.xls Page 110

CardsIP500 Base Cards 1.0 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 2.0 2.1 3.0 3.1 3.2 4.0 4.1 4.2 5.0 6.0 6.1 7.0

IP500 Phone 2 - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √IP500 Phone 8 - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √IP500 Digital Station 8 - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √IP500 Card Carrier - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √IP500 VCM32 - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √IP500 VCM64 - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √IP500 4-Port Expansion - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √IP500 ETR6 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √IP500 Combination ATM - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √IP500 Combination BRI - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √

- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √

IP500 Trunk Cards 1.0 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 2.0 2.1 3.0 3.1 3.2 4.0 4.1 4.2 5.0 6.0 6.1 7.0

IP500 Analog Trunk Card - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √IP500 BRI 2 Trunk Card - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √IP500 BRI 4 Trunk Card - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √IP500 PRI-1U - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √IP500 PRI-2U - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √

1. IP500v2 systems only

PhonesPhone 1.0 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 2.0 2.1 3.0 3.1 3.2 4.0 4.1 4.2 5.0 6.0 6.1 7.0

1010 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √1040 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √1120E - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √1140E - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √1220 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √1230 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √1403 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √1408 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √1416 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √

- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √1603-I - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √1603SW - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √1603SW-I - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √

- - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √1608-I - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √

- - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √1616-I - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √2010 √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ - - - - - - - - -2030 √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ - - - - - - - - -2050 √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ - - - - - - - - -20CC √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ - - - - - - - - -20DT √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ - - - -2402D - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √2410D - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √2420 - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √3616 - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √3620 - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √3626 - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √

3.0DT

IP500 TCM 8[1]

3.0DT

3.0DT

1603[1]

1608[1]

1616[1]

14. IPO Software Compatibility

document.xls Page 111

3641 - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √3645 - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √3701 - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √3711 - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √3720 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √3725 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √3740 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √3749 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √3810 - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √3910 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √3920 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √4135 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √4145 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √4145EX - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √4136 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √4146 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √4146EX - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √4406D √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √4412D √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √4424D √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √4601 - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √4602IP - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √4602SW - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √4606 √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ - - - - - - -4610SW - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √4612 √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ - - - - - - -4620 - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √4621 - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √4624 √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ - - - - - - -4625 - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √5402 - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √5410 - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √5420 - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √5601 - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √5602IP - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √5602SW - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √5610SW - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √5620 - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √5621 - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √6408D √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ -6416D √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ -6424D √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ -7420 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √7430 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √7434 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √7439 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √7440 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √7444 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √7449 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √9040 √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ - - - - - - -9404 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √9408 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √9504 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √9508 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √9608 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √

14. IPO Software Compatibility

document.xls Page 112

9620L - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √9620C - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √9621 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √9630G - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √9640 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √9640G - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √9641 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √9650 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √9650C - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ACU - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √B149 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √B159 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √B179 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ETR6 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ETR6D - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ERT18 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ETR18D - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ETR34 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ETR34D - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √M7100 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √M7100N - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √M7208 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √M7208N - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √M7310 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √M7310N - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √M7324 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √M7324N - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √T7000 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √T7100 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √T7208 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √T7316 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √T7316E - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √T7406 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √T7406E - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - √T3 Compact - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √T3 Classic - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √T3 Comfort - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √T3 IP Compact - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √T3 IP Classic - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √T3 IP Comfort - - - - - - - - - - - √ √ √ √ √ √ √

1. 4.2 Q4 '08+.

15. VOICEMAIL FEAT. COMPARISON

document.xls Page 113

Feature

Platform SupportIP500 V2 YesIP500 V1 Yes*

*IP Office 500 R4.0 to R4.2 running in IP Office Professional Edition mode only.Capacities

Number of Mailboxes supported Limited only by IP Office configuration.

Up to 40 dependent on license

Voicemail Storage Size

Runs as a service Yes NoMulti-lingual support Yes YesVoicemail for Individual users Yes YesVoicemail for Virtual users Yes YesVoicemail for Hunt Groups Yes YesGroup Broadcast Yes NoUnified Messaging Service (UMS) Option No

Option No

NoResilience and Backup Option NoSmall Community Network Operation Yes NoCentralized Voicemail Services Yes NoDistributed Voicemail Servers in an SCN Yes NoVoicemail Ringback Internal and external Internal onlyVoicemail Help TUI Yes NoMessage Waiting Indication Yes Yes

Yes YesIntegration with Phone Manager Pro Yes NoPersonalized Greeting Yes YesExtended personal Greetings NoContinuous Loop Greeting Yes NoForward to Email Yes YesCopy to Email Yes YesListen To Email (Text To Speech) NoSend Email notification Yes YesUnified Messaging Service (UMS) Option NoSave Message Yes YesDelete Message Yes YesForward Message to another Mailbox Yes YesForward to Multiple Mailboxes Yes YesForward with a Header Message Yes YesRepeat Message Yes YesRewind Message Yes YesFast Forward Message Yes YesPause Message Yes NoSkip Message Yes YesLIFO/FIFO Message Playback Option Yes NoSet Message Priority No

Yes NoAlphanumeric Data Collection No

IP Office Preferred EditionVoiceMail Pro

IP Office Essential EditionEmbedded Voicemail

Yes (does not use VCM resources)Yes (does not use VCM resources)

No Limit - Limited only by IP Office configuration.

Maximum No. of Concurrent Calls (ports)

6 simultaneous calls on IP500 V2.4 simultaneous calls on IP500.

PC dependent(Requires 1MB per minute)

IP500 V2:2 ports: Up to 15 hours4 ports: Up to 20 hours6 ports: Up to 25 hours

IP500:Up to 15 hours

Integration with Microsoft Exchange Server 2007/2010Capable to interact with Blackberry solution Option[1]

Visual Voice (interactive menu on phone display)

Yes[2]

Yes[2]

Yes[2]

Set automatic message deletion timeframe

Yes[2]

15. VOICEMAIL FEAT. COMPARISON

document.xls Page 114

Yes Yes

Call Back Sender (if Caller ID available) Yes YesRemote Access to Mailbox Yes YesUser Definable PIN Code Yes YesKnown Caller ID PIN Code By-Pass Yes YesBreakout to Reception Internal and external. Internal and external.

1

2 Intuity mode only.In-Queue Announcements

Queue Entry Announcement Yes YesQueue Update Announcement Yes YesQueue Position Announcement Yes NoTime in Queue Announcement Yes NoTime in System Announcement Yes NoEstimated Time to Answer (ETA) Yes NoExit Queue to alternative answer point Yes No

Auto-Attendant / AudiotexMulti-Level Tree Structure Yes Yes (up to 40 in R4.1 & higher)Message Announcements Yes NoWhisper Announce Yes NoAlarm Calls Yes NoAssisted Transfers Yes NoDial by Name Yes YesDirect Dial by Number Yes Yes

Other FeaturesCall Recording Yes NoTamper proofed / verified Call Recording Yes NoTest Conditions Yes NoPersonal Numbering Yes NoSpeaking Clock Yes NoCampaign Manager Yes NoVoiceMail Pro Manager Yes NoCustomized Voicemail Yes NoIntuity TUI emulation mode Yes NoForward Emails to External Systems (VPIM) Yes NoThird Party Database Access (IVR) Yes NoText To Speech within Callflows Yes NoOut-Calling Yes 1 number 3 attempts

Call Transfer Announcement Yes NoSupport for Visual Basic Scripts Yes No

Languages SupportedFor more details see links ->

Callers Caller ID, time and date announced

Requires UMS (enabled through the Power User, Office Worker and the Teleworker licenses) and MS Exchange Server 2007/2010 with a mobility solution (for example a Blackberry) - not provided by Avaya.

Yes (Intuity mode only) Cascading 5 numbers 10 attempts

IP Office Preferred Edition VoiceMail Pro DetailsIP Office Essential Edition Embedded Voicemail Details

16. VOICEMAIL PROMPTS

document.xls Page 115

IP Office Voicemail Prompt Comparisons<--- IP Office Mode

16. VOICEMAIL PROMPTS

document.xls Page 116

<--- Intuity Mode

16. VOICEMAIL PROMPTS

document.xls Page 117

<--- Embedded/Essential Voicemail IP Office Edition

16. VOICEMAIL PROMPTS

document.xls Page 118

<--- Essential Voicemail IP Office Partner EditionWhat's New

IP Office 7.0• Embedded Voicemail – Increased Storage Time (IP500v2 only)

• Default number of licensed voice mail ports (2) 15 hours only.• Add 2 more voice mail ports licenses (total 4) for 20 hours storage.• Add 2 more voice mail ports licenses (total 6) for 25 hours storage.

• Embedded Voicemail – Outcalling Notification (IP500v2 only)

Here is a list of new features that have been added to IP Office Embedded Voicemail. Note that for existing systems, the addition of new features that use prompts requires the prompt set of existing Embedded Voicemail installations to be upgraded. Refer to the IP Office Embedded Voicemail Installation Manual.

This feature is only applies to Embedded Voicemail on the IP500v2 and is applicable to all IP Office modes.

Embedded Voicemail now has a new Outcalling feature, available in all IP Office modes, but only on the IP500v2 platform. The user is able to specify a single Outcalling telephone number that the Voicemail will call when the user receives a new voicemail message in their mailbox, no escalation capabilities are provided. When a message is left in the mailbox, Embedded VoiceMail calls the specified telephone number.

16. VOICEMAIL PROMPTS

document.xls Page 119

IP Office 6.1• Skip Your Mailbox Greeting

• Phantom Mailbox Support without Hardware

• Calls to a phantom extension go directly to voice mail.• DTMF breakout service can be used to transfer the call.• Phantom voice mailboxes:

• Default like a normal mailbox.• Can be accessed remotely if the remote access feature of the mailbox is enabled.

• End of Recording Options

• User can mark Old or Saved Message as new

• Bypass Greeting

• Immediate Coverage to Mailbox

Accessing your Mailbox and Messages

Caller's can skip your mailbox greeting by pressing 1. Instead they immediately hear the tone for the start of recording.

Phantom Mailbox Support is implemented to provide mailbox support for all extensions 10 to 57 that are not physical represented on the system – known as phantom extensions. This was a feature of Partner ACS that allows flexible auto attendant functionality.

Provides voice mailbox support for all extensions (10-57), without requiring thephysical hardware to be present. Extensions without hardware are called phantomextensions.• Note: Ports 7 and 8 of an ETR-6 module can be used for phantom extensions even though you cannot plug a phone into them.

• Voicemail to Email can be activated for a phantom mailbox via the Simplified Manager.

A caller who has finished recording a message into a user’s voice mailbox can press the ``#’’ key signalling the end of message recording.

Press *06 to move an Old or saved Message to the end of the list of New Messages. This option will also be reflected in 14xx Visual Voice, A new option is added to the Visual Voice -> Listen -> Old/Saved sub-menus to mark a message as New. . When a message is marked as New, the system does not initiate a new Voicemail to Email message, but the extension's message waiting light is illuminated.

Callers that are directed into a User’s mailbox can press “1” to bypass the recorded greeting and immediately record a message.

Configuring a “0” Rings option in a user’s 1400 TUI or via Simplified Manager Cover Rings configuration will send calls immediately into the user’s voice mailbox without alerting the user’s extension, or the caller having to wait one ring cycle.

By default you can access your mailbox from your extension without needing to use your access code as your extension's number is treated as a 'trusted source'. Your system maintainer can change that if required. They can also configure other numbers as trusted sources for your mailbox if you require that.

From non-trusted sources, entry of your mailbox access code is required. For example, entry of your access code isusually required if your maintainer has configured a method for you to access your mailbox from remote locations otherthan your own extension.

16. VOICEMAIL PROMPTS

document.xls Page 120

To log in to your mailbox:

Caller Options

• Transfer to another number

1. At your own extension, dial 777.• To access your mailbox from another extension, dial 778 and enter your own extension number when asked which mailbox you want to access.

2.You will hear a prompt telling you how many messages you have. The voicemail system will start playing your new messages. The following is a summary of the options that are available when you have logged into your mailbox.

IMPORTANTOnce a new message has been listened to, it is marked as 'old' and is automatically deleted after 24 hours. If you do not want the message deleted, you must mark it as 'saved' by pressing 5 whilst listening to the message.

Callers to your mailbox can perform the following actions when leaving a message in your mailbox.

• Skip Your Mailbox GreetingCaller's can skip your mailbox greeting by pressing 1. Instead they immediately hear the tone for the start of recording.

Depending on your users settings the caller may be able to select to be transferred to another extension rather than leaving a message.

16. VOICEMAIL PROMPTS

document.xls Page 121

• Caller Post Message Options

Listening to Your Messages

Forwarding a Message

To forward a message:

After leaving a mailbox message, callers can press # rather than hanging up immediately. The caller will hear a prompt informing them whether the message has been saved or whether the messages was too short (less than 3 seconds) and so was not saved.

When you log in to your mailbox you are automatically played any new messages. After a message has been played it is marked as being an old message. Old messages are automatically deleted after 24 hours.

You can forward a message to a different mailbox or to several mailboxes at the same time. If you forward a message you can add a comment to the start of the message.

1.When you are listening to a message, press 6.· To forward the message as it is, press 2.

· To add your own message header before forwarding, press 3. You will be prompted to record your comment after the tone. Record your comment and press # to finish recording.2.Enter the extension number to forward the message to and press #.3.If you want to send the message to more than one extension, repeat the process of enter each extension number followed by #.4.Press # to finish addressing and forward the message.

16. VOICEMAIL PROMPTS

document.xls Page 122

Voicemail Email

1.Log in to your mailbox.2.Select the required type of email notification.

1.Log into your mailbox.

Outcalling

For IP Office 4.2+ (excluding Small Office Edition), Embedded Voicemail supports Voicemail Email functions. You can have notification of new messages sent to your email address. The notification can be a simple alert to tell you that you have a message or a copy of the voicemail message if required.

• Email Address/Enabling Voicemail Email FunctionsBefore you can use the email options, your system administrator must enter your email address into the IP Office configuration. Otherwise you hear the message 'Email is not enabled on this mailbox' whenever you try to use an email option. Your system administrator can tell you whether your voicemail system has been configured to useemail.

To switch on email notification:You can set up your mailbox so that any messages received in future are forwarded to your email address. The messages are not stored in your voicemail mailbox.

• For a email alert press *02.• To have the message forwarded to your email, press *01.

To forward a message to email:If you are listening to a message you can send the message to your email either whilst listening to it or immediately after it has been played.

1.During or immediately after playing a message, press 6.2.Press 1. The message is forwarded to your email address.

To switch off email notification:If you have chosen any of the email notification options, you can switch them off from your telephone.

2.Press *03. You hear a confirmation message to tell you that the option is now turned off.

You can have the voicemail system call a number that you have set whenever you receive a new message. This option is only supported on systems running Release 7.0 or higher. Embedded voicemail outcalling only supports a single destination number with no escalation and no time profiles.

16. VOICEMAIL PROMPTS

document.xls Page 123

• You enter the wrong access code 3 times.• More than 5 minutes passes with no response.

Changing the Mailbox Access Code

When changing your access code:

• Do not set an obvious code, for example:• Do not match your extension number.• Do not use a sequence of digits, for example 1234.• Do not use the same repeated digit, for example 1111.

Each outcalling call alert will ring for a duration that you can set, the default is 15 seconds. If the call is not answered, it will end the call. If the outcalling call is answered, you will be prompted to enter your mailbox access code . If you don't have an access code set, it will ask for your extension number instead. The outcalling call is ended if:

• You press *# to indicate that you do not want any more outcalling calls for the current new messages.

Up to 4 outcalling calls are attempted, with a minimum of 15 minutes between calls, unless you answer and press *# oraccess your mailbox by another method. If you receive any more new messages in the meantime they do not restart theoutcalling attempts.

By default you can access your mailbox from your extension without needing to use your access code as your extension's number is treated as a 'trusted source'. Your system maintainer can change that if required. They can also configure other numbers as trusted sources for your mailbox if you require that.From non-trusted sources, entry of your mailbox access code is required. For example, entry of your access code is usually required if your maintainer has configured a method for you to access your mailbox from remote locations other than your own extension.

Setting and changing a mailbox access code can be done by your system administrator. You can also do it yourself through the mailbox.

• Enter least four digits and up to 15. If you enter less than four numbers you will be prompted to enter a longer code

16. VOICEMAIL PROMPTS

document.xls Page 124

To change your access code:1. Log in to your mailbox.

5. Re-enter your new access code followed by #.The access code will now be changed.

To remove an existing access code:1. Log in to your mailbox.

Changing Your Greeting

• To listen to your greeting:1. Log in to your mailbox.

• If your mailbox already has an access code set, you will be prompted to enter it. Enter your access code

2. Press *04 to change your access code.3. Enter your current access code and press #. If you have no current access code just press #.4. Enter your new access code followed by #.

• The system will prompt you if the codes do not match or is not acceptable. It will also confirm the change of access code if successful.

2. Press *04 to change your access code.3. Enter your current access code and press #.4. When you are asked to enter your new access code, press #.5. When you are asked to re-enter your access code, press #. Your access code will have been removed.

You can override the system greeting with a personal greeting. This is the greeting heard by callers when they are directed to your voicemail. At any time you can listen to your greeting and re-record it.

2. Press 3 to select the option to edit your greeting.3. Press 1 to hear your greeting. If no greeting has been recorded your will hear "The message has not yet been recorded". You need to record a message.

16. VOICEMAIL PROMPTS

document.xls Page 125

• To record or change your greeting:1. Log in to your mailbox.

4.When you are prompted speak your new greeting.• The greeting must be longer than 3 seconds.• A long (approximately 10 seconds) period of silence will disconnect you from voicemail.

Transfer Options

2. Press 3 to select the option to edit your greeting.3. Press 2 to change your greeting.

5. Press 2 when you have finished recording your greeting.6. Press 1 to listen to your new greeting. After you have listened to your greeting you can:

• Press 3 to save the new greeting. Your new greeting will be used.• Press 2 to re-record the new greeting.• Press 4 to save the new greeting for playing on a continuous loop.This option can be used to continually play the greeting, callers will not be able to leave a message. Note that once this option is selected, the greeting cannot be changed back to a normal greeting except be recording a new greeting.

Your system administrator can set up to 3 transfer numbers for your mailbox. Callers leaving messages in your mailbox can then press *0, *2 or *3 to be transferred to the specified numbers. Typically this feature is used to transfer callers to the receptionist or one of your colleagues.If you have the IP Office Phone Manager application, you can configure the destination numbers yourself through the Phone Manager preferences (View | Preferences | Voicemail | Voicemail Transfer Options).Contact your system administrator to find out if any transfer number have been set for your mailbox. When this feature is set, remember to alter your mailbox greeting in order to inform callers of the option.

17. VOICEMAIL PRO ACTIONS

document.xls Page 126

VoiceMail Pro Actions

NEW! R6.1

Complete Sequence FunctionComplete Sequence is the ability for the Voicemail Pro to complete call-flow tasksonce a call has been terminated has been introduced in this release. The capabilitywill allow call independent tasks, such as the sending of multiple emails, and datamanipulation tasks and database read/write tasks to continue to completion, or till aconfigured timeout expires, even after the incoming call terminates.The Complete Sequence checkbox is found on the Specific Tab of the Start PointAction. There is a Timeout Setting in seconds to allow for tasks such as databaseinteractions to finish before completion of the callflow.

NEW! R6.1

Basic Actions - These actions are chiefly used to control the routing of a call between actions.

17. VOICEMAIL PRO ACTIONS

document.xls Page 127

Mailbox Actions - These actions relate to the leaving and collecting of messages from a mailbox.

17. VOICEMAIL PRO ACTIONS

document.xls Page 128

Configuration Actions - These actions allow the caller to alter the settings of a user or hunt group mailbox.

17. VOICEMAIL PRO ACTIONS

document.xls Page 129

Telephony Actions - These actions relate to telephony functions such as call transfers.

17. VOICEMAIL PRO ACTIONS

document.xls Page 130

Miscellaneous Actions - These actions do not fit into a single category.

Condition Actions - These actions are used to create branches in the call routing according to whether a value is true or false.

17. VOICEMAIL PRO ACTIONS

document.xls Page 131

Database Actions - These actions relate to retrieving and adding data to a database.

17. VOICEMAIL PRO ACTIONS

document.xls Page 132

Queue Actions - These actions are associated with hunt group queues and so are not available to user and short code start points.

18. ONE-X PORTAL FOR IP OFFICE

document.xls Page 133

one-X Portal for IP Office

The Avaya one-X™ Portal for IP Office is an application that provides users control of their telephone from a networked PC.Avaya one-X™ Portal for IP Office can be used with any IP Office extension; analog, digital or any IP telephones, wired or wireless, and is available as part of the IP Office Office Worker, Power User or Teleworker user licenses only.Avaya one-X™ Portal for IP Office is a server based application that the user accesses via web browser.Via separate gadgets, Avaya one-X™ Portal for IP Office provides easy access to telephony features, call information, call and conference control, instant messaging, directory and VoiceMail Pro mailbox.

18. ONE-X PORTAL FOR IP OFFICE

document.xls Page 134

one-X Portal Details<--- Calls Gadget

18. ONE-X PORTAL FOR IP OFFICE

document.xls Page 135

<--- Call Log Gadget

18. ONE-X PORTAL FOR IP OFFICE

document.xls Page 136

<--- Messages Gadget

18. ONE-X PORTAL FOR IP OFFICE

document.xls Page 137

<--- Directory Gadget

18. ONE-X PORTAL FOR IP OFFICE

document.xls Page 138

<--- User Status/Presence

18. ONE-X PORTAL FOR IP OFFICE

document.xls Page 139

<--- The World Clock Gadget

18. ONE-X PORTAL FOR IP OFFICE

document.xls Page 140

<--- Agent Control Gadget

18. ONE-X PORTAL FOR IP OFFICE

document.xls Page 141

<--- Instant Messaging Another Avaya one-X™ Portal for IP Office User<--- Personalizing the Layout

18. ONE-X PORTAL FOR IP OFFICE

document.xls Page 142

<--- Profiles<--- Call Assistant

• Screen pop when receiving a call.

• Outlook Contact Pop

• Hot Key

Call Assistant is an optional desktop application that enables the following functions:

The screen will show the name (if in the personal or system directory) and number of the caller and the user can anser or drop the call by clicking on the relevant button

It will also give the option to automatically pop up the Outlook 2003/2007 Contacts entry for the caller or the called.

The one-X Call Assistant can be used to make a call by dialling a number selected in a Windows application. To do this, simply select or highlight the number in the Windows application and then press your one-X Call Assistant's hot key combination.

18. ONE-X PORTAL FOR IP OFFICE

document.xls Page 143

<--- Server, Browser and Other Requirements

19. USER CALL CONTROL COMPARE

document.xls Page 144

Feature

Web browser basedOS independent (Windows, Linux, Mac support)Click to dialCitrix/terminal server support

Transfer call by drag and drop to a speed dial icon

View internal users’ presence

Send Instant Messages (IM) to internal users YesTelecommuter modeMobile Twinning ConfigurationCall Pickup

Personal Phone Directory

System Phone Directory

External Phone Directory (e.g. LDAP/Active Directory)

Yes– while logged in Yes– while logged in Yes - 24/7 call log

Advice of Charge (ISDN service provider dependent)

Future

Audio Conference Management No No Screen pop' contacts with OutlookSimple Outlook contact record creation.

Optional license

Video Softphone

Phone Manager Lite

Phone Manager Pro

and PC SoftPhone

one-X Portal for IP Office

– – Yes – – Yes – – Future – – Future

Inbound/outbound call handling. Yes Yes Yes Phone call control. Yes Yes Yes Configure phone preferences. Yes Yes Yes Configure keyboard short cuts. Yes Yes Yes CLI (ANI) / Name display. Yes Yes Yes Speed dial / Busy Lamp Field management. Yes - 15 icons

maximum. Yes - 100 icons

maximum per tab. Yes - from Personal & System Directory

Speed Dial tabs (to group Busy Lamp Field icons) Yes - 1 Tab Yes - 10 tabs maximum.

Yes – 5Personal

Directory tabsmaximum.

– Yes – Yes (Telephony +

LCS1) Yes (Telephony +

LCS1) Yes (Telephony+ User Status)

Yes (requires LCS1) Yes (requires LCS1) – Yes (not PC

SoftPhone)Yes (except Office

Worker profile) – – Yes – – Yes

Compact mode – Yes Yes – Call Assistant – Yes - 1000 entries

maximum.Yes – 100 entries

maximum – Yes - 5000 entries

maximum.Yes - 5000 entries

maximum. – Yes - 5000 entries

maximum.Yes - unlimited

Call history log – all, missed, messages. Separated incoming/outgoing call log. – Yes Yes Collect new voicemail messages. Yes Yes Yes Voicemail box control (Intuity and IP Office modes). – Yes Yes Personal Distribution List set up (Intuity mode) – Yes – Incoming call scripting. – Yes – Time on call. – Yes Yes

Yes Yes –

Door opening control. – Yes Yes (via analogextension)

Queue monitoring. – Yes - 2 Queues Conference Control Display. Yes Yes Yes

Yes – Yes Yes (with Call

Assistant Plug-In) – Yes –

Agent Mode. – Yes – Distinctive Ringing (WAV file). – Yes – Post Connect dial (sending DTMF while connected to another party). Yes Yes –

VoIP mode (to run as an IP softphone) – Yes (with Power User

and Teleworker licenses only)

– – Yes (with Power User

and Teleworker licenses only)

1. LCS: Microsoft Live Communications Server 2003

20. Customer Call Reporter

document.xls Page 145

Customer Call Reporter

Overview

IP Office Customer Call Reporter Concept

IP Office Customer Call Reporter Key Features

• Real time Call Center activity monitor and historical reporting.• Microsoft server based with thin client (web browser) client connections.• Simplified installation and maintenance.• Six reporting templates provide drag and drop and user defined filter functionality.• Three customizable Supervisor views and summarized Agent views.• Report Scheduler.• Customer Map.• Multi-lingual capable.• Supports up to 30 Supervisors and 150 Agents.

IP Office Customer Call Reporter Business Benefits• Lower TCO

• Standards Based

• Ease of Use

Contact Centers are a requirement at nearly every level of business, from very small informal groups of 5 or 10 "customer service reps", to large formal campaigns that can involve thousands of agents.However, customers in the small business market are generally very nervous about making such a high profile investment in a "contact center solution." They require a "business intelligence solution" that deploys easily, can be managed with very little training, and can provide statistics on each segment of the business. Small Businesses also do not have the resources for extra IT staff to administer databases, servers, etc, so they need a solution that can be easily understood by their own employees. It should operate as a service to each of the clients.

IP Office Customer Call Reporter is Avaya’s new server based contact center product designed explicitly for small businesses. Drawing upon the latest web and design technologies the IP Office Customer Call Reporter introduces significant new capabilities to effectively and efficiently manage a multi-site call center environment. The product focus is on ease of use and deployment simplicity to ensure improved ongoing productivity and lower support costs.

In its native web server environment the IP Office Customer Call Reporter can be simply installed onto a single server without the need for any client software deployment. Administration and management of the call center is carried out via a thin client through a secure password protected web browser session.

IP Office Customer Call Reporter provides small businesses with a web based contact center measurement tool, producing cradle to grave reporting in an easily understandable format with no client software to load.

IP Office Customer Call Reporter uses standards based applications, such as Microsoft SQL 2005 Express, and supports all major web browser software, to provide small business installers with greater flexibility in deployment.

IP Office Customer Call Reporter’s real-time charts can be customized by the user in the manner that suits their business best, with historical reporting templates that allow the business to filter on the type of date they want to see.

20. Customer Call Reporter

document.xls Page 146

CCR Details<--- Ordering IP Office Customer Call Reporter

20. Customer Call Reporter

document.xls Page 147

<--- CCR Server/OS/Client/Database requirements

20. Customer Call Reporter

document.xls Page 148

<--- Dashboard

20. Customer Call Reporter

document.xls Page 149

<--- Historical Reporting

20. Customer Call Reporter

document.xls Page 150

<--- Creating an IP Office Customer Call Reporter Report

20. Customer Call Reporter

document.xls Page 151

<--- Supervisor Wallboard

20. Customer Call Reporter

document.xls Page 152

<--- Real Time Report/Monitor

20. Customer Call Reporter

document.xls Page 153

<--- Call Statistics

21. IP OFFICE PARTNER® Version

document.xls Page 154

IP OFFICE R7.0.5 Essential Edition – PARTNER® VersionThis mode is only available in North America and Mexico locales.

<--- Basic Features

21. IP OFFICE PARTNER® Version

document.xls Page 155

<--- Feature Descriptions

21. IP OFFICE PARTNER® Version

document.xls Page 156

<--- Partner® Version Constraints

22. PARTNER® Version Sets

document.xls Page 157

IP Office Essential Edition - PARTNER® Version mode

Enhanced Tip and Ring (ETR Port)

PARTNER DECT: 3910, 3920 Digital Station (DS Port)

1400 Series: 1403, 1408, 14169500 Series: 9504, 9508

Digital Station (TCM Port)

4100 Series:

7400 Series:

ACU: Audio Conferencing UnitM-Series: MT7100, MT7100N, MT7208, MT7208N, M7310, M7310N, M7324, M7324N.T-Series: T7000, T7100, T7208, T7316, T7316E, T7406, T7406E

Analog Telephones

6200 Series:

Interquartz Gemini:

IP Office Essential Edition - PARTNER® Version mode Release 7.0 supports the following phones and phone add-ons. Availability may depend on location and may be subject to local restrictions.

For pictures of sets go the IP Office Online Knowlegdgebase under General/Pictures.

These phones are only supported on an ETR6 card in a IP500v2 systems. The following are supported in IP Office Essential Edition - PARTNER® Version mode.

ETR6, ETR6D, ETR18, ETR18D, ETR34D (ETR 34D phones limited to a maximum of 2 per card and 4 in total)

These digital stations connect to the IP Office via DS ports. The following are supported in IP Office Essential Edition - PARTNER® Version mode.

These digital stations connect to the IP500v2 IP Office system via TCM ports. The following are supported in IP Office Essential Edition - PARTNER® Version mode.

4135, 4136, 4145, 4145EX, 4146, 4146EX - Connection to IP Office TCM ports via a Digital Mobility Solution system.

7420, 7430, 7434, 7439, 7440, 7444, 7449 - Connection to IP Office TCM ports via a Digital Mobility Solution system.

Analog phones and devices connect to PHONE ports with the IP Office system. However due to the variety of analog phones and device available no guarantee of operation is given. It is the responsibility of the IP Office installer and maintainer to test and verify the operation of proposed analog equipment.

6211, 6219, 6221 (North America).

9330-AV, 9335-AV, 9281-AV (Europe, Middle East, Africa, Asia-Pacific).

23. PARTNER® & IPO COMPARISON

document.xls Page 158

Platform

Migratable Hardware Platform N Y YKey System Functionality Y Y

PBX-mode Y (pooled) Y YETR Telephones Y Y NDigital Telephones N Y YPRI/T1 N 1 8Integrated SIP Trunking N Y YSD Card Technology N Y YSystem Capacity

Extensions (max) 48 100 384ETR 48 18 0Digital 0 100 384Analog 48 100 384IP 0 0 384Trunks (max) 31 72 192Analog 21 32 144Fractional T1 Y Y Y24 Channel PRI/T1 N Y YSIP 3rd Party Y Y

Conferencing capacity 5 64

Mobile Twinning N Y YTAPI Support N Y YSystem Status Application (SSA) N Y YEmbedded Messaging vs PVM LargeAll sets have mailboxes N Y YDay / Lunch / Evening Greeting N Y YMax ports 2 6 6VM to e-mail N Y YHours of Storage 2 15, 20, 25 15No. of auto attendants 0 9 40Remote AdministrationVia Modem Y Y YVia IP N Y Y

PARTNER ACS

IP Office Essential Edition

- PARTNER Version and

Quick Mode R7.0

IP Office Essential Edition

configuration required

128 (max 64 in one conference)

23. PARTNER® & IPO COMPARISON

document.xls Page 159

IP Office Hardware SupportPlatforms supported IP500v2 IP500, IP500v2Combination cards supported 2 2DS8 cards supported 3 3Phone 2 cards supported 4 4Phone 8 cards supported 4 4ETR 6 cards supported 3 0ATM4 cards supported 4 4PRI cards supported 1 (single only) 4 (single or dual)Max expansion modules 8 124-port expansion cards supported 0 1DS 16 modules supported 1 12Phone 16 modules supported 6 12DS 30 modules supported 3 12Phone 30 modules supported 0 12ATM 16 modules supported 1 12Application SupportManager Simplified FullTAPI Support Y YEmbedded VoiceMail Y YMobility Y YPreferred Edition N YAdvanced Edition N YOffice Worker N YMobile Worker N YTeleworker N YPower User N YReceptionist N YCustomer Service Agent N YCustomer Service Supervisor N Y

24. System Status Application

document.xls Page 160

System Status ApplicationOverview

NEW! For R6.1SSA now has the ability to generate/analyze BERT test patterns on IP500 PRI Trunkcards (single and dual).SSA menus to select Line or Channel loopback on IP500 PRI Trunk cards• Lines - Payload or Line Loopback• Channels - Payload LoopbackTo enable loopback or to run a bit error rate test the effect channels or line must befirst set Out of Service, and cannot have a call in progress. SSA can be used todisconnect active calls, then once idle, SSA will command the IP Office togenerate/analyze test patterns. SSA / IP Office will only support the testing of asingle channel/circuit at a time

Initiated tests report results• Elapsed Time• Errored Seconds• Errors Detected• Errors Injected• Bit Error RateSSA buttons• Reset Counters• Inject Errors• Stop Tests

Trunks/Channels “Out of Service” DiagnosticsSSA provides the system engineer with the ability to place TDM trunks Out of Servicewithout requiring a reboot. There is a new tab on the Trunks form in SSA for “LineTesting”In and Out of Service options are delivered via Manager (PRI/T1 Trunk) and SSA(Trunks / Status). The existing options in Manager can be “merged”.

NEW! For R6.0Secure Digital (SD) Cards now includes SSA software to allow for an SSA connection through a web browser. Additional commands and the ability to upgrade the unit have been added to SSA in R6.0.

The System Status Application (SSA) is a diagnostic tool for system managers and administrators to monitor and check the status of IP Office systems locally or remotely. SSA shows both the current state of an IP Office system and details of any problems that have occurred. The information reported is a combination of real-time events, historical events, status and configuration data to assist fault finding and diagnosis. SSA provides real-time status, historic utilization and alarm information for ports, modules and expansion cards on the system. SSA connects to all variants of IP Office running release 4.0 or later, using an IP connection that can be remote or local. Modem connections at 14.4kbps or above are supported for remote diagnostics.

SSA provides real-time status, historic utilization and alarm information for ports, modules and expansion cards on the system.SSA is part of the IP Office 4.0 or later suite and connects to all variants of IP Office 4.0 or later software, using an IP connection that can be remote or local.

24. System Status Application

document.xls Page 161

NEW! For R5.0IP Telephony Quality of Service (QoS) Reporting• Ability to send RTCPMON packets from Avaya H323 IP phones when registered to IP Office.• Collect Quality of Service (QoS) data from RTCPMON packets and other RTCP packets.• System Status Application (SSA) displays QoS data in extension/trunk status screens.• SSA and SNMP alarms are raised at the end of a call/RTP-session.

Enhancements to VoIP Telephone SupportThere are three ways to support the upgrade of Avaya IP Phones• Custom – HTTP/TFTP Server• Memory Card – Compact Flash• Manager – HTTP/TFTP Relay to Manageradded to SSA in R6.0.

NEW! For R4.1• The ability to play back previously recorded logs was added to SSA in Release 4.1.

SSA provides information on the following:

• Alarms

• Call DetailsInformation on incoming and outgoing calls, including call length, call ID and routing information.

• Extensions

SSA displays all alarms which are recorded within IP Office for each device in error. The number, date and time of the occurrence is recorded. The last 50 alarms are stored within IP Office to avoid need for local PC

24. System Status Application

document.xls Page 162

•Trunks

• System Resources

• Details (IP500 and IP500 V2 only)

• Shutdown System

SSA details all extensions (including device type and port location) on the IP Office system. Information on the current status of a device is also displayed.

IP Office trunks and connections (VoIP, analog and digital) and their current status are displayed. For VoIP trunks, QoS information is also displayed (e.g. round trip delay, jitter and packet loss)

IP Office includes central resources that are utilized to perform various functions. Diagnosing these resources is often critical to the successful operation of the system. This includes details on resources for VCM, Voicemail and conferencing.

è Voicemail Channelsè Conference Channelsè Data Channelsè VCM Channelsè Modem Channels

This button allows additional information to be displayed. This additional information can be hidden again by clicking on the Summary button.This command can be used to shutdown the IP Office for a period of time after which it will automatically restart. Alternately it can be shutdown until power is removed and then reapplied.

24. System Status Application

document.xls Page 163

• Backup System Files (IP500 V2 only)System SD card.

24. System Status Application

document.xls Page 164

• Restores System Files (IP500 V2 only)

• Upgrade Binaries (IP500 V2 only)

• Diagnosing these resources is often critical to the successful operation of the system.

Enhancements with Release 4.2 of IP Office!

• Duplicate Numbers in Small Community Networking dial plan.• “No routing for Line” - Incoming Line Group has no associated Incoming Call Route.• Call Routed to a non-existent Start Point in VoiceMail Pro.

Restore the files from the backup folder on the System SD card. A system shutdown will be required for the restored files to be used following the system restart.

system to the System SD card.

• SSA can be launched independently or from IP Office Manager and there can be up to two (2) SSA clients connected to an IP Office unit at one time.Note: SSA is not a configuration tool for IP Office systems. For information on configuration, refer to IP Office Manager

System Status Application (SSA) has a new real-time configuration alarms screen which shows the

24. System Status Application

document.xls Page 165

SSA displays the following new resource availability alarms in IP Office 4.2 (see above):• Attempt to use a feature for which no license is installed.• Voicemail storage full or nearly full.

The following new screens are provided in SSA in IP Office 4.2:• Control Unit Audit - details the last 15 accesses from Manager.• Feature Key and License Status.• Directory, including Users on the SCN.• Real time Voicemail port status.• Voicemail Summary/Detail information.• Real time Mailbox status.• IP Route and Service status.• Tunnel Status.

25. TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

document.xls Page 166

GeneralExpansion Modules Width 445mm/17.5" Height 71mm/2.8" Depth 245mm/9.7"

Dimensions IP500V1/V2 Width 445mmm/17.5"Height 73mm/2.9"Depth 365mm/14.4"

The recommended minimum clearance, front and rear, for the connection of cables and other devices is 75mm/3".

Busy Hour Call Complete (BHCC) is a measure used to test IP Office systems under a high call load.For BHCC tests, each incoming call rings for 5 seconds, is answered and stays connected for

Call Capacity 6 seconds. The BHCC figures for the different IP Office control units are listed below. Note thatin some cases the BHCC figure achievable will be limited by the number of incoming trunks supported.IP500 & IP500V2 = 36000.

Environmental Note that the numbers are for reference only. For practical purposes, for example the calculation of heatdissipation, it is recommended to base environmental requirements (for example air cooling or UPS ratings) onthe maximum input rating of the power supplies of the planned IP Office configuration, as follows.In order to calculate the maximum, that is worst case, amount of heat that can be generated by an IP Officesystem, it is assumed that all input power is converted to heat; whether from the PSU itself, the system unit,expansion module and/or cabling.Heat dissipation is normally measured in British Thermal Units (BTU's). A heat value expressed in Watts can beconverted to BTU/hr by multiplying by 3.41297. As indicated above, you should use the maximum power input

Heat Dissipation of each power supply to calculate this most accurately.Using the conversion factor:Heat Dissipation = max power in watts x 3.41297 = xxx BTU/hour. See values below:The metric equivalent to BTU is a Joule where 1 BTU = 1,055 to 1,060 Joules.This calculates the BTU value per power supply. The maximum BTU per system is therefore calculated, basedon adding the BTUs/hr for each expansion module plus the control unit.Remember to budget for the power requirements of any additional devices that are to be co-located with theIP Office such as server PC's (voicemail, etc).

• 0°C to +40°C (32°F to 104°F): 95% relative humidity, non-condensing.

25. TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

document.xls Page 167

Power volt-ampere BTU/hourIP500v2 230 784.9831IP500 Analog 16 Module 88 300.3414IP500 DS16 Module 34 116.041IP500 DS30 Module 42 143.3447IP500 Phone 16 Module 23 78.49831IP500 Phone 30 Module 42 143.3447IP500v1 230 784.9831IP400 Phone 8 17 58.02049IP400 Phone 16 23 78.49831IP400 Phone 30 42 143.3447IP400 Digital Station 16 34 116.041IP400 Digital Station 30 42 143.3447IP400 So8 34 116.041IP400 WAN3 10/100 17 58.02049IP400 Analog Trunk 16 88 300.3414Typical Server PC 600 2047.782Typical Desktop PC 400 1365.188Mid Span PSU - 6 ports 150 511.9455Mid Span PSU - 12/24 ports 300 1023.891

Unit Weight

control units and expansion modules and base cards and trunk cards:

IP500v1/v2 System Unit - 3.2Kg/7.0lbsAnalog 16 Module - 2.9Kg/6.5lbsDS16 Module - 3.0Kg/6.7lbsDS30 Module - 3.5Kg/7.8lbsDS16A Module - 3.0Kg/6.7lbsDS30A Module - 3.5Kg/7.8lbsTCM8 - .4Kg/0.9lbsPhone 16 Module - 2.9Kg/6.5lbsPhone 30 Module - 3.1Kg/6.94lbs

25. TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

document.xls Page 168

• Input• IP Office 500v1/v2 System Unit: IEC AC inlet socket. 100-240V AC, 50/60Hz, 81-115VA, 2.5A maximum.• Power Supply Units: All CE/UL/Dentori Safety Approved.• Standard 40W Power Supply Unit (All IP400 control and V1 expansion units unless otherwise indicated)Supplied with the control or expansion unit. 40W PSU with integral lead to the unit. Connection to switched mains supply requires separately supplied country specific IEC 60320 C7 power cord (2-wire figure 8 connector).• Input: 100-240V AC, 50/60Hz, 81-115VA, 2A maximum.

Power Supply Consumption • Output: 24Vdc, 1.875A, output power 45W maximum.(Nominal Watts) • Small Office 45W Power Supply Unit

Supplied with the unit. 45W PSU with integral lead to control unit. Connection to switched mains supply requires separately supplied country specific IEC 60320 C13 power cord (3-wire earthed cold kettle lead).• Input: 100-240V AC, 50/60Hz, 81-115VA, 1.5A maximum.• Output: 24V DC, 1.875A, output power 45W maximum.· IP406 V2, DS 16/30V2 and Phone 8/16/30V2 - 60W Earthed Power Supply UnitSupplied with the control or expansion unit. 60W PSU with integral lead to the unit. Connection to switched mains supply requires separately supplied country specific IEC 60320 C13 power cord (3-wire earthed cold kettle lead).• Input: 100-240V AC, 50/60Hz, 81-115VA, 2.5A maximum.• Output: 24V DC, 1.5A, output power 60W maximum.• IP Office 500 80W internal Power SupplyIntegral to the System Unit. Connection to switched mains supply requires separately supplied country specific IEC 60320 C13 power cord (3-wire earthed cold kettle lead).• Input: 100-240V AC, 50/60Hz, 81-115VA, 2.5A maximum.

· IP403, 406 V1 & 412 - 40W Non-Earthed Supply Unit: •Input: 100-240Vac, 50/60Hz, 81-115VA, 2A maximum. • Output: 24Vdc, 1.875A, output power 45W maximum.

Interface InformationDTE Port

EU Interfaces:• BRI:RJ45 sockets. ETSI T-Bus Interface to CTR3 for Pan European Connection.• PRI E1:RJ45 socket. ETSI T-Bus Interface to CTR4 for Pan European Connection.• PRI T1/J1:RJ45 socket: FCC Part 68/JATE connection.

ISDN Ports

USA Interfaces:• PRI T1 Service:Ground Start (GS) – Default, E&M, 56k data for 5ESS, 56/64/64 restricted for 4ESS.• PRI ISDN Switch support:4ESS, 5ESS, DMS-100, DMS-250 (includes conformance to ANSI T1.607 and Bellcore Special Report SR4287, 1992).• PRI ISDN Services:AT&T Megacom 800, AT&T WATS (4ESS), AT&T SDS Accunet 56kB/s and 64kB/s (4ESS), AT&T Multiquest (4ESS).

• IPO 406 V2, IP412 and IP500: 9 way D-type female connector,V.24/V.28

25. TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

document.xls Page 169

Analog Trunk Ports• RJ45 sockets: Only on ATM16 expansion Module. The first two trunks on the module are automatically switched to

power fail sockets on the rear of the unit in the event of power being interrupted must be loop start for correct power fail operation.• IP500 - IP500 Analog Phone 8 Base Card when fitted with an IP500 Analog Trunk daughter card, the combination

supports 1 power failure extension to trunk (loop-start only) connection.Power Fail ports Combination Base Card (IP500v2 only)

• IP500v2 Port 8 can also act as a Power Fail port if an ATM4 daughter card is fitted.ETR6 Base Card (IP500v2 / Essential Edition - PARTNER® Version only)• IP500v2 Port 7-8 Power Fail Analog Phone Ports**The Power Fail Analog Phone ports are wired together and provide one circuit only in the event of power fail if an

ATM4 daughter card is fitted.

ISDN Data Rates

• RJ45 sockets. EU - Telephone ports act as Master sockets.• CLI Schemes: DTMFA, DTMFC, DTMFD, FSK and UK20.

Analog Phone Ports • REN: 2 (External Bell via POT port: REN = 1)• Off Hook current: 25mA.• Ring Voltage: 40V (nominal) RMS.• RJ45 sockets: Auto-negotiating 10/100 BaseT Ethernet (10/100Mbps).• IPO 412: This module has 2 LAN ports acting as a half-duplex layer-3 LAN switch. Both ports are fixed MDI crossover ports. In the IP Office configuration, port 1 is LAN1, port 2 is LAN2.configuration, the LAN ports are on LAN1, the WAN port on LAN2.

LAN • IPO 406V2: This module has 8 LAN ports acting as a full-duplex layer-2 LAN switch. Ports are auto-MDI/MDIX. All ports are on LAN1 in the IP Office configuration. The IP406V2 provides the facility to configure a second logical interface on port 8 of the built-in Ethernet switch. Once enabled, the LAN 2 interface is available as an IP route destination• IP 500 -This unit has 2 ports marked LAN and WAN acting as a full-duplex layer-3 LAN switch. In the IP Office configuration, the LAN port is LAN1, the WAN port is LAN2.• IP500: RJ45 Ethernet socket.

WAN • IPO IP406V2 and IPO 412 Control Units: 37 way D-Type female sockets. X.21 interface to 2048k bps, V.35 interface

to 2048Kbps and V.24 Interface to 19.2Kbps.

Audio

• 3.5mm Stereo Jack socket: Switching Capacity - 0.7A.External Output Port • Maximum Voltage: 55V d.c. On state resistance - 0.7Ω.

• Short circuit current: 1A. Reverse circuit current capacity - 1.4A.

Embedded Voice Memory

• RJ45 sockets: Loop start/Ground start (regional dependant)

• BRI: B-channel 64kbps or 56kbps, D-channel 16kbps.• PRI: B-channel 64kbps or 56kbps, D-channel 64kbps.

• 3.5mm Stereo Jack socket: Input impedance - 10k /channelMaximum a.c. signal – 200mV rms

• IP406V2 and IP 500: 512MB Compact Flash Memory Card • IP500v2 SD Flash Memory Card SDHC minimum 4GB FAT32 format (Single partition, SDHC, class2+, FAT32, SPI & SD bus)

25. TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

document.xls Page 170

ACTA (FCC Reg code)IP500 V2IP500IP406V2 Office IP412 OfficeIP400 ATM16

• US: AY1PH01BS114-1 (REN:01B)• US: AY1PH01BIPO500 (REN:01B)• US: AY1AD04BIP406V2 (REN: 04B)• US: AV1DY04BIP412 (REN: 04B)• US: AY1MH08AIPATM16 (REN: 08B)

26. UPS VA VALUES

document.xls Page 171

IP Office Specific VA Values

Typical IP Office System VA Typical IP Office System VAIP500 System 230 IP406 V2 SYSTEM 168IP500 V2 System 230 IP412 System 312

Individual Equipment VA Individual Equipment VA23 3425 1788 2334 4242 60017 400

So8 Module 34 150300

• The 1151C2/1151D2 power supply units for Avaya H.323 IP phones include a backup battery. This typically provides 15 minutes backup at maximum load (20 Watts) and up to 8 hours at light load (2 Watts).

IP Telephone Power ConsumptionMeasured in Watts using an IEEE 802.3af power supply at 48V. This table shows the power consumption of the phones.

TelephonePower Consumption (Watts)

Typical1120E W1120ENTYS03xA --NTY Class 3 7 10.501120E NTYS03xDE6 Class 3 4.61120E NTYS03xEE6 Class 2 4.21140E W1140ENTYS05xA -- NTY Class 3 7.3 8.001140E W1140ENTYS05xCE6 Rel 5Class 3 4.8 1140E NTYS05xEE6 Class 2 4.31220 NTYS19xx Class 2 3.4 4.601230 NTYS20xx Class 2 3.4 4.601603 w/POE adapter Class 2 3.75 4.32 5.101608 Class 2 3.76 4.66 5.691616* Class 2 2.83 3.17 3.651616* Class 3 5.31 6.22 8.311616* with 1 BM32*** Class 2 3.41 4.37 5.521616* with 1 BM32*** Class 3 5.95 6.82 9.8

NA 3.99 5.57 7.41616-I* Class 2 2.25 2.35 3.111616-I* w/ BM32 Class 2 2.99 3.08 4.87

Class 2 3.29 3.47 6.874601, 4602, 5601, 5602 Class 2 NA 3.5W 4.64602SW, 5602SW Class 2 4.10 N/A 5.04610SW, 5610SW Class 2 4.00 N/A 6.04620, 5620 Class 2 NA 4.0 6.04620 Class 3 NA 7.7 9.94620SW ** Class 3 NA 5.9 84620SW, 5620SW Class 2 4.60 N/A 5.754621SW, 5621SW Class 2 4.90 N/A 6.454625SW Class 3 7.8 N/A 9.42Gig Adapter 16xx/46xx NA 3.16 N/A 5.819608 Class 1 1.93 2.08 2.559610 Class 2 3.72 4.26 4.669611G Class 1 2.64 3.12 3.789620L Class 1 2.1 2.2 2.709620C Class 2 4.22 4.6 5.059621G Class 2 3.18 3.49 4.279630 Class 2 4.6 5.2 5.589630G Class 2 4.6 4.83 6.19640 Class 2 4.19 4.52 5.59640G Class 2 4.42 4.83 5.579641G Class 2 3.28 3.44 4.129650 Class 2 4.6 5.2 5.589650C Class 2 4.19 4.52 5.5BM12 NA 0.1 0.31 0.62SMB-24 NA 0.35 0.6 0.9Blue Tooth Adapter NA NA 0.3 0.41Gig Adapter for 96xx NA 3.8 NA 3.8

The web site http://ups.avayaups.com provides a calculator into which you can enter the equipment you want supported on a UPS. It will then display various UPS options. The site uses VA values for typical IP Office systems. However, if more specific values are required for a particular system, the table below can be used to enter values.

IP406 V2 Control Unit So8 Module IP412 Control Unit Phone 8 Module Analog 16 Module Phone 16 Module Digital Station 16 Module Phone 30 Module Digital Station 30 Module Typical Server PC WAN3 Module Typical Desktop PC

Mid Span PSU - 6 ports Mid Span PSU - 12/24 ports

PoEClass(IEEE

802.3af)Conservative

Mode Worst Case

1616* with 2 BM32*** Aux Power Supply

1616-I* w/2 BM32 Aux Power Supply

26. UPS VA VALUES

document.xls Page 172

Note4:

Default PoE Class "L" Two BM129608 Class 1 L L H

9611G Class 1 H H H9641G Class 2 L L L

Default PoE Class "L" Two SBM249608 Class 1 L H H

9611G Class 1 H H H9641G Class 2 L L H

*There is a sticker on the back of the 1616 which will provide the material code. If the material code is 700450190 or 700458540, the phone is Class 2. If the material code is 700415565, the phone is class 3.**The 4620SW that require Class 3 power can be identified by the ethernet jacks that point straight out of the back of the telephone, rather than down from the back of telephone.***Note: when using the 1616 phone with more than 1 BM32, an external power supply is needed.Note1: The EU24 adds less than 1W to the 4620 and 462xSW numbers. The EU24BL (1.5W) should not be used with POE, use the 1151(C/D).the telephone, rather than down from the back of telephone.Note2: The GigE adapter for the 46xx phones will work with Class 0, 1 or 2 phones. Class 0 devices may require use of a local power supply, depending on the power rating. Class 3 devices always require the use of a local power supply.

Note3: Assuming that your PoE source supports Class 3 power, you should never be forced to aux power a 96xx phone. All phones operate in Class 2 and all but the 9630G will accept a single button module and still be in Class 2. However, once you add a second button module (or a first for the 9630G), you must flip the IEEE power switch on the back of the phone. This will then present the Class 3 power signature and if the PoE source will allow a Class 3 device it will provide full power for as many other devices that we currently have designed or planned for the 96xx phones.

Note that the GigE adapter starts out in Class 3 – so if we take any phone and plug a GigE adapter to it, the Ethernet switch must support Class 3 power or else you need a brick.

One BM12

Three BM12

One SBM24

Three SBM24

• Power consumption measured using Power over Ethernet IEEE802.3af standard powering — The measurements were taken as average from six IEEE802.3af compliant PoE switches; The power consumption using AC/DC Adapters is similar to above, but must

account for approximately 72% efficiency rating from AC source. Power consumption measured at the endpoint/device — 7ft maximum length LAN cord to PoE switch; 2.45W maximum power loss allowable over 100m cable lengths.

Note: Typical is measured off-hook sample size 1. Worst Case is analytical. Except the 4601, 4602, 5601 and 5602 all telephones had a PC attached at 100Mbps. The EU24/EU24BL adds less than 1W to the 4620, 4620SW and 5620 numbers.

26. UPS VA VALUES

document.xls Page 173

Notes for the Nortel 1xxx phones:Typical Use defined as: Two Ethernet ports linked at maximum speed, light traffic, backlight on, active on a handsfree call,no accessories connected.This represents a typical in-use scenario. Idle power will be lower Power measured at phone with 2 m cord. Longer cord willresult in higher power due to cable loss.Power can vary from sample to sample and with activity on the phone, or with accessories connectedIEEE 802.3af Class number is determined by peak power, not typical or idle power.

The use of an Uninterrupted Power Supply (UPS) with any telephone system is recommended. Even at sites thatrarely lose electrical power, that power may occasionally have to be switched off for maintenance of otherequipment. In addition, most UPSs also provide an element of power conditioning, reducing spikes and surges.

The capacity of UPS systems and the total equipment load the UPS is expected to support are usually quotedin VA. Where equipment load is quoted in Watts, multiply by 1.4 to get the VA load.

The calculation of how much UPS capacity is required depends on several choices.• What equipment to place on the UPS?

Remember to include server PCs such as the voicemail. It is recommended that the total load on a new UPSis never greater than 75% capacity, thus allowing for future equipment.

• How many minutes of UPS support is required?Actual UPS runtime is variable, it depends on what percentage of the UPSs capacity the total equipment loadrepresents. For example, a 1000VA capacity UPS may only support a 1000VA (100%) load for 5 minutes. Thisrelationship is not linear, the same UPS would support a 500VA (50%) load for 16 minutes. Therefore thelower the percentage of capacity used, the increasingly longer the UPS runtime, typically up to 8 hoursmaximum. Remember also that for most UPS's the ratio of discharge to full recharge time is 1:10.

• How many output sockets does the UPS provide?Multiple UPS units may be required to ensure that every item of supported equipment has its own supply socket.

27. HANDSET CABLE LENGTHS

document.xls Page 174

Telephone Extension Cable Lengths

Telephone Set TypeUnshielded Twisted-Pair (UTP) - 50nf/Km

CW1308

ETR Phones 305m/1000'. 305m/1000'. 122m/400'. 122m/400'.1400 Series 1000m - 3280' 400m - 1310'

2400/5400 Series 1200m - 3937' 1000m - 3280' 670m - 2200' 400m - 1310'4406D 1000m - 3280' 400m - 1310' 400m - 1310'4412D 700m - 2295' 400m - 1310' 400m - 1310'4424D 500m - 1640' 500m - 1640' 400m - 1310' 400m - 1310'

6400 Series 1000m - 3280' 400m - 1310' 400m - 1310'T3 Series (Upn) 1000m - 3280' 400m - 1310' -Analog Phones 1000m - 3280' 500m - 1640' 800m - 2620'

M7000&T7000 Series N/A

* Derate by 3m for each 1nF increase per km.Rerate by 2m for each 1nF decrease per km

+ SAP is required at 400mLoop Specification on BCM/ NorstarOn BCM / Norstar

Telephone Set TypeUnshielded Twisted-Pair (UTP) - 50nf/Km

AWG22 AWG24 AWG26(0.65mm) ( 0.5mm Ø) (0.4mm)

N/A N/A

N/A N/A

ATA-2 7200m - 26000'

N/A 1230 m - 4000' N/A

ASM8 N/A 1530 m - 5000' N/A

The table below details the maximum total cable distances for DS and analog extensions using different cable types.

AWG22(0.65mm)

AWG24( 0.5mm Ø)

AWG26(0.4mm)

1000m - 3280'

1000m - 3280' 1000m - 3280'

1000m - 3280' 1000m - 3280' 1000m - 3280'

400m/1300' without SAP

750m / 2450'*with SAP

400m/1300' without SAP

700 m / 2300' *+

with SAP

400m/1300' without SAP

650m / 2100' *with SAP

Avaya M7000 and T7000 Series 305m /1000' without SAP

790m / 2500 ft. with SAP

Norstar MICS Loop Specifications

Analog Stations (GASM8, ASM8+, BCM50 On-board GASI)

28. PROTOCOLS

document.xls Page 175

Protocol RFC DescriptionThe IP Office supports the following protocols and standards:V.120 - - - A standard Rate Adaption mechanism. V.110 - - - A standard Rate Adaption mechanism. PPP RFC 1661 Point to Point Protocol. LCP RFC 1570 Link Control Protocol. MP RFC 1990 Multi-Link (Point to Point) Protocol. IPCP RFC 1332 Internet Protocol Control Protocol.PAP RFC 1334 Password Authentication Protocol. RTP/RTCP RFC1889 Real Time and Real Time Control ProtocolCHAP RFC 1994 Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol. CCP RFC 1962 Compression Control Protocol. STAC RFC 1974 Stac LZS Compression Protocol. MPPC RFC 2118 Microsoft Point to Point Compression (Protocol). BACP RFC 2125 Bandwidth Allocation Control Protocol. UDP RFC 768 User Datagram Protocol.IP RFC 791 Internet Protocol. TCP RFC 793 Transmission Control Protocol.DHCP RFC 1533 Dynamic Host Control Protocol. NAT RFC 1631 Network Address Translation. BOOTP RFC 951 Bootstrap Protocol. TFTP RFC1350 Trivial File Transfer Protocol.NTP RFC868 Network Time Protocol.SNMPv1 RFC1157 Simple Network Management Protocol. (STD15)

RFC1155

RFC1212 Concise MIB Definitions. (STD16)RFC1215 A Convention for Defining Traps for use with the SNMP

MIB-II RFC1213

ENTITY MIB RFC2737 Entity MIB (Version 2).RIP RFC1058 Routing Information Protocol

RFC2453 RIP Version 2. (STD56)RFC1722 RIP Version 2 Protocol Applicability Statement. (STD57)

IPSEC RFC2401 Security Architecture for the Internet ProtocolRFC2402 IP Authentication HeaderRFC2403 The Use of HMAC-MD5-96 within ESP and AHRFC2404 The Use of HMAC-SHA-1-96 within ESP and AHRFC2405 The ESP DES-CBC Cipher Algorithm With Explicit IVRFC2406 IP Encapsulating Security Payload (ESP)RFC2407 The Internet IP Security Domain of Interpretation for ISAKMP.RFC2408 Internet Security Association and Key Management ProtocolRFC2409 The Internet Key Exchange (IKE).RFC2410 The NULL Encryption Algorithm and Its Use With IPsec.RFC2411 IP Security Document Roadmap.

L2TP RFC2661 Layer Two Tunneling Protocol "L2TP"RFC3193 Securing L2TP using IPsecRFC2507 IP Header Compression (IPHC)RFC2508 Compressing IP/UDP/RTP Headers for Low-Speed Serial LinksRFC2509 IP Header Compression over PPP

DiffServ RFC2474

PPP MP RFC1990 The PPP Multilink Protocol (MP)RFC1490 Multi protocol Interconnect over Frame Relay

ML-PPP RFC2686 The Multi-Class Extension to Multi-Link PPP

Structure and Identification of Management Information for TCP/IP-based internets. (STD16)

Management Information Base for Network Management of TCP/IP-based internets:MIB-II (STD17)

Header

Definition of the Differentiated Services Field (DS Field) in the IPv4 and IPv6 Headers.

Frame RelayEncapsulation

28. PROTOCOLS

document.xls Page 176

Session Initiated Protocol (SIP)

• RFC 2833 [7] - RTP Payload for DTMF Digits, Telephony Tones and Telephony Signals

• RFC 3263 [10] - Session Initiation Protocol (SIP): Locating SIP Servers• RFC 3264 [11] - An Offer/Answer Model with Session Description Protocol (SDP)• RFC 3323 [14] - A Privacy Mechanism for the Session Initiation Protocol (SIP)

• RFC 3824 [24] - Using E.164 numbers with the Session Initiation Protocol (SIP)• RFC 1889 – RTP• RFC 1890 - RTP Audio• RFC 4566 – SDP• RFC 3265 - Event Notification• RFC 3515 - SIP Refer• RFC 3842 - Message Waiting• RFC 3310 – Authentification• RFC 2976 – INFO• RFC 3323 - Privacy for SIP (PAI) and draft-ietf-sip-privacy-04 (RPID)

• RFC 3261 - SIP session Initiation Protocol• RFC 1889 – RTP• RFC 1890 - RTP Audio• RFC 4566 – SDP• RFC 2833 - RTP /DTMF• RFC 3264 - SDP Negotiation• RFC 3265 - Event Notification• RFC 3515 - SIP Refer• RFC 3842 - Message Waiting• RFC 3310 – Authentication• RFC 2976 – INFO• RFC 3323 - Privacy for SIP (PAI) and draft-ietf-sip-privacy-04 (RPID)

• Rec. E.164 [2] - ITU-T Recommendation E.164: The international public telecommunication numbering plan

• RFC 3261 [8] - SIP: Session Initiation Protocol

• RFC 3489 [18] - STUN - Simple Traversal of User Datagram Protocol (UDP) Through Network Address Translators (NATs)

The SIP endpoint support implementation is compliant with the following standards or "RFCs".

28. PROTOCOLS

document.xls Page 177

VoIP Standards Supported

IP Office supports the following protocols and standards:• H.323 (V2)(1998), Packet-based multimedia communications systems • Q.931, ISDN user-network interface layer 3 specification for basic call control

• H.245 (1998), Control protocol for multimedia communication • Session Initiation Protocol.• Audio CODECs:

• G.711 A-law/U-law (64K).• G.723.1 MP-MLQ (6.3K).• G.729 Annex A, Annex B, Annex AB – CS-ACELP.

• Silence Suppression • Fax Relay (IP Office to IP Office Fax Transport over IP).• T.38 Fax support (SIP trunks and SIP endpoints).• Local End Echo Cancellation 25ms • Out of band DTMF • Jitter buffer, 5 frames of jitter buffer • Internet Standards/Specification (in addition to TCP/UDP/IP)

• RFC 1889 – RTP/RTCP, Real Time and Real Time Control Protocol • RFC 2507,2508,2509 – Header Compression • RFC 2474 – DiffServ, Type of Service field configurable.• RFC 1990 - PPP Fragmentation.• RFC 1490 - Encapsulation for Frame Relay.• RFC 2686 - Multiclass Extensions to Multilink PPP.• RFC 3261 - Session Initiation Protocol (SIP).• RFC 3489 - STUN.

IP Office supports the following QSIG services across this network:

• H.225.0 (1998), Call signaling protocols and media stream packetization for packet-based multimedia communication systems

• Simple Telephony Call/Basic Call: ETS300 171/172.• Circuit Switched Data Call/Basic Call: ETS300 171/172.• Called/Calling Line ID Presentation: ETS300 173.• Called/Calling Name Presentation: (SS-CNIP, SS-CONP, SS-CNIR) ETS300 237/238.• Message Waiting: (SS-MWI) EN301 260/255.• Transfer: (SS-CT) ETS 300 260/261.

29. Button Feature List

document.xls Page 178

Description Action Action Data

Togg

les

Stat

us In

d

Use

r Ad

min

IP Office Phone Support

Anal

og

1400

Ser

ies

1600

Ser

ies

20 S

erie

s

2400

Ser

ies

3600

Ser

ies

3700

Ser

ies

3810

4100

Ser

ies

4400

Ser

ies

4600

Ser

ies

5400

Ser

ies

5600

Ser

ies

6400

Ser

ies

7400

Ser

ies

9040

9500

Ser

ies

9600

Ser

ies

M-S

erie

s

T-Se

ries

T3/T

3 IP

Ser

ies

Actions GeneralDial 1.0 + Dial Dial X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Group 1.0 + Group X √ X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

User 1.0 + User X √ X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Actions AppearanceAppearance 3.0+ Optional text label. a= X √ X X √ √ X √ √ X √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ X

3.0+ X √ X X √ √ X √ √ X √ X √ √ √ √ √ X √ √ √ X

3.0+ User name. X √ X X √ √ X √ √ X √ X √ √ √ √ √ X √ √ √ X

Button Feature

IP OfficeSoftware

LevelDefault Label

This action is used to dial the number contained in the Telephone Number field. A partial number can be enter for the user to complete. On buttons with a text label area, Dial followed by the number is shown.

Telephone number or partial telephone number. √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Monitors the status of a hunt group queue. This option is only supported for hunt groups with queuing enabled. The user does not have to be a member of the group.Depending on the users button type, indication is given for when the group has alerting calls and queued calls (queued in this case is defined as more calls waiting than there are available group members). In IP Office 4.0 the definition of queued calls has changed to include ringing calls. However for operation of the Group button, ringing calls are still regarded as different from other queued calls.For pre-4.0 IP Office pressing the button displayed information about the longest waiting call in the queue and options to answer, drop or ignore the call. For IP Office 4.0 and higher the button has been changed to just answer the longest waiting call.

Group name enclosed in " " double-quotes or group number.

<group name> √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Monitors whether another user's phone is idle or in use. The Telephone Number field should contain the users name enclosed in double quotes. The button can be used to make calls to the user or pickup their longest waiting call when ringing. On buttons with a text label, the user name is shown.

The actions performed when the button is pressed will depend on the state of the target user, whether they are local or on a remote SCN system and the phone on which the button is programmed.

See Note 4 below

User name enclosed in "double-quotes".

<the user name>. √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Creates a call appearance button. This can be used to answer and make calls. Users with multiple call appearance buttons can handle multiple calls. For full details refer to the IP Office Key & Lamp Manual.Call appearance functions, assigned to buttons that do not have status lamps or icons, are automatically disabled until the user logs on at a phone with suitable buttons.For IP Office 3.2+, appearance buttons can be set with a ring delay if required or to not ring. This does not affect the visual alerting displayed next to the button. The delay uses the user's Ring Delay setting (User | Telephony | Multi-line Options) settings.Note that *4100 Series and 7400 Series phones support virtual call appearance button operation. This also applies to T7000, T7100, M7100 and M7100N phones and the Audio Conferencing Unit (ACU).

Appearance -> Appearance √[*] √[*] √[*] √[*]

Bridged Appearance

Creates an appearance button that follows the state of another user's call appearance button. The bridged appearance can be used to make and answer calls on behalf of the call appearance user. For full details refer to the IP Office Key & Lamp Manual.

The bridged appearance button user must also have at least one call appearance button programmed.Bridged appearance functions, assigned to buttons that do not have status lamps or icons, are automatically disabled until the user logs in at a phone with suitable buttons.

Appearance -> Bridged Appearance

User name and call appearance button number.

<user name><call appearance label>.

√[*] √[*]

For IP Office 3.2+, appearance buttons can be set with a ring delay if required or to not ring. This does not affect the visual alerting displayed next to the button. The delay uses the user's Ring Delay (User | Telephony | Multi-line Options ) setting.

*Not supported on T7000, T7100, M7100, M7100N and the Audio Conferencing Unit (ACU).

Coverage Appearance

Creates a button that alerts when a call to the specified covered user is unanswered after that users Individual Coverage Timer expires. The call coverage appearance button can be used to answer that call. For full details refer to the IP Office Key & Lamp Manual.The call coverage appearance button user must also have at least one call appearance button programmed. The covered user does not need to be using call appearance buttons. Coverage appearance functions, assigned to buttons that do not have status lamps or icons, areautomatically disabled until the user logs on at a phone with suitable buttons.

Appearance -> Coverage Appearance

<user name>. √[*] √[*]

For IP Office 3.2+, appearance buttons can be set with a ring delay if required or to not ring. This does not affect the visual alerting displayed next to the button. The delay uses the user's Ring Delay setting (User | Telephony | Multi-line Options) settings.*Not supported on T7000, T7100, M7100, M7100N and the Audio Conferencing Unit (ACU).

29. Button Feature List

document.xls Page 179

Description Action Action Data

Togg

les

Stat

us In

d

Use

r Ad

min

IP Office Phone Support

Anal

og

1400

Ser

ies

1600

Ser

ies

20 S

erie

s

2400

Ser

ies

3600

Ser

ies

3700

Ser

ies

3810

4100

Ser

ies

4400

Ser

ies

4600

Ser

ies

5400

Ser

ies

5600

Ser

ies

6400

Ser

ies

7400

Ser

ies

9040

9500

Ser

ies

9600

Ser

ies

M-S

erie

s

T-Se

ries

T3/T

3 IP

Ser

ies

Button Feature

IP OfficeSoftware

LevelDefault Label

3.0+ Line ID number. X √ X X √ √ X √ √ X √ X √ √ √ √ √ X √ √ √ X

Actions: EmulationThis function allows quick dialing of a stored number. 1.0+ AD X X √ X √ √ X √ X √ √ X √ √ √ √ √ X

1.0+ None Pause X X X X √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

1.0+ None Prog X X √ X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X

1.0+ None Stop X X X X √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

1.0+ Acct X X √ X √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Not supported. Provided for CTI emulation only. 1.0+ None Stats X X X X √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

Not supported. Provided for CTI emulation only. 1.0+ None Count X X √ X √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

1.0+ None Sfunc X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

1.0+ None Mark X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

1.0+ None Wait X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

AD Suppress 1.0+ None Spres √ √ X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ X X

1.0+ None AutCB √ √ √ X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.0+ Iauto X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.0+ CFrwd √ √ X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Line Appearance

Creates an line appearance button linked to the activity of a specified line appearance ID number. The button can then be used to answer and make calls on that line. For full details refer to the IP Office Key & Lamp Manual.

Appearance -> Line Appearance

<Line ID number>. √[*] √[*]

The line appearance button user must also have at least one call appearance button programmed before line appearance buttons can be programmed.Line appearance functions, assigned to buttons that do not have status lamps or icons, are automatically disabled until the user logs in at a phone with suitable buttons.Note that on 4620, 4621, 4625 and 5621 phones, buttons set to call appearance can occupy the full screen width, using the button on either side of the display line for operation and adjusting the numbering of all other buttons accordingly. The appearance buttons can be changed to half-width mode from the phone by pressing Options -> Application Options -> Call Appearance Width.For IP Office 3.2+, appearance buttons can be set with a ring delay if required or to not ring. This does not affect the visual alerting displayed next to the button. The delay uses the user's Ring Delay (User | Telephony | Multi-line Options ) setting.For IP Office 4.2+, line appearances are supported on T3 and T3 IP phones. These phones do not require (or support) call appearance buttons in order to use line appearances.*Not supported on T7000, T7100, M7100, M7100N and the Audio Conferencing Unit (ACU).

Abbreviated Dial

Emulation -> Abbreviated Dial

Telephone number or partial number• Full NumberThe number is dialled.• Partial NumberThe partial number is dialled and the user can then complete dialing the full number.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1]

Abbreviated Dial Pause

Not supported. Provided for CTI emulation only. Allows a user to enter a pause character when programming an abbreviated dial.

Emulation -> Abbreviated Dial Pause

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Abbreviated Dial Program

Not supported. Provided for CTI emulation only. Allows a user to program abbreviated dialing numbers against other programmable buttons. This function cannot be used to overwrite call appearance buttons.

Emulation -> Abbreviated Dial Program

Abbreviated Dial Stop

Not supported. Provided for CTI emulation only. Allows a user to enter a stop character when programming an abbreviated dial.

Emulation -> Abbreviated Dial Stop

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Account Code Entry

Enter an account code for a call. This button can be used before dialing a number or during a call.

Emulation -> Account Code Entry

Optional. If an code is set it must match an account code set in the account codes list. If no account code is set, the phone display will request entry of a valid code. This option is not supported on XX02 phones and the T7000 phone.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

ACD Agent Statistics

Emulation -> ACD Agent Statistics

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

ACD Stroke Count

Emulation -> ACD Stroke Count

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

AD Special Function

Not supported. Provided for CTI emulation only. Allows a user to enter a special character (mark, pause suppress, wait) when entering an abbreviated dial.

Emulation -> AD Special Functions

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

AD Special Function Mark

Not supported. Provided for CTI emulation only. Allows a user to enter a mark character when programming abbreviated dial.

Emulation -> AD Special Function Mark

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

AD Special Function Wait

Not supported. Provided for CTI emulation only. Allows a user to enter a Wait for Dial Tone character when programming an abbreviated dial.

Emulation -> AD Special Function Wait

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Suppresses the display of dialed digits on the telephone display. Dialed digits are replaced with an s character.

Emulation -> AD Suppress √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Automatic Callback

Sets a ringback on the extension being called. When the target extension ends its current call, the ringback user is rung (for their set No Answer Time/Allocated Answer Interval) and if they answer, a new call is made to the target extension.Ringback can also be cleared using the Cancel Ring Back When Free function.

Emulation -> Automatic Callback

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Automatic Intercom

Call an extension and have the call automatically answered on speaker phone after 3 beeps. The extension called must support a handsfree speaker. If the extension does not have a handsfree microphone then the user must use the handset if they want to talk. If the extension is not free when called, the call is presented as a normal call on a call appearance button if available.

Emulation -> Automatic Intercom

User number or name. For IP Office 4.0+ this field can be left blank for number entry when pressed.· For IP Office 4.0+, on large display phones, if configured without a preset target this type of button will display an interactive button menu for target selection.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Call Forwarding All

Switches forward unconditional on and sets the forward number to the number specified or prompts the user to enter a number if none is specified.

Emulation -> Call Forwarding All

Telephone number or blank for entry when pressed. √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

29. Button Feature List

document.xls Page 180

Description Action Action Data

Togg

les

Stat

us In

d

Use

r Ad

min

IP Office Phone Support

Anal

og

1400

Ser

ies

1600

Ser

ies

20 S

erie

s

2400

Ser

ies

3600

Ser

ies

3700

Ser

ies

3810

4100

Ser

ies

4400

Ser

ies

4600

Ser

ies

5400

Ser

ies

5600

Ser

ies

6400

Ser

ies

7400

Ser

ies

9040

9500

Ser

ies

9600

Ser

ies

M-S

erie

s

T-Se

ries

T3/T

3 IP

Ser

ies

Button Feature

IP OfficeSoftware

LevelDefault Label

Call Park 1.0+ CPark √ √ √ X √ X X √ X √ √ X √ √ √ √ √ X

1.0+ √ X √ X X √ X √ √ X √ √ √ √ √ X

Call Pickup Answer an alerting call on the system. 1.0+ None CpkUp X X √ X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √1.0+ None CnLWC X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

Consult Not supported. Provided for CTI emulation only. 1.0+ None Cnslt X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

1.0+ Idial X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Pickup a call ringing at a specific extension or hunt group. 1.0+ DpkU X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Directory 1.0+ None Dir X X X X X √ X X √ X √ √ X √ X X √ √

· When associated with a specific park slot number, the button will park and unpark calls from that park slot and indicate when a call is parked in that park slot. Similarly the Park buttons within application (for exampleSoftConsole, Phone Manager and one-X Portal for IP Office) can be used to park, retrieve and indicate parked calls.· When not associated with a specific park slot number, the button will park calls by assigning them a park slot number based on the users extension number. For example, for extension XXX, the first parked call is assigned topark slot XXX0, the next to XXX1 and so on up to XXX9. The button will indicate when there are parked calls in any of those slots. On the T7000 phone, only a single automatic part slot XXX0 is supported.· With a call connected, pressing the button will park that call using a park slot number assigned by the system based on the extension number.· With no call connected, pressing the button will display details of any calls parked by the extension and allow their retrieval.

Emulation -> Call Park

Park slot ID (alphanumeric) or blank for menu of slots in use. √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1]

Call Park To Other Extension

Allows the user to park their current call against another user's extension. The parked call indication on that extension isthen activated according to the telephone type.If the target extension has a Call Park button with no specific park slot number, the parked call will be indicated by thatbutton and can be unparked from the list of parked calls shown when that button is pressed.· Pre-IP Office 4.0The park slot number assigned to the parked call is based on the number of the extension against which the call isbeing parked. For example, calls parked against extension 203 are assigned park slot ID 2030, 2031 and so on up to2039 depending on the number of calls parked.· IP Office 4.0+The park slot number assigned to the parked call is based on the number of the extension parking the call. Forexample, calls parked by extension 201 are assigned the park slot ID 2010, 2011 and so on up to 2019 depending onthe number of calls parked.

Emulation -> Call Park to Other Extension

User number. For IP Office 4.0+ this field can be left blank for number entry when pressed

Rpark("Park" in pre-4.0 IP Office)

XPre-4.0√ 4.0+

XPre-4.0√ 4.0+

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1]

Emulation -> Call Pickup √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Cancel Leave Word Calling

Not supported. Provided for CTI emulation only. Cancels the last Leave Word Calling message originated by the user.

Emulation -> Cancel Leave Word Calling

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Emulation -> Consult √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Dial Intercom

Call an extension and have the call automatically answered on speaker phone after 3 beeps. The extension called must support a handsfree speaker. If the extension does not have a handsfree microphone then the user must use the handset if they want to talk. If the extension is not free when called, the call is presented as a normal call on a call appearance button if available.· For IP Office 4.2 Q4 maintenance release and higher this feature can be used as part of handsfree announced transfers .

Emulation -> Dial Intercom

User number or name or blank for number entry when pressed .· For IP Office 4.0+, on large display phones, if configured without a preset target this type of button will display an interactive button menu for target selection.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Directed Call Pickup

Emulation -> Directed Pickup

User number or name or group number or name or blank for number entry when pressed .· For IP Office 4.0+, on large display phones, if configured without a preset target this type of button will display an interactive button menu for target selection.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

A Dir button provides access to various directories and allows telephone number selection by dialed name matching. The directories available for searching depend on the phone type, see User Directory Access . Once they user has selected a directory, dialing on the dial pad letter keys is used to display matching names, with controls for scrolling through the matching names and for calling the currently displayed name.The method of name matching is controlled by the Dial by Name (System | Telephony | Telephony) setting in the IP Office configuration:

Emulation -> Directory √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[4]

· With Dial By Name onMatching is done against all the dial keys pressed. For example, dialing 527 matches names starting with JAS (for example "Jason") and KAR (for example "Karl"). Only the first 50 matches are displayed.· With Dial By Name offMatching is done against the first letter only. For example pressing 5 displays names beginning with J. Press 5 again displays names beginning with K. Only the first 50 matches are displayed. This mode is not supported by IP Office 5.0+.

Name dialing functions on IP Office assume that the phone is using the standard ITU keypad· Dialing SpacesFor names that include spaces, the method of indicating a space has changed in IP Office 5.0.· Pre-IP Office 5.0To enter a name with a space, nothing is dialed for the space. For example "John S..." is dialed as 56467.· IP Office 5.0+To enter a name with a space, the 0 key is used for the space. For example "John S..." is dialed as 564607.

29. Button Feature List

document.xls Page 181

Description Action Action Data

Togg

les

Stat

us In

d

Use

r Ad

min

IP Office Phone Support

Anal

og

1400

Ser

ies

1600

Ser

ies

20 S

erie

s

2400

Ser

ies

3600

Ser

ies

3700

Ser

ies

3810

4100

Ser

ies

4400

Ser

ies

4600

Ser

ies

5400

Ser

ies

5600

Ser

ies

6400

Ser

ies

7400

Ser

ies

9040

9500

Ser

ies

9600

Ser

ies

M-S

erie

s

T-Se

ries

T3/T

3 IP

Ser

ies

Button Feature

IP OfficeSoftware

LevelDefault Label

Drop 1.0+ None Drop X X √ X X X √ X X X √ X √ X X X X X √ √ X X X

1.0+ GrpPg X X √ X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.4+ None or FF (IP Office 4.1+). HdSet √ √ X X X X X X X X X X √ X X X X X X X X X √

Inspect 1.0+ None Inspt X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

1.0+ HfAns √ √ √ X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.0+ None LWC X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

Not supported. Provided for CTI emulation only. 1.0+ None Excl X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

Not supported. Provided for CTI emulation only. 1.0+ Pcall X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

Ringer Off Switches the phone's call alerting ring on/off. 1.0+ None RngOf √ √ √ X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √1.0+ Blank or 1 or 2 (IP Office 4.1+). Admin X X √ X √ X X √ X √ √ X X √ √ √ √

1.0+ None SAC √ √ √ X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.0+ None BtnVu X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

Time of Day 1.0+ None TmDay √ √ √ X √ X X √ X √ √ X √ √ X √ √ X

This action is supported on phones which do not have a permanent Drop button.· For a currently connected call, pressing Drop disconnects the call. When drop is used to end a call, silence is returned to the user rather than dial tone. This is intended operation, reflecting that Drop is mainly intended for use by call center headset users.· If the user has no currently connected call, pressing Drop will redirect a ringing call using the user's Forward on No Answer setting if set or otherwise to voicemail if available.· For a conference call, on phones with a suitable display, Drop can be used to display the conference parties and select which party to drop from the conference.

Emulation -> Drop

Group Paging

Makes a paging call to an extension or group specified. If no number is specified, this can be dialed after pressing the button. The target extension or group members must be free and must support hands-free auto-answer in order to hear the page.

On Avaya phones with a CONFERENCE button, a paged user can convert the page call into a normal call by pressing that button.

Emulation -> Group Paging

User number or name or group number or name.· For IP Office 4.0+, on large display phones, if configured without a preset target this type of button will display an interactive button menu for target selection.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Headset Toggle

This function is intend for use with Avaya phones that have separate handset and headset sockets but do not provide a dedicated Headset button, for example older style 4400 and 4600 series phones. On phones without a headset socket or with a dedicated Headset button this control will have no effect.

Miscellaneous -> Headset Toggle

√[3]

Not supported. Provided for CTI emulation only. Allows users on display phones to determine the identification of held calls. Allows users on an active call to display the identification of incoming calls.

Emulation -> Inspect √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Internal Auto-Answer

This function is also know as hands-free auto-answer. Sets the user's extension to automatically connect internal calls after a single ring. This function should only be used on phones that support hands-free operation.

Emulation -> Internal Auto-Answer

Optional.· If left blank this function acts as described above for internal auto-answer.· IP Office 4.1+ supports the entry of FF as the Action Data. In that case the button will enable/disable headset force feed operation for external calls. In this mode, when headset mode is selected but the phone is idle, an incoming external call will cause a single tone and then be automatically connected. This operation is only supported on Avaya phones with a fixed HEADSET button. Ring delay is applied if set on the call or line appearance button receiving the call before the call is auto-connected.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Leave Word Calling

Not supported. Provided for CTI emulation only. Leaves a message for the user associated with the last number dialed to call the originator.

Emulation -> Leave Word Calling

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Manual Exclude

Emulation -> Manual Exclude √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Priority Calling

Emulation -> Priority Calling.

None.· For IP Office 4.0+, on large display phones, if configured without a preset target this type of button will display an interactive button menu for target selection.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Emulation -> Ringer Off √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Self-Administer

Allows a user to program features against other programmable buttons themselves. See Using an Admin Button for full details. From IP Office 3.0+, Appearance can no longer be used to create call appearance buttons. Similarly, existing call appearance button cannot be overwritten using any of the other Admin button functions.· For IP Office 4.0+ user's with a log in code will be prompted to enter that code when they use this button action.· For IP Office 4.2+, T3 phone users can access a similar set of functions for button programming, see T3 Phone Self-Administration .· On 4412D+, 4424D+, 4612IP, 4624IP, 6408D, 6416D, 6424D phones:· Admin can be permanently accessed via Menu , , , Admin. See Using a Menu Key .· Admin1 can be permanently accessed via Menu , Menu , , ProgA, , , DSS.

Emulation -> Self-Administer. √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[2]

Send All Calls

Sets the user's extension into 'Do Not Disturb' mode. Callers, other than those on the user's do not disturb exception list, receive busy or are diverted to the users voicemail mailbox. Note that with a call already connected and other calls already alerting, enabling Do Not Disturb will not affect those calls already existing. For full details of see Do Not Disturb When on, most Avaya phones display an N on the display. This function and the Do Not Disturb On function work in parallel, ie. setting one sets the other.

Emulation -> Send All Call √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Stored Number View

Not supported. Provided for CTI emulation only.Allows a user to view the contents of any programmed feature button.

Emulation -> Stored Number View

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Displays the time and date on the user's telephone. This function is ignored on those Avaya IP Office phones that display the date/time by default.

Emulation -> Time of Day √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1]

29. Button Feature List

document.xls Page 182

Description Action Action Data

Togg

les

Stat

us In

d

Use

r Ad

min

IP Office Phone Support

Anal

og

1400

Ser

ies

1600

Ser

ies

20 S

erie

s

2400

Ser

ies

3600

Ser

ies

3700

Ser

ies

3810

4100

Ser

ies

4400

Ser

ies

4600

Ser

ies

5400

Ser

ies

5600

Ser

ies

6400

Ser

ies

7400

Ser

ies

9040

9500

Ser

ies

9600

Ser

ies

M-S

erie

s

T-Se

ries

T3/T

3 IP

Ser

ies

Button Feature

IP OfficeSoftware

LevelDefault Label

Timer 1.0+ None Timer √ √ √ X √ √ X √ X √ √ X √ √ X √ √ X

Twinning 3.2+ None Twinning √ √ √ X √ √ X √ X √ √ X √ √ √ √ √ X

Visual Voice 4.0+ None Voice X X X X √ X X √ X √ X X √ √ √ X X

Actions: AdvancedAcquire Call 1.1+ Aquir X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

4.2+ None ACWrk √ √ X X X X X X X X X X X √ √ √ √ √

Break Out 4.0+ BkOut X X X X √ √ X √ X √ √ X √ √ √ √ √ X

1.1+ 1 for on, 0 for off. BusyH X X X X √ √ √ X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

Call Intrude 1.1+ Intru X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Call List 3.1+ None LIST X √ X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X √

Starts a timer running on the display of the user's extension. The timer disappears when the user end a call. Note: This function is ignored on those Avaya IP Office phones that display a call timer by default.· For pre-6.1, this function is not supported on Avaya phones that display a call timer next to each call appearance through the phone's own settings.· For 6.1, this function can be used on Avaya phones (except 9600 Series) that display a call timer next to each call appearance. The button will temporarily turn the call timer on or off for the currently selected call appearance. The change only applies for the duration of the current call.

Emulation -> Timer √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1]

This action can be used by user's setup for mobile twinning. This action is not used for internal twinning.· While the phone is idle, the button allows the user to set and change the destination for their twinned calls. It canalso be used to switch mobile twinning on/off and indicates the status of that setting.· When a call has been routed by the IP Office to the user's twinned destination, the Twinning button can be used toretrieve the call at the user's primary extension.· In configurations where the call arrives over an IP trunk and the outbound call is on an IP trunk, SCN may optimisethe routing and in this case the button may not be useable to retrieve the call.

Emulation -> Twinning √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1]

· For user's setup for one-X Mobile Client, changes to their Mobile Twinning status made through the IP Office configuration or using a Twinning button are not reflected in the status of the Extension to Cellular icon on their mobile client. However, changes to the Extension to Cellular status made from the mobile client are reflected by the Mobile Twinning field in the IP Office configuration. Therefore for one-X Mobile Client users it is recommended that they control their Mobile Twinning status through the one-X Mobile Client rather than through a Twinning button.

· Mobile Twinning HandoverFor IP Office Release 6.1, when on a call on the primary extension, pressing the Twinning button will make an unassisted transfer to the twinning destination.· During the transfer process the button will flash. Pressing it again at this time will halt the transfer attempt and reconnect the call at the primary extension.· The transfer will return if it cannot connect to the twinning destination. It will also return using the user's configured Transfer Return Time (if the user has no Transfer Return Time configured, a enforced time of 15 seconds is used).

This action provides the user with a display menu for access to their mailbox. It can be used with Voicemail Pro (Intuity and IP Office modes) and Embedded Voicemail. The menu provide the user with options to listening to messages, leaving messages and managing the mailbox.

If pressed when a call is connected, the button allows entry of an extension number for direct to voicemail transfer of the connected call.

On phones that have a display but do not support full visual voice operation as indicated below, use of the button for usermailbox access using voice prompts and for direct to voicemail transfer during a call is supported (does not include T3and T3 IP phones).

For IP Office 4.2+, access to Visual Voice on supported phones can be triggered by the phone's MESSAGES button rather than requiring a separate Visual Voice programmable button. This is done using the System | Voicemail option Messages button goes to Visual Voice.

Emulation -> Visual Voice √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[2]

See Call Steal Advanced -> Call -> Call Steal

User number or blank for last call transferred. √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

After Call Work

This button is used by users configured as an CCR Agent (User | Telephony | Supervisor Settings )and working with the IP Office Customer Call Reporter (CCR) application. It shows the CCR agent their current After Call Work (ACW) status and allow them to manually change status. While in ACW state, the agent will not receive hunt group calls.CCR Agents can be automatically put into and taken out of ACW by the IP Office if the user is configured for AutomaticAfter Call Work (User | Telephony | Supervisor Settings ). Those users must have an After Call Work button.

Advanced -> Miscellaneous -> After Call Work

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1]

This feature is usable within an IP Office Small Community Network. It allows a user on one system in the network to specify that the following dialing be processed by another IP Office system on the network as if the user dialed it locally on that other system.On phones with a multi-line display, if the target IP Office system is not specified in the button settings, a menu of the available systems in the network is displayed from which a selection can be made.For pre-IP Office Release 5 systems, this feature requires the IP Offices to have Advanced Small Community Networking licenses.

Advanced -> Dial -> Break Out

Optional. The system name or IP address of the required IP Office system can be specified. If no system name or IP address is set, on display phones a list of systems within the Small Community Network is displayed when the button is pressed.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1]

Busy On Held

When on, busy on held returns busy to new calls while the user has an existing call on hold.While this feature can be used by users with appearance keys, it is not recommended as this overrides the basic call handling intent of appearance keys.

Advanced -> Busy -> Busy on Held

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Intrudes on the existing call of the specified target extension. All call parties are put into a conference and can talk. Use of this feature is subject to the Can Intrude status of the intruder and the Cannot be Intruded status of the other call parties.If the target is idle, the function is changed to a normal call.

Advanced -> Call -> Call Intrude

User number or blank for entry when pressed· For IP Office 4.0+, on large display phones, if configured without a preset target this type of button will display an interactive button menu for target selection.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

This function is only supported for T3 phones. It provides access to a list of received calls.

Advanced -> Call -> Call List

29. Button Feature List

document.xls Page 183

Description Action Action Data

Togg

les

Stat

us In

d

Use

r Ad

min

IP Office Phone Support

Anal

og

1400

Ser

ies

1600

Ser

ies

20 S

erie

s

2400

Ser

ies

3600

Ser

ies

3700

Ser

ies

3810

4100

Ser

ies

4400

Ser

ies

4600

Ser

ies

5400

Ser

ies

5600

Ser

ies

6400

Ser

ies

7400

Ser

ies

9040

9500

Ser

ies

9600

Ser

ies

M-S

erie

s

T-Se

ries

T3/T

3 IP

Ser

ies

Button Feature

IP OfficeSoftware

LevelDefault Label

Call Listen 1.1+ User number Listn X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Pick up the first available ringing call on the system. 1.1+ None PickA X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Pick up a call ringing any hunt group of which the user is a member. 1.1+ None PickG X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.1+ Group number or name PickM X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Call Queue 1.1+ User number Queue X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ X X

Call Record 1.1+ None Recor X √ X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Call Steal 1.1+ Aquir X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.1+ None CWOff X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

1.1+ None CWOn √ √ X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

Disables call waiting, if on, for the duration of the extension's next call. 1.1+ None CWSus X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

1.1+ None FwdOf X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.0+ None RBak- X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

For Avaya use only. 1.1+ Channel number. ChMon X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

Clear Call 1.1+ None Clear X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Clear CW 1.1+ None ClrCW X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

1.1+ HGNS- X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

1.1+ HGOS- X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

Clear Quota 1.1+ Quota X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

Places all the calls the user has on hold into a conference with the user. 1.1+ None Conf+ X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

This feature allows a user to monitor another conversation without being heard. It requires the user being monitored to be a member of the group set as the button user's Monitor Group (User | Telephony) in the IP Office configuration. The use of call listen is also controlled by the Can Intrude setting of the user and the Cannot Be Intruded settings of the target. It is not affected by the settings of the third party to thecall if they are internal.• Warning: The use of monitoring may be subject to local and national restrictions. This feature should only be used in compliance with those restrictions.• Note: On pre-4.0 IP Office systems, IP phone extensions can be used to monitor but cannot be monitored

Advanced -> Call -> Call Listen

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Call Pickup Any

Advanced -> Call -> Call Pickup Any

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Call Pickup Group

Advanced -> Call -> Call Pickup Group

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Call Pickup Members

This feature can be used to pick up any call to an extension that is a member of the hunt group specified. The call picked up does not have to be a hunt group call.

Advanced -> Call -> Call Pickup Members

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Transfer the call to the target extension if free or busy. If busy the call is queued to wait for the phone to become free.This is similar to transfer except it allows you to transfer calls to a busy phone.

Advanced -> Call -> Call Queue

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

This feature allows you to record a conversation and requires Voicemail Pro to be installed. An advice of recording warning will be given if configured on the voicemail system. The recording is placed in the mailbox specified by the user's Manual Recording Mailbox setting. Call recording also requires available conference resources similar to a threeparty conference.

Advanced -> Call -> Call Record

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

This function can be used with or without a specified user target.· If the specified target has alerting calls, the function will connect to the longest waiting call.· If the specified target has no alerting calls but does have a connected call, the function will take over the connected call, disconnecting the original user. This usage is subject to the Can Intrude setting of the Call Steal user and the Cannot Be Intruded setting of the target. The feature is independent the intrude settings of the third party to the call.· If no target is specified, the function attempts to reclaim the users last ringing or transferred call if it has not been answered or has been answered by voicemail.

Advanced -> Call -> Call Steal

User number or blank for last call transferred. √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Call Waiting Off

Switches call waiting off for the user. This button function is obsolete, the Call Waiting On button function toggles on/off and indicates current status.

Advanced -> Call -> Call Waiting Off

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Call Waiting On

Enables call waiting on the user's extension. When the user is on a call and another call arrives, they will hear a call waiting tone. Note: Call waiting does not operate for user's with call appearance buttons. See Call Waiting .

Advanced -> Call -> Call Waiting On

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Call Waiting Suspend

Advanced -> Call -> Call Waiting Suspend

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Cancel All Forwarding

Cancels forward unconditional, forward on busy, forward on no answer, follow me and do not disturb if any of those are active on the user's extension.

Advanced -> Call -> Cancel All Forwarding

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Cancel Ring Back When Free

Cancels any existing ringback set by the user, see Ring Back When Free . Note the Ring Back When Free buttons provide both status indication of when set and toggle to cancel or set ringback when free.

Advanced -> Miscellaneous -> Cancel Ring Back When Free

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Channel Monitor

Advanced -> Call -> Channel Monitor

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

This feature can be used to end the last call put on hold. This can be used in scenarios where a first call is already on hold and simply ending the second call will cause an unsupervised transfer of the first call.

Advanced -> Call -> Clear Call

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

End the user's current call and answer any call waiting. Requires the user to also have call waiting indication on. This function does not work for users with multiple call appearance buttons.

Advanced -> Call ->Clear CW √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Clear Hunt Group Night Service

Changes the specified hunt group from 'Night Service' mode to 'In Service' mode.This button function is obsolete. The Set Hunt Group Night Service function can be used to toggle a group in/out of service and provides lamp status indication.Note: If the hunt group has been placed into night service mode by an associated time profile, this function cannot override that night service mode.

Advanced -> Call -> Clear Hunt Group Night Service

Group number.· IP Office 4.0+: If left blank, the button will affect all hunt groups of which the user is a member.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Clear Hunt Group Out Of Service

Changes the specified hunt groups status from 'Out of Service' mode to 'In Service' mode.This button function is obsolete. The Set Hunt Group Out Of Service function can be used to toggle a group in/out of service and provides lamp status indication.

Advanced -> Call -> Clear Hunt Group Out of Service

Group number.· IP Office 4.0+: If left blank, the button will affect all hunt groups of which the user is a member.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Quotas can be assigned to IP Office on outgoing calls to data services such as internet connections. The quota defines the number of minutes available for the service within a time frame set within the service, for example each day, each week or each month.The Clear Quota function can be used to reset the quota for a specific IP Office service or for all IP Office services.

Advanced -> Call -> Clear Quota

"Service name" within quote marks or "" for all services. √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Conference Add

Advanced -> Call -> Conference Add

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

29. Button Feature List

document.xls Page 184

Description Action Action Data

Togg

les

Stat

us In

d

Use

r Ad

min

IP Office Phone Support

Anal

og

1400

Ser

ies

1600

Ser

ies

20 S

erie

s

2400

Ser

ies

3600

Ser

ies

3700

Ser

ies

3810

4100

Ser

ies

4400

Ser

ies

4600

Ser

ies

5400

Ser

ies

5600

Ser

ies

6400

Ser

ies

7400

Ser

ies

9040

9500

Ser

ies

9600

Ser

ies

M-S

erie

s

T-Se

ries

T3/T

3 IP

Ser

ies

Button Feature

IP OfficeSoftware

LevelDefault Label

1.1+ CnfMM X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Dial 3K1 1.1+ Any number. D3K1 X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Dial 56K The call presented to local exchange as a "Data Call". 1.1+ Any number. D56K X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Dial 64K The call presented to local exchange as a "Data Call". 1.1+ Telephone number D64K X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Dial CW 1.1+ User number DCW X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Dial Direct 1.1+ Dirct X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

1.1+ Any number. Emrgy X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.4+ Inclu X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Dial Paging 1.1+ Page X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.4+ PhyEx X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.4+ Extension port ID number. DialP X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Dial Speech 1.1+ Telephone number DSpch X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Dial V110 The call is presented to local exchange as a "Data Call". 1.1+ Telephone number DV110 X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Dial V120 The call is presented to local exchange as a "Data Call". 1.1+ Telephone number DV120 X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Dial Video The call is presented to the local exchange as a "Video Call". 1.1+ Telephone number Dvide X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Display Msg Allows the sending of special functions to feature phones. 1.0+ Displ X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

1.1+ DNDX+ X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ X √ √

1.1+ Telephone number or CLI DNDX- X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ X √ √

1.1+ None DNDOf X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ X √ √

1.1+ None DNDOn √ √ X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Conference Meet Me

This feature allows a user to join a specific numbered conference. By default, ad hoc conferences are assigned numbers starting from 100 for the first conference in progress. Therefore specifying a number away from this range ensure that the conference joined is not an ad hoc conference started by other users.For IP Office 4.1+ this button has been enhanced. A currently connected caller can be transferred into the conference by pressing TRANSFER, then the Conference Meet Me button and TRANSFER again to complete the transfer. This allows the user to place callers into the conference specified by the button without being part of the conference call themselves. This option is only support on Avaya phones with a fixed TRANSFER button (excluding T3 and T3 IP phones).For pre-IP Office Release 5 systems, this function is not supported on IP500 systems without an IP500 Upgrade Standard to Professional license. For IP Office Release 6 and higher, IP500 and IP500 V2 systems require a Preferred Edition license.

Advanced -> Call -> Conference Meet Me

Conference number. This can be an alphanumeric value up to 15 characters.

XPre-4.0√ 4.0+

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

The call is presented to local exchange as a "3K1 Speech Call". Useful in some where voice calls cost less than data calls.

Advanced -> Dial -> Dial 3K1 √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Advanced -> Dial -> Dial 56K √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Advanced -> Dial -> Dial 64K √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Call the specified extension number and force call waiting indication on if the extension is already on a call. The call waiting indication will not work if the extension called has multiple call appearance buttons in use.

Advanced -> Dial -> Dial CW √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Call an extension and have the call automatically answered on speaker phone after 3 beeps. The extension called must support a handsfree speaker. If the extension does not have a handsfree microphone then the user must use the handset if they want to talk. If the extension is not free when called, the call is presented as a normal call on a call appearance button if available.· For IP Office 4.2 Q4 maintenance release and higher this feature can be used as part of handsfree announced transfers .

Advanced -> Dial -> Dial Direct

User number or name or blank for entry when pressed.· If left blank, the Dial Direct button can be used with User buttons to specify the target.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Dial Emergency

Dials the number specified regardless of any outgoing call barring applicable to the user.

Advanced -> Dial -> Dial Emergency

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Dial Inclusion

Intrudes on the existing connected call of the specified target extension. The intruder and the target extension can then talk but cannot be heard by the other party.During the intrusion all parties hear a repeated intrusion tone. When the intruder hangs-up the original call parties are reconnected.Use of this feature is subject to the Can Intrude status of the intruder and the Cannot be Intruded status of the other call parties if internal.

Advanced -> Dial -> Dial Inclusion

User number or name or blank for user selection when pressed .· For IP Office 4.0+, on large display phones, if configured without a preset target this type of button will display an interactive button menu for target selection.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Makes a paging call to an extension or group specified. If no number is specified, this can be dialed after pressing the button. The target extension or group members must be free and must support hands-free auto-answer in order to hear the page.On Avaya phones with a CONFERENCE button, a paged user can convert the page call into a normal call by pressing that button.

Advanced -> Dial -> Dial Paging

User or group number or name or blank for entry when pressed. √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Dial Physical Extn By Number

Call the specified extension using its Base Extension number setting. This is regardless of the current user logged on at that extension and any forwarding, follow me or do not disturb settings applied by the extension user. This function requires the extension to be assigned a default extension number in the IP Office configuration. If the extension does not have a default extension number, Dial Physical Extn by ID should be used.

Advanced -> Dial -> Dial Physical Extn By Number

Extension port Base Extension number. √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Dial Physical Extn By ID

Call the specified extension, if free, regardless of the current user logged on at that extension and any forwarding, follow me or do not disturb settings applied by the extension user. This function uses the port ID shown in the IP Office configuration.

Advanced -> Dial -> Dial Physical Extn By ID

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

This feature allows a short code to be created to force the outgoing call to use the Speech bearer capability.

Advanced -> Dial -> Dial Speech

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Advanced -> Dial -> Dial V110

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Advanced -> Dial -> Dial V120

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Advanced -> Dial -> Dial Video

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Advanced -> Dial -> Display Msg

The telephone number takes the format N";T" where:· N is the target extension.· T is the text message. Note that the "; before the text and the " after the text are required.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Do Not Disturb Exception Add

Adds a number to the user's "Do Not Disturb Exception List". This can be the number of an internal user or a number to match the CLI of a particular external caller.Calls from that number, except hunt group calls, will ignore the user's Do Not Disturb setting. For further details see Do Not Disturb (DND) in the Telephone Features section.

Advanced -> Do Not Disturb -> Do Not Disturb Exception Add

Telephone number or CLI. Up to 31 characters. For CLI numbers any prefix added by the IP Office system must also be included.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Do Not Disturb Exception Delete

Removes a number from the user's "Do Not Disturb Exception List". This can be the number of an internal user or a number to match the CLI of a particular external caller.

Advanced -> Do Not Disturb -> Do Not Disturb Exception Delete

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Do Not Disturb Off

Cancels the user's 'do not disturb' mode if set. This button function is largely obsolete as the do not disturb on function toggles on/off and indicates the button status.

Advanced -> Do Not Disturb -> Do Not Disturb On

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Do Not Disturb On

Acts the same as Send All Calls . Note that for T3 phones, a Do Not Disturb On button programmed through the phone will be shown as a Send All Call button in the IP Office Manager configuration.

Advanced -> Do Not Disturb -> Do Not Disturb On

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

29. Button Feature List

document.xls Page 185

Description Action Action Data

Togg

les

Stat

us In

d

Use

r Ad

min

IP Office Phone Support

Anal

og

1400

Ser

ies

1600

Ser

ies

20 S

erie

s

2400

Ser

ies

3600

Ser

ies

3700

Ser

ies

3810

4100

Ser

ies

4400

Ser

ies

4600

Ser

ies

5400

Ser

ies

5600

Ser

ies

6400

Ser

ies

7400

Ser

ies

9040

9500

Ser

ies

9600

Ser

ies

M-S

erie

s

T-Se

ries

T3/T

3 IP

Ser

ies

Button Feature

IP OfficeSoftware

LevelDefault Label

Extn Login 1.1+ None Login √ √ X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Extn Logout 1.1+ None Logof X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Flash Hook 1.4+ Flash X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.1+ Here+ X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.1+ Here- X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.1+ FolTo √ √ X X √ X X √ X √ √ X √ √ √ √ √ X

1.1+ None FwdH+ √ √ X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.1+ None FwdH- X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

1.1+ FwdNo X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.1+ FwBNo X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.1+ None FwBOf X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

This feature allows user configured with a log in code to take over ownership of an physical extension. That user'sassociated extension number becomes the number of the extension while they are logged in along with all their usersettings (if appropriate to the phone type).If the user logging in was already logged in or associated with another phone, they will be automatically logged out thatphone.When used, the user will be prompted to enter their extension number and then their log in code. Login codes of up to 15digits are supported with Extn Login buttons. Login codes of up to 31 digits are supported with Extn Login short codes.

Advanced -> Extn -> Extn Login

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Logs out a user from the phone. The phone will return to its normal default user, if an extension number is set against the physical extension settings in the configuration. Otherwise it takes the setting of the NoUser user. This action is obsolete as Extn Login can be used to log out an existing logged in user.If the user who logged out was the default user for an extension, dialing *36 will associate the extension with the user unless they are set to forced login.For IP Office 4.0 and higher this feature cannot be used by a user who does not have a login code.

Advanced -> Extn -> Extn Logout

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Sends a hook flash signal to the currently connected line if that line is an analog line. For IP Office 4.0+ this can be used for a Centrex Transfer for calls on lines from a Centrex service provider.

Advanced -> Miscellaneous -> Flash Hook

Optional.Normally this field is left blank. For IP Office 4.0+ it can contain the destination number for a Centrex Transfer for external calls on a line from a Centrex service provider.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Follow Me Here

Causes calls to the extension number specified, to be redirected to this user's extension. IP Office 4.0+ user's with a log in code will be prompted to enter that code when using this function.

Advanced -> Follow Me -> Follow Me Here

User name or user number. For IP Office 4.0+ this field can be left blank for number entry whenpressed .· For IP Office 4.0+, on large display phones, if configured without a preset target this type of button will display an interactive button menu for target selection.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Follow Me Here Cancel

Cancels any 'Follow Me Here' set on the specified extension. Only works if entered at the extension to which the extension's calls are being sent by the follow me action.

Advanced -> Follow Me -> Follow Me Here Cancel

User number or blank for number entry when pressed .· For IP Office 4.0+, on large display phones, if configured without a preset target this type of button will display an interactive button menu for target selection.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Follow Me To

Leaving the extension blank prompts the user to enter the extension to which their calls should be redirected.IP Office 4+ user's with a login code will be prompted to enter that code when using this function.

Advanced -> Follow Me -> Follow Me To

User name or user number or blank for number entry when pressed . If already enabled the button cancels the Follow Me To.· For IP Office 4.0+, on large display phones, if configured without a preset target this type of button will display an interactive button menu for target selection.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1]

Forward Hunt Group Calls On

Forward the user's hunt group calls. This function only works when forward unconditional is also on and uses the same forwarding number as forward unconditional.This option is only applied for calls to Sequential and Rotary type hunt groups. Calls from other hunt group types are not presented to the user when they have Forward Unconditional active. Note also that hunt group calls cannot be forwarded to another hunt group.

Advanced -> Forward -> Forward Hunt Group Calls On

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Forward Hunt Group Calls Off

Cancels the forwarding of the user's hunt group calls. This function is largely obsolete since the button function Forward Hunt Group Calls On toggles on/off and indicates status.

Advanced -> Forward -> Forward Hunt Group Calls Off

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Forward Number

Sets the number to which calls are forwarded when the user has forwarding on. Used for all forwarding options unless a separate Forward On Busy Number is also set. Forwarding to an external number is blocked if Inhibit Off-Switch Transfers is selected within the system configuration.

Advanced -> Forward -> Forward Number

Any number or, IP Office 4.0+, blank for entry when pressed.Telephone number.· IP Office 4.0+ allows this field to be left blank to prompt the user for entry when the button is pressed . Also if blank, IP Office 4.0+ users with a log in code will be prompted to enter that code.· For IP Office 4.0+, on large display phones, if configured without a preset target this type of button will display an interactive button menu for target selection.

XPre-4.0√ 4.0+

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Forward On Busy Number

Sets the number to which calls are forwarded when using 'Forward on Busy' and/or 'Forward on No Answer'. Forwarding to an external number is blocked if Inhibit Off-Switch Transfers is selected within the system configuration.

Advanced -> Forward -> Forward on Busy Number

Telephone number.· IP Office 4.0+ allows this field to be left blank to prompt the user for entry when the button is pressed . Also if blank, IP Office 4.0+ users with a log in code will be prompted to enter that code.· For IP Office 4.0+, on large display phones, if configured without a preset target this type of button will display an interactive button menu for target selection.

XPre-4.0√ 4.0+

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Forward On Busy Off

Switches forward on busy off. This button function is largely obsolete, as Forward On Busy On can be used to switch forward on busy on/off and provides status indication.

Advanced -> Forward -> Forward on Busy Off

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

29. Button Feature List

document.xls Page 186

Description Action Action Data

Togg

les

Stat

us In

d

Use

r Ad

min

IP Office Phone Support

Anal

og

1400

Ser

ies

1600

Ser

ies

20 S

erie

s

2400

Ser

ies

3600

Ser

ies

3700

Ser

ies

3810

4100

Ser

ies

4400

Ser

ies

4600

Ser

ies

5400

Ser

ies

5600

Ser

ies

6400

Ser

ies

7400

Ser

ies

9040

9500

Ser

ies

9600

Ser

ies

M-S

erie

s

T-Se

ries

T3/T

3 IP

Ser

ies

Button Feature

IP OfficeSoftware

LevelDefault Label

1.1+ None FwBOn √ √ X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.1+ None FwNOf X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

1.1+ None FwNOn √ √ X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.1+ None FwUOf X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

1.1+ None FwUOn √ √ X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

4.1+ None. √ √ X X X X X X X X X X X √ X √ X X √ X X X X

Hold Call 1.1+ Hold X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

Hold CW 1.1+ None HoldCW X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

1.1+ HGDis X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

1.1+ HGEna √ √ X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Hold Music 1.1+ Music X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

4.0+ None MCID X X X X √ X X √ X √ √ X X √ √ √ √ √ X

1.1+ None OHStn √ √ X X √ √ X X X √ X √ √ X √ √ √ √ √ X

Park Park slot number Park √ √ X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Forward On Busy On

Enables forwarding when the user's extension is busy. For users with call appearance buttons, they will only return busy when all call appearance buttons are in use. Uses the Forward Number as its destination unless a separate Forward on Busy Number is set.For IP Office 3.2 and higher, Forward Internal (User | Forwarding) can also be used to control whether internal calls are forwarded.

Advanced -> Forward -> Forward on Busy On

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Forward On No Answer Off

Switches forward on no answer on/off. The time used to determine the call as unanswered is the user's no answer time. Uses the Forward Number as its destination unless a separate Forward on Busy Number is set.For IP Office 3.2 and higher, Forward Internal (User | Forwarding) can also be used to control whether internal calls are forwarded.

Advanced -> Forward -> Forward on No Answer Off

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Forward On No Answer On

Switches forward on no answer on/off. The time used to determine the call as unanswered is the user's no answer time. Uses the Forward Number as its destination unless a separate Forward on Busy Number is set.For IP Office 3.2 and higher, Forward Internal (User | Forwarding) can also be used to control whether internal calls are forwarded.

Advanced -> Forward -> Forward on No Answer On

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Forward Unconditional Off

Switch 'forward all calls' off. This does not affect 'Forward on No Answer' and/or 'Forward on Busy' if also on. This function is largely obsolete as a button set to Forward Unconditional On toggles on/off and indicates when on.

Advanced -> Forward -> Forward Unconditional Off

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Forward Unconditional On

This function is also know as 'divert all' and 'forward all'. It forwards all calls, except hunt group and page calls, to the forward number set for the user's extension. To also forward hunt group calls to the same number 'Forward Hunt Group Calls On' must also be used.For IP Office 3.2 and higher, Forward Internal (User | Forwarding) can also be used to control whether internal calls are forwarded.In addition to the lamp indication shown below, most phones display D when forward unconditional is on.

Advanced -> Forward -> Forward Unconditional On

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Group Listen On

Using group listen allows callers to be heard through the phone's handsfree speaker but to only hear thephone's handset microphone. When group listen is enabled, it modifies the hands free functionality of theshort code user’s terminal in the following manner• When the user’s phone is placed in handsfree / speaker mode, the speech path from theconnected party is broadcast on the phone speaker but the phone's base microphone is disabled.• The connected party can only hear speech delivered directly by the short code user's handsetmicrophone.• Group listen is not supported for IP phones or when using a phone's HEADSET button.• Currently connected calls are not affected by changes to this setting. If group listen is required itmust be selected before the call is connected.This enables listeners local to the short code user’s phone to hear the connected party whilst limiting theconnected party to hear only what is communicated via the user’s handset.· M-Series/T-Series: The button is equivalent to Feature 802 (On) and Feature #802 (Off).

Advanced -> Extension -> Group Listen On.

Group Listen On

√[1]

This uses the Q.931 Hold facility, and "holds" the incoming call at the ISDN exchange, freeing up the ISDN B channel. The Hold Call feature "holds" the current call to a slot. The current call is always automatically placed into slot 0 if it has not been placed in a specified slot. Only available if supported by the ISDN exchange.

Advanced -> Hold -> Hold Call

ISDN Exchange hold slot number or blank (slot 0). √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Place the user's current call on hold and answers the waiting call. This function is not supported on phones which have multiple call appearance buttons set.

Advanced -> Hold -> Hold CW

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Hunt Group Disable

This function is obsolete, the Hunt Group Enable function being able to toggle membership between enabled and disabled and providing lamp indication of when membership is enabled.An individual user's membership of any particular hunt groups is programmed through the IP Office configuration. This control allows the user to disable that membership. They will no longer receive calls to that hunt group until their membership is enabled again.

Hunt Group -> Hunt Group Disable

Group number or name or blank for all groups. √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Hunt Group Enable

An individual users membership of any particular hunt groups is programmed through the IP Office configuration. This control allows the user to enable or disable that membership. While enabled, the user can receive hunt group calls when logged on.In addition to the lamp indication below, most phones display G when any group membership is enabled.

Hunt Group -> Hunt Group Enable

Group number or name or blank for all groups. √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

This feature allows the user to listen to the system's music on hold. See Music On Hold for more information.

Advanced -> Hold -> Hold Music

Optional.IP Office 4.2+ (not Small Office Edition) supports up to 4 hold music sources. However only the system source is supported for Hold Music buttons.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

MCID Activate

This action is used with ISDN Malicious Caller ID call tracing. It is used to trigger a call trace at the ISDN exchange. The call trace information is then provided to the appropriate legal authorities.This option requires the line to the ISDN to have MCID enabled at both the ISDN exchange and on the IP Office. The user must also be configured with Can Trace Calls enabled (User | Telephony).

Miscellaneous -> MCID Activate

√ √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1]

Off Hook Station

Enables the user's extension to be controlled by an IP Office application, for example Phone Manager or SoftConsole. Calls can then be answered and cleared through the application without having to manually go off or on hook. Requires the phone to support full handsfree operation.

Advanced -> Miscellaneous -> Off Hook Station

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1]

Monitors the status of an IP Office system park slot. The user can use the button to park a call into that slot and to also retrieve a call parked in that slot including calls parked by other users.

Park buttons with indication will indicate when the park slot is in use. Similarly the Park buttons within the Phone Manager and SoftConsole applications can be used to park, retrieve and indicate parked calls.

For IP Office 4.0 and higher this function has been replaced by Emulation | Call Park

1.0 to3.2 only

Advanced -> Call -> Park Call √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

29. Button Feature List

document.xls Page 187

Description Action Action Data

Togg

les

Stat

us In

d

Use

r Ad

min

IP Office Phone Support

Anal

og

1400

Ser

ies

1600

Ser

ies

20 S

erie

s

2400

Ser

ies

3600

Ser

ies

3700

Ser

ies

3810

4100

Ser

ies

4400

Ser

ies

4600

Ser

ies

5400

Ser

ies

5600

Ser

ies

6400

Ser

ies

7400

Ser

ies

9040

9500

Ser

ies

9600

Ser

ies

M-S

erie

s

T-Se

ries

T3/T

3 IP

Ser

ies

Button Feature

IP OfficeSoftware

LevelDefault Label

Park Call Park slot number. Park √ √ X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ √ √ X

Priority Call 1.1+ User number or name. Pcall X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Private Call 4.0+ None PrivC √ √ X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Relay Off 1.1+ Switch number (1 or 2). Rely- X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

Relay On 1.1+ Switch number (1 or 2). Rely+ X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Relay Pulse 1.1+ Switch number (1 or 2). Relay X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Resume Call 1.1+ ISDN Exchange slot number. Resum X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

Retrieve Call 1.1+ ISDN Exchange slot number. Retriv X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

1.1+ None RBak+ X √ X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.1+ Absnt X X X X √ X X √ X √ √ X √ √ √ √ √ X

2.1+ Acct X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.1+ HGNS+ √ √ X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.1+ HGOS+ √ √ X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.1+ ICSeq X X X √ X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X

For IP Office 4.0 and higher this function has been replaced by Emulation | Call Park 1.0 to

3.2Only

Advanced -> Call -> Park Call

This feature allows the user to call another user even if they are set to 'do not disturb'. A priority call will follow forward and follow me settings but will not go to voicemail.

Advanced -> Call -> Priority Call

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

When on, any subsequent calls cannot be intruded on, bridged into or silently monitored until the user's private call status is switched off.Note that use of private calls is separate from the user's intrusion settings. If a user is set to Cannot be Intruded, switching private calls off does not affect that status. To allow private calls to be used to fully control the user status, Cannot be Intruded should be disabled for that user.If enabled during a call, any current recording, intrusion or monitoring is ended.

Advanced -> Call -> Private Call

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Opens the specified switch in the system's external output port (EXT O/P). Advanced -> Relay -> Relay Off

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Closes the specified switch in the system's external output port (EXT O/P). Advanced -> Relay -> Relay On

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Closes the specified switch in the system's external output port (EXT O/P) for 5 seconds and then opens the switch.

Advanced -> Relay -> Relay Pulse

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Resume a call previously suspended to the specified ISDN exchange slot. The suspended call may be resumed from another phone/ISDN Control Unit on the same line.

Advanced -> Call -> Resume Call

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Retrieves a call previously held to a specific ISDN exchange slot. Only available when supported by the ISDN exchange.

Advanced -> Call -> Retrieve Call

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Ring Back When Free

Sets a ringback on the extension being called. When the target extension ends its current call, the ringback users is rung (for their set No Answer Time/Allocated Answer Interval) and if they answer, a new call is made to the target extension.Ringback can be cleared using the Cancel Ring Back When Free function.

Advanced -> Miscellaneous -> Ring Back When Free

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Set Absent Text

This feature can be used select the user's current absence text. Note: The user still has to select Set or Clear on their phone to display or hide the text. This text is then displayed to internal callers who have suitable display phones or applications.The text is displayed to callers even if the user has forwarded their calls or is using follow me. Absence text is supported across a Small Community Network (SCN).The absence text message is limited to 128 characters. Note however that most amount displayed will depend on the caller's device or application.

Advanced -> Set -> Set Absent Text

The telephone number should take the format "y,n,text" where:• y = 0 or 1 to turn this feature on or off.• n = the number of the absent statement to use:• 0 = None.• 1 = On vacation until.• 2 = Will be back.• 3 = At lunch until.• 4 = Meeting until.• 5 = Please call.• 6 = Don't disturb until.• 7 = With visitors until.• 8 = With cust. til.• 9 = Back soon.• 10 = Back tomorrow.• 11 = Custom.• text = any text to follow the absent statement.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1]

Set Account Code

Dials an account code and then returns dial tone for the user to dial a number. Can also be used to enter an account code after a call has been connected.

Advanced -> Set -> Set Account Code

Account code or blank.If blank, the user is prompted to dial an account code after pressing the button. This option is not supported on XX02 phone modules.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Set Hunt Group Night Service

Puts the specified hunt group into 'Night Service' mode. Calls to a group set to night service, receive busy or are diverted to voicemail if available or are diverted to the group's night service fallback group if set.This function cannot be used to override hunt groups already set to night service mode by an associated time profile.

Advanced -> Set -> Set Hunt Group Night Service

Hunt group extension number.· IP Office 4.0+: If left blank, the button will affect all hunt groups of which the user is a member.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Set Hunt Group Out Of Service

Puts the specified hunt group into 'Out of Service' mode. Calls to a group set to out of service receive busy or are diverted to voicemail if available or are diverted to the group's out of service fallback group if set.For pre-IP Office 4.0 systems this function cannot be used to override hunt groups already set to night service mode by an associated time profile.For IP Office 4.0 systems this function can be used to used to override hunt groups already set to night service mode by an associated time profile.

Advanced -> Set -> Set Hunt Group Out of Service

Hunt group extension number.· IP Office 4.0+: If left blank, the button will affect all hunt groups of which the user is a member.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Set Inside Call Seq

Only supported for analog extensions. The distinctive ringing pattern used for other phones is set by the phone type. See the Set Inside Call Seq short code.

Advanced -> Set -> Set Inside Call Sequence

0 to 10 as follows:• 0 = Default system ring.• 1 = Ring Normal (varies according to system locale).• 2 = Ring Type 1: 1 on/2 off/...• 3 = Ring Type 2: 0.25 on/0.25 off/0.25 on/0.25 off/0.25 on/1.75 off/...• 4 = Ring Type 3: 0.4 on/0.8 off/...• 5 = Ring Type 4: 2 on/4 off/...• 6 = Ring Type 5: 2 on/2 off/...• 7 = Ring Type 6: 0.945 on/4.5 off/...• 8 = Ring Type 7: 0.25 on/0.24 off/0.25 on/2.25 off/...• 9 = Ring Type 8: 1 on/3 off/...• 10 = Ring Type 9: 1 on/4 off/...

X[2]

29. Button Feature List

document.xls Page 188

Description Action Action Data

Togg

les

Stat

us In

d

Use

r Ad

min

IP Office Phone Support

Anal

og

1400

Ser

ies

1600

Ser

ies

20 S

erie

s

2400

Ser

ies

3600

Ser

ies

3700

Ser

ies

3810

4100

Ser

ies

4400

Ser

ies

4600

Ser

ies

5400

Ser

ies

5600

Ser

ies

6400

Ser

ies

7400

Ser

ies

9040

9500

Ser

ies

9600

Ser

ies

M-S

erie

s

T-Se

ries

T3/T

3 IP

Ser

ies

Button Feature

IP OfficeSoftware

LevelDefault Label

4.2+ SetNSG X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.1+ Time in seconds (range 6 to 99999). NATim X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.1+ OCSeq X X X √ X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X

4.2+ SetOOSG X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.1+ RBSeq X X X √ X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X

1.1+ Time in seconds (range 0 to 99999). WUTim X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.1+ Suspe X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

Suspend CW 1.1+ SusCW X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

Toggle Calls Cycle between the user's current call and any held calls. 1.1+ None Toggl X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

Unpark Call 1.1+ Park slot ID (alphanumeric). Ride X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

1.1+ See notes. VMCol X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.1+ None VMOff X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

1.1+ None VMOn X √ X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

1.1+ None VMRB- X X X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ X X X X

Set Night Service Group

This button allows the user to change the Night Service target of a hunt group. The button user does not have to be a member of the hunt group. For Small Community Networks this function can be used for hunt groups on remote systems.When pressed, the user is prompted to enter or select a hunt group as the Night Service destination. Changing the destination does not affect calls already ringing at the hunt groups previous night service destination.

Advanced -> Set -> Set Night Service Group.

Hunt group extension number. This is the group for which the night service destination is being set.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Set No Answer Time

Allows the user to change their no answer time setting. This is the time calls will ring before going to voicemail or following the user's divert on no answer setting if set on.In situations where call coverage is also being used, the user's no answer time must be greater than their individual coverage time for coverage to occur.

Advanced -> Set -> Set No Answer Time

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Set Outside Call Seq

Only supported for analog extensions. The distinctive ringing pattern used for other phones is set by the phone type. See the Set Outside Call Seq short code.

Advanced -> Set -> Set Outside Call Sequence

0 to 10 as follows:• 0 = Default system ring.• 1 = Ring Normal (varies according to system locale).• 2 = Ring Type 1: 1 on/2 off/...• 3 = Ring Type 2: 0.25 on/0.25 off/0.25 on/0.25 off/0.25 on/1.75 off/...• 4 = Ring Type 3: 0.4 on/0.8 off/...• 5 = Ring Type 4: 2 on/4 off/...• 6 = Ring Type 5: 2 on/2 off/...• 7 = Ring Type 6: 0.945 on/4.5 off/...• 8 = Ring Type 7: 0.25 on/0.24 off/0.25 on/2.25 off/...• 9 = Ring Type 8: 1 on/3 off/...• 10 = Ring Type 9: 1 on/4 off/.

Set Out of Service Group

This button allows the user to change the Out of Service target of a hunt group. The button user does not have to be a member of the hunt group. For Small Community Networks this function can be used for hunt groups on remote systems.When pressed, the user is prompted to enter or select a hunt group as the Out of Service destination. Changing the destination does not affect calls already ringing at the hunt groups previous Out of Service destination.

Advanced -> Set -> Set Out of Service Group

Hunt group extension number. This is the group for which the night service destination is being set.

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Set Ringback Seq

Only supported for analog extensions. The distinctive ringing pattern used for other phones is set by the phone type. See the Set Ringback Seq short code.

Advanced -> Set -> Set Ringback Call Sequence

0 to 10 as follows:• 0 = Default system ring.• 1 = Ring Normal (varies according to system locale).• 2 = Ring Type 1: 1 on/2 off/...• 3 = Ring Type 2: 0.25 on/0.25 off/0.25 on/0.25 off/0.25 on/1.75 off/...• 4 = Ring Type 3: 0.4 on/0.8 off/...• 5 = Ring Type 4: 2 on/4 off/...• 6 = Ring Type 5: 2 on/2 off/...• 7 = Ring Type 6: 0.945 on/4.5 off/...• 8 = Ring Type 7: 0.25 on/0.24 off/0.25 on/2.25 off/...• 9 = Ring Type 8: 1 on/3 off/...• 10 = Ring Type 9: 1 on/4 off/...

Set Wrap Up Time

Allows the user to change their Wrap-up Time setting. Specifies the amount of time after ending one call before another call can ring. During this interval the user is treated as still being on a call. It is recommended that this option is not set to less than the default of 2 seconds. 0 is used to allow immediate ringing.

Advanced -> Set -> Set Wrap Up Time

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Suspend Call

Uses the Q.931 Suspend facility. Suspends the incoming call at the ISDN exchange, freeing up the ISDN B channel. The call is placed in exchange slot 0 if a slot number is not specified. Only available when supported by the ISDN exchange.

Advanced -> Suspend -> Suspend.

Exchange slot number or blank (slot 0). √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Uses the Q.931 Suspend facility. Suspends the incoming call at the ISDN exchange and answer the call waiting. The call is placed in exchange slot 0 if a slot number is not specified. Only available when supported by the ISDN exchange.

Advanced -> Suspend -> Suspend CW

Exchange slot number or blank (slot 0). √[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Advanced -> Call -> Toggle Calls

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

This function is obsolete, since the Park function can be used to both park and retrieve calls and provides visual indication of when calls are parked. Retrieve a parked call from a specified system park slot.

Advanced -> Call -> Unpark Call

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Voicemail Collect

Connects to the voicemail server. The telephone number must indicate the name of the Voicemail box to be accessed, eg. "?Extn201" or "#Extn201". The ? indicates "collect Voicemail" and the # indicates "deposit Voicemail". This action is not supported by voicemail using IP Office Intuity emulation mode.

When used with Voicemail Pro, names of specific call flow start points can also be used to directly access those start points via a short code. In these cases ? is not used and # is only used if ringing is required before the start points call flow begins.

Advanced -> Voicemail -> Voicemail Collect

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Voicemail Off

Disables the user's voicemail box from answering calls that ring unanswered at the users extension. This button function is largely obsolete as the Voicemail On function toggles on/off.

This does not disable the user's mailbox and other methods of placing messages into their mailbox.

Advanced -> Voicemail -> Voicemail Off

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Voicemail On

Enables the user's voicemail mailbox to answer calls which ring unanswered or arrive when the user is busy.

Advanced -> Voicemail -> Voicemail On

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Voicemail Ringback Off

This button function is largely obsolete as the Voicemail Ringback On function toggles on/off. Disables voicemail ringback to the user's extension.

Advanced -> Voicemail -> Voicemail Ringback Off

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

29. Button Feature List

document.xls Page 189

Description Action Action Data

Togg

les

Stat

us In

d

Use

r Ad

min

IP Office Phone Support

Anal

og

1400

Ser

ies

1600

Ser

ies

20 S

erie

s

2400

Ser

ies

3600

Ser

ies

3700

Ser

ies

3810

4100

Ser

ies

4400

Ser

ies

4600

Ser

ies

5400

Ser

ies

5600

Ser

ies

6400

Ser

ies

7400

Ser

ies

9040

9500

Ser

ies

9600

Ser

ies

M-S

erie

s

T-Se

ries

T3/T

3 IP

Ser

ies

Button Feature

IP OfficeSoftware

LevelDefault Label

1.1+ None VMRB+ √ √ X X √ √ X X √ X √ √ √ X √ √ √ √ √

Phone Support Notes[1]

[2] May have limited support on some specific T3 phone models.[3] Supported on 4606, 4612 and 4624 only.[4] Not T7100 model

Note 1

Note 2

Note 3

Note 4Phone

Idle Call the user.Ringing Displays an option to pickup the call. Picks up the call.

On a Call No action.

· CALL For 1400, 1600, 9500 and Initiates a call to the users. 9600 Series phones, the

· MESSAGE Call, Voicemail and Callbackoptions are supported.

· VOICEMAILCall the user's voicemail mailbox.

· CALLBACKSet an automatic callback.

· DropDisconnect the user's current call.

If configured to be able to intrude on the user:· Acquire

Take control of the call.· Intrude

Intrude into the call, turning it into a 3-way conference.If configured to be able to listen to the user:

· ListenStart silent monitoring of the user's call.

Voicemail Ringback On

Enables voicemail ringback to the user's extension. Voicemail ringback is used to call the user when they have new voicemail messages in their own mailbox or a hunt group mailbox for which they have been configured with message waiting indication.The ringback takes place when the user's phone returns to idle after any call is ended.

Advanced -> Voicemail -> Voicemail Ringback On

√[1] √[1] √[1] √[1] X[2]

Not 1403, 1603, 4601, 4602, 5601 and 5602 except where 4602 is supported on IP Office 2.1 and 3.0DT software.

Dir - Directory.Drop - Drop.HFAns - Internal Auto-Answer.Timer - Timer.AutCB - Automatic Callback.Prog - Abbreviated Dial Program.CFrwd - Call Forwarding All.Park - Park Call (pre-4.0)CPark - Call Park (4.0+).RPark - Call Park to Other Extension (4.0+).SAC - Send All Calls.TmDay - Time of Day.Admin - Self-Administer.

Acct - Account Code Entry.AD - Abbreviated Dial.Park - Call Park to Other Extn.GrpPg - Group Paging.CPkUp - Call Pickup.DPkUp - Directed Call Pickup.RngOf - Ringer Off.Spres - AD Suppress.HdSet - Headset Toggle.HGNS+ - Set Hunt Group Night Service.Flash - Hook Flash (4.0+).BkOut - Breakout (4.0+).

Dial (pre-4.0).XX - Abbreviated Dial (4.0+).GroupPark (pre-4.0).CPark (4.0+).User.Flash Hook.• Abbreviated Dial (129), Abbreviated Dial Pause (130), Abbreviated Dial Program (7), Abbreviated Dial Stop (148), Account Code Entry (128), ACD Agent Statistics (147), ACD Stroke Count (135), AD Special Function Mark (142), AD Special Function Wait (149), AD Special Functions (145), AD Suppress (146), Automatic Callback (6), Automatic Intercom (139), Call Forwarding All (8), Call Park (9), Call Park To Other Extension (143), Call Pickup (132), Cancel Leave Word Calling (133), Consult (134), Dial Intercom (140), Directed Call Pickup (136), Send All Calls (10), Stored Number View (150), Time of Day (11), Timer (4).

Large display 1400, 1600, 2400, 4600, 5400, 5600, 9500, 9600, M-Series and T-Series Phones

Other Phones or Across Small Community Network

For IP Office 4.0+ the following options are displayed (name lengths may vary depending on the phone display):

Cause a single burst of ringing on the target phone. On some phones, when they end their current call their phone will then display PLEASE CALL and your extension number.

For 1400, 1600, 9500 and 9600 Series phones the following additional options are displayed:

30. Set Button Display Status

document.xls Page 190

Button Action Status 24XX/54XX 46XX/56XX 16XX/44XX/64XX T-Series/M-Series

Group- No calls Main Main Not lit- Call alerting Green flash- Calls queued Main Main Red flash

Park Call- No parked call PARK1 PARK1 Off- Parked here Green flash- Parked elsewhere PARK1 PARK1 Red flash

User

- Idle Extn221 Extn221 Not lit Off- Alerting Green flash- In Use/Busy Extn221 Extn221 Green on- DND Extn221 Extn221 Green on

AD Suppress - On Spres Green on- Off Spres Spres Off Off

Automatic Callback - On AutCB Green on- Off AutCB AutCB Off Off

Call Forwarding All - On CFrwd Green on- Off CFrwd CFrwd Off Off

Call Park- Calls parked by extension Cpark Green flash- Call Parked by other extension Cpark Cpark Red flash- No parked calls Cpark Cpark Off Off

Call Park To Other Extension - Parked Call Rpark Green flash- No parked call Rpark Rpark Off Off

Internal Auto-Answer - On HFAns Green on- Off HFAns HFAns Off Off

Ringer Off - On (no ring) RngOf Green on- Off (ring) RngOf RngOf Off Off

Send All Calls - On SAC Green on- Off SAC SAC Off Off

Time of Day - On TmDay Green on- Off TmDay TmDay Off Off

Timer - On Timer Green on- Off Timer Timer Off Off

Twinning- On Twinning Green on- Off Twinning Twinning Off Off- Twinned call at secondary Red on

Call Waiting On - On CWOn Green on- Off CWOn CWOn Off Off

Do Not Disturb On - On DNDOn Green on- Off DNDOn DNDOn Off

Follow Me To - On FolTo Green on- Off FolTo FolTo Off Off

Forward Hunt Group Calls On - On FwDH+ Green on- Off FwdH+ FwDH+ Off Off

Forward On Busy On - On FwBOn Green on- Off FwBOn FwBOn Off Off

Mainu Mainu Slow flash Slow flash

PARK1u PARK1u

Extn221 Extn221u Slow flash Fast flash On

Spres On

AutCB On

CFrwd On

Cparku Slow flash Fast flash

Rparku Slow flash

HFAns On

RngOf On

SAC On

TmDay On

Timer On

Twinning On

Twinning Twinningu OnCWOn On

DNDOn

FolTo On

FwdH+ On

FwBOn On

30. Set Button Display Status

document.xls Page 191

Forward On No Answer On - On FwNOn Green on- Off FwNOn FwNOn Off Off

Forward Unconditional On - On FwUOn Green on- Off FwUOn FwUOn Off Off

Hunt Group Enable - On HGEna Green on- Off HGEna HGEna Off Off

Off Hook Station - On OHStn Green on- Off OHStn OHStn Off Off

Private Call - On Green on. - Off Off Off

Ring Back When Free - On AutCB+ Green on- Off AutCB AutCB+ Off Off

Set Hunt Group Night Service - On Green on- Off Off Off

Set Hunt Group Out Of Service - On Green on- Off Off Off

Voicemail On - On Green on- Off Off Off

Voicemail Ringback On - On Green on- Off Off Off

FwNOn On

FwUOn On

HGEna On

OHStn On

PrivC PrivC OnPrivC PrivC AutCB On

HGNS+200 HGNS+200 OnHGNS+200 HGNS+200 HGOS+200 HGOS+200 OnHGOS+200 HGOS+200 VMOn VMOn OnVMOn VMOn VMRB+ VMRB+ OnVMRB+ VMRB+

30. Set Button Display Status

document.xls Page 192

T3 Phone Set StatusButton Action T3 Set Status DSS Link LEDDial None

User

Account Code Entry None

Automatic Intercom None

Call Pickup Classic/Comfort icon: Displays . NoneCall List

Dial Intercom None

Directory NoneGroup Paging None

Headset Toggle On when active.

Internal Auto-Answer On when active.

Send All Calls On when active.Call Pickup Any NoneCall Pickup Group NoneCall Pickup Members None

Dial Paging None

Do Not Disturb On On when active.Follow Me Here On when active.

Forward Unconditional On On when active.

Hunt Group Enable On when active.

Relay Pulse NoneSet Account Code None

Classic/Comfort icon: Displays the telephone number set.Classic/Comfort icon: Displays the user name.

On when busy, flashing when call alerting user.

Classic/Comfort icon: Displays 1234.

Classic/Comfort icon: Displays followed by the set number.

Classic/Comfort icon: Displays LIST. On when calls are in the list. Flashes when new calls are in the list.Classic/Comfort icon: Displays

followed by the set number.Classic/Comfort icon: Displays .Classic/Comfort icon: Displays followed by target number if set.Classic/Comfort icon: Displays HdSet

Classic/Comfort icon: Displays HfAns.

Classic/Comfort icon: Displays .Classic/Comfort icon: Displays .Classic/Comfort icon: Displays . followed by group name.Classic/Comfort icon: Displays . followed by group name.Classic/Comfort icon: Displays followed by target number if set.Classic/Comfort icon: Displays .Classic/Comfort icon: Displays followed by the user name.Classic/Comfort icon: Displays followed by the user name.Classic/Comfort icon: Displays followed by the group number or * for all if programmed with no specific group number.Classic/Comfort icon: Displays S1 or S2 dependant on switch number.Classic/Comfort icon: Displays 1234.

30. Set Button Display Status

document.xls Page 193

Set Hunt Group Night Service

Set Hunt Group Out Of Service

Voicemail On On when set.

Classic/Comfort icon: Displays followed by the group number. The background uses the same settings as the LED below.

On when all related groups are in night service. Slow flash if related hunt groups are in mixed states.

Classic/Comfort icon: Displays – followed by the group number. The background uses the same settings as the LED below.

On when set. On when all related groups are out of service. Slow flash if related hunt groups are in mixed states.Classic/Comfort icon: Displays

The background uses the same settings as the LED below.

31. SHORT CODE FEATURES

document.xls Page 194

Feature Description Telephone Number IP Office Release2.1 4.0 4.1 4.2 5 6.0 6.1 7.0

AOC Previous Call û û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü üAOC Reset Total û û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

AOC Total û û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Auto Attendant û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Break Out û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Barred û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Busy On Held û ü û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Call Intrude û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Call Listen

û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Call Pickup Any Pick up the first available ringing call. û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Call Pickup Extn Pick up a ringing call from a specific extension. û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Call Pickup Group Pick up a call ringing any hunt group of which the user is a member. û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Call Pickup Line û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Call Pickup User û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü

Call Queue û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Call Record û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Default ShortCode

Phone ManagerControl

Soft-ConsoleControl

ProgramButton Control

Display of advice of charge information is only supported on T3 phones, T3 IP phones and Phone Manager.Display of advice of charge information is only supported on T3 phones, T3 IP phones and Phone Manager.Display of advice of charge information is only supported on T3 phones, T3 IP phones and Phone Manager.This feature is used with embedded voicemail on Small Office Edition, IP406 V2 and IP500 and IP500v2 systems. It allows the recording of the greetings used by auto-attendant services and the transfer of calls to that auto attendant. This feature was previously called Record Greeting.

ü

• For pre-IP Office 4.1

Four system short codes are automatically added for each auto attendant. These use a telephone number of the form AA:Name.Y where Name is replaced by the Auto Attendant name and Y is 1, 2, 3 or 4 for the morning,

afternoon, evening or menu option greeting. • You can manually delete the short codes or add

additional short codes as required. • To create a short code to access an auto attendant, for example to allow internal calls to an auto attendant, omit

the .Y part of the short code telephone number. • For IP Office 4.1+

Four system short codes (*81XX, *82XX, *83XX and *84XX) are automatically added for use with all auto

attendants, for the morning, afternoon, evening and menu options greetings respectively. These use a telephone number of the form "AA:"N".Y" where N is the replaced

with the auto attendant number dialed and Y is 1, 2, 3 or 4 for the morning, afternoon, evening or menu option

greeting. • An additional short code of the form (for example)

*80XX / Auto Attendant / "AA:"N can be added manual if internal dialed access to auto attendants is required. • For IP Office 4.1+, to add a short code to access a

specific auto attendant, the name method as used for pre-IP Office 4.1 should be used.

üSee Configuration Settings | Auto

Attendant

This feature is usable within an IP Office Small Community Network. It allows a user on one system in the network to specify that the following dialing be processed by another IP Office system on the network as if the user dialed it locally on that other system. This feature is not supported for SIP extensions.For pre-IP Office Release 5 systems, this feature requires the IP Offices to have Advanced Small Community Networking licenses.

ü

The IP Address of the IP Office system, using * characters in place of . characters.

üAdvanced Dial BkOut

This short code feature can be used for call barring by using the short code as the call destination. This short code feature was previously called Busy. It has been renamed but its function has not changed.When used in an ARS form that has been configured with an Alternate Route, for callers whose dialing has matched the short code no further routing is applied.When on, busy on held returns busy to new calls when the user has an existing call on hold. This short code feature is useful when a user does not want to be distracted by an additional incoming call when they have a call on hold.

Y or 1 for on, N

ü BusyH

This feature intrudes on the existing connected call of the specified target extension. All call parties are put into a conference and can talk to and hear each other. Use of this feature is subject to the Can Intrude status of the intruder and the Cannot be Intruded status of the target.A Call Intrude attempt to a user who is idle becomes a Priority Call. • Note that this feature requires conference resources from the IP Office system for the duration of the intrusion.• IP Office 4.0+ provides privacy features that allow users to indicate that a call cannot be intruded on. See Private Calls.• For IP Office 4.2+, intruding onto an a user doing silent monitoring (Call Listen ) is turned into a silent monitoring call.

ü

Target extension number.

ü Actions Intrude ü Intru

This feature allows a user to monitor another user's call without being heard. Monitoring is different from call intrusion. Note that this feature requires conference resources from the system for the duration of the intrusion.

ü Listn

• This feature uses system conference resources. If insufficient conference resource are available it will not be possible to use this feature.• For IP Office 4.0+ a number of new features are supported for call listening:• Users can be given privacy features that allow them to indicate that a call cannot be monitored. See Private Calls.• IP extensions can be monitored including those using direct media. Previously the monitoring of IP extensions could not be guaranteed.• The monitoring call can be initiated even if the target user is not currently on a call and remains active until the monitoring user clears the monitoring call.• The user who initiated the call listen can also record the call.• IP Office 4.2+: Intruding onto an a user doing silent monitoring (Call Listen) is turned into a silent monitoring call.• 1400, 1600, 9400, 9500 and 9600 Series phones with a user button can initiate listening using that button if the target user meets the criteria for listening.

ü *30 ü PickA

ü Target

extension number.ü *32*N# ü

CpkUp

ü *31 ü PickG

Pick up an incoming call which is presenting, held or parked. Pickup executed using Line Appearance ID specified in Telephone Number. For privacy reasons, Call Pickup Line cannot be used on a held or parked conference call. As this feature is applied to presenting single party held / parked calls only, user intrusion settings do not apply. This feature is not supported on T3 phones.

ü Target Line

Appearance ID.

ü Q2 2007 Maint.

Release

Call Pickup Members

This feature can be used to pick up any call to an extension that is a member of the Hunt Group specified. The incoming call can be as a result of a DID call to that extension, an internal call to that extension or an internal or external call to the Hunt Group.Note that this function will not work for calls to a hunt group member who currently has their membership disabled.

ü Group

number or "Group name".

ü *53*N#

ü PickM

Pick up an incoming call which is alerting, parked or held. The pickup uses the user extension number specified in Telephone Number field of the short code. If there are multiple calls, priority is given to picking up alerting, then parked and then held in that order of priority. It cannot be used to pickup conferenced calls. The normal user intrusion features are not applied to this pickup feature. This feature is not supported on T3 phones.

ü Target user

extension number.

üQ2 2007 Maint.

Release

Queue the current call to the destination phone, even when the destination phone is busy. This is the same as a transfer except it allows you to transfer to a busy phone.

ü Target

extension number.

ü *33*N#

ü Queue

This feature allows you to record a conversation. To use this requires Voicemail Pro. Refer to your local regulations in relation to the recording of calls.• IP Office 4.0+ provides privacy features that allow users to indicate that a call should not be recorded. See Private Calls.

ü Target

extension number.

ü Recor

31. SHORT CODE FEATURES

document.xls Page 195

Call Steal ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Call Waiting On û ü û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Call Waiting Off û ü û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü üCancels any existing ring back (also known as callback) set by the user. û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Change Login Code Allows a user to change their log in code. û û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü

û û û û û û û ü ü ü ü

Clear Call This feature can be used to end the current call. û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Clear CW û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Clear Quota This feature refreshes the time quota for all services or a specific service. û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü üConference Add û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

CW û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Dial This short code feature allows users to dial the number specified to an outside line. ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Dial 3K1 Sets the ISDN bearer capabilities to 3.1Khz audio call. û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Dial 56K Sets the ISDN bearer capabilities to 56Kbps data call. û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Dial 64K Sets the ISDN bearer capabilities to 64Kbps data call. û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Dial CW û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Dial Direct Call the extension specified and force automatic answer if supported by the telephone type. û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Dial Direct Hot Line û û û û û ü û û û û û û

Dial Emergency û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Dial Extn This feature can be used to dial an internal extension number (user or hunt group). û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

This function can be used with or without a specified user target.• If the specified target has alerting calls, the function will connect to the longest waiting call.• If the specified target has no alerting calls but does have a connected call, the function will take over the connected call, disconnecting the original user. This usage is subject to the Can Intrude setting of the user and the Cannot Be Intruded setting of the target. The feature is independent the intrude settings of the third party to the call. • If no target is specified, the function attempts to reclaim the users last transferred call if it has notbeen answered or has been answered by voicemail.

ü Target extension

number or blank for last call transferred.

ü *45*N# & *46

ü Actions Reclaim

ü Actions Reclaim

Callü Aquire

Enables call waiting on the user's extension. When on, if the user receives a second calls when already on a call, they hear a call waiting tone in the speech path.Call waiting settings are ignored for users with multiple call appearance buttons. In this case the appearance buttons are used to indicate additional calls. Call waiting is automatically applied for users with 'internal twinned' phones.

ü *15 ü CWOn

Disables call waiting on the user's extension. Call waiting may be applied for users with internal twinned phones regardless of their call waiting settings. ü *16 ü

CWOff

Call Waiting Suspend

For phones using call waiting, this feature temporarily disables call waiting for the duration of the usersnext call.

ü *70(A-Law only)

ü CWSus

Cancel All Forwarding

This feature cancels all forms of forwarding on the user's extension including "Follow Me" and "Do NotDisturb".

ü *00 ü FwdOf

Cancel Ring Back When Free

ü RBak-

ü The

user's current and new log in codes separated by a *.

ü Q2 2008 Maint.

Release

Clear After Call Work

This feature can be users who have been configured as CCR agents. It allows them to dial a short code to exit the After Call Work (ACW) state as reported by the IP Office Customer Call Reporter (CCR) application.

ü acw

ü 4.2 4Q 2008

Maint. Release

ü *52 ü Clear

This feature is most commonly used to end the user's current call and answer the waiting call. Note: Call waiting settings are ignored for users with multiple call appearance buttons.

ü *26 (A-Law

only)ü ClrCW

Clear Hunt Group Night Service

This feature changes the specified hunt group from 'Night Service' mode to 'In Service' mode. This will not override a hunt group in night service due to a time profile.

ü Hunt group

extension number. For IP Office 4.0+, if left blank, the short code will affect all

hunt groups of which the user is a member.

ü *21*N#

ü HGNS-

Clear Hunt Group Out Of Service

This feature changes the specified hunt group from 'Out of Service' mode to 'In Service' mode. This will not override a hunt group in night service due to a time profile.

ü Hunt group

extension number. For IP Office 4.0+, if left blank, the short code will affect all

hunt groups of which the user is a member.

ü HGOS-

ü "Service name" or

"" (all services).

ü Quota

Places any calls the user has on hold into a conference with the user. This feature is useful for impromptu conferences. ü *47 ü

Conf+

Conference Meet Me

This feature allows a user to join a specific conference.

For pre-IP Office Release 5 systems, this function is not supported on IP500 systems without an IP500 Upgrade Standard to Professional license. For IP Office Release 6 and higher, IP500 and IP500 V2 systems require a Preferred Edition license.

ü Conference

number. This can be an alphanumeric value up to 15 characters.

ü CnfRv

Pick up the waiting call. This feature provides same functionality as pressing the Recall or Hold key on the phone. Unlike the Clear CW feature, this feature does not disconnect you from the existing call when the second call is picked up.

ü Telephone

number.

ü Various

depending on locale.

ü Dial

ü Telephone

number.

ü D3K1

ü Telephone

number.

ü D56K

ü Telephone

number.

ü D64K

Call the specified extension number and force call waiting indication on if the extension is already on a call.If the user has call appearance buttons programmed, call waiting will not get activated. The next incoming call will appear on an available call appearance button. When there are no available call appearance buttons, the next incoming call will receive busy tone.

ü Extension number.

ü DCW

ü Extension number.

ü Dirct

When the line appearance is mapped to a short code using the DialDirectHotLine short code feature, no secondary dial tone is generated and the number is dialed directly. This feature should not be confused with the hot line feature enabled using ?D short codes.

ü Telephone

number.

Dials the number specified regardless of any call barring applicable to the user.On all IP Office systems, regardless of locale, system and or ARS, short codes using the Dial Emergency feature should be created for any required emergency service numbers. Those short codes should be useable by all users from all extensions. Those short codes should route the calls to suitable lines. If the system uses prefixes for external dialing, the dialing of emergency numbers with and without the prefix should be allowed. Note that the blocking of emergency numbers or the routing of emergency numbers to a intermediate destination other than the emergency network may be against local and nation laws.For systems with a United States locale, the Dial Emergency short code acts differently. Calls matched to Dial Emergency short codes are routed using the details contained in the E911 forms. This routing will then be either via installed E911 Adjunct equipment or via grouped set of trunks and extensions called zones.

ü Telephone

number.

ü Emrgy

ü Extension number.

IP Office 4.2+ can use p(x) as a suffix to the Telephone Number to change the priority of a call. Allowable values for x are 1, 2 or 3 for low, medium

or high priority respectively. For example Np(1).

31. SHORT CODE FEATURES

document.xls Page 196

Dial Fax This feature is used to route fax calls via T38 Fax Relay. û û û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü

Dial Inclusion û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Dial Paging û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Dial Speech û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Dial V110 û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Dial V120 û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Dial Video The call is presented to the local exchange as a "Video Call". û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Disable ARS Form û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û ü ü û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û ü ü û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û ü ü û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Display Msg Allows the sending of special functions to DS port display phone extensions. û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Do Not Disturb On û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Do Not Disturb Off û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Enable ARS Form û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü üû û ü ü û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û ü ü û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û ü ü û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Extn Login ü û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Extn Logout û ü û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Flash Hook This feature sends a hook flash signal to the currently connected line if it is an analog line. û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

ü Fax destination

number.

This feature intrudes on the existing call of the specified target extension. The intruder and the target extension can then talk but cannot be heard by the other party. This can include intruding into a conference call, where the conference will continue without the intrusion target.During the intrusion all parties hear a repeated intrusion tone. When the intruder hangs-up the original call parties are reconnected.Use of this feature is subject to the Can Intrude status (configured in Manager via the User form's Telephony tab) of the intruder and the target extension (the extension to be intruded upon).Attempting to hold a dial inclusion call simply ends the intrusion part of the call. The inclusion cannot be parked.

ü Target extension

number.

ü Inclu.

This feature makes a page call to an extension or group. The target extension or group members mustsupport page calls (that is to be able to auto-answer calls).

ü Extension or group

number.

ü Groups only

ü Page

Dial Physical Extension By

Number

Dial a specified extension number regardless of the current user logged on at that extension and any forwarding, follow me or do not disturb settings applied by the current extension user. Note that the extension number used is the Base Extension number set against the extension configuration settings.

ü Base Extension

number

ü *70*N#

(MU-Law only)ü PhyEx

Dial Physical Number By ID

Dial a specific extension using its system ID. This may be necessary in hot desking environments wheresome extensions have been created with no default extension number. Without an extension number, acall can not be made to that extension unless a short code is created.

ü Extension ID

ü *71*N#

(MU-Law only)ü

DialP

This feature allows a short code to be created to force the outgoing call to use the Speech bearer capability.

ü Telephone

number.

ü DV110

Sets the ISDN bearer capabilities to V110. The call is presented to local exchange as a "Data Call".

ü Telephone

number.

ü DV120

Sets the ISDN bear capabilities using V.120. ü Telephone

number.

ü Dvide

ü Telephone

number.

ü DSpch

This feature can be used to put an ARS form out of service. It can be used with ARS forms for which an Out of Service Route has been configured in Manager. The short code feature Enable ARS Form can be used to return an ARS form to in service.

ü ARS form number.

Disable Internal Forwards

This feature turns off the forwarding of internal calls for the user. It applies to Forward Unconditional,Forward on Busy and Forward on No Answer.

Disable Internal Forward

UnconditionalThis feature turns off the forwarding of internal calls for the user. It applies to Forward Unconditional only.

Disable Internal Forward Busy or No

Answer

This feature turns off the forwarding of internal calls for the user. It applies to Forward on Busy andForward on No Answer.

ü The telephone

number takes the format N";T" where:• N is the target extension.

• T is the text message. Note that the "; before the text and the " after the text are required.

ü Displ

Do Not Disturb Exception Add

This feature adds a number to the user's "Do Not Disturb Exception Numbers List". This can be an internal extension number or external ICLID. For further details see Do Not Disturb (DND) in the Telephone Features section.

ü Telephone number

or ICLID. Up to 31 characters. For ICLID numbers any prefix added by the IP Office system must also

be included.

ü *10*N#

ü DNDX+

Do Not Disturb Exception Delete

This feature removes a number from the user's "Do Not Disturb Exception List". For further details see Do Not Disturb (DND) in the Telephone Features section.

ü Telephone number

or ICLID.

ü *11*N#

ü DNDX-

This feature puts the user into 'Do Not Disturb' mode. When on, all calls, except those from numbers in the user's exception list hear busy tones or are redirected to voicemail if available. For further details see Do Not Disturb (DND) in the Telephone Features section.

ü *08 ü DNDOn

Cancels the user's 'do not disturb' mode if set. For further details see Do Not Disturb (DND) in theTelephone Features section.

ü *09 ü DNDOf

This feature can be used to put an ARS form in service. It can be used with ARS forms that have been put out of service through Manager or the use of a Disable ARS Form short code.

ü ARS form number.

Enable Internal Forwards

This feature turns on the forwarding of internal calls for the user. It applies to Forward Unconditional, Forward on Busy and Forward on No Answer.

Enable Internal Forward

UnconditionalThis feature turns on the forwarding of internal calls for the user. It applies to Forward Unconditional only.

Enable Internal Forward Busy or No

AnswerThis feature turns on the forwarding of internal calls for the user. It applies to Forward on Busy and Forward on No Answer.

This feature allows a user to take over ownership of an extension. This requires the user to have a Login Code (User | Telephony | Supervisor Settings) .Note that on some phones, the dialed digits are recorded and may include the login code used.Login codes of up to 15 digits are supported with Extn Login buttons. Login codes of up to 31 digits are supported with Extn Login short codes.

ü Extension

Number*Login Code.If just a single number is dialed containing no *

separator, the IP Office assumes that the extension number to use is the physical extension's default

extension number and that the number dialed is the login code.

ü*35*N#

ü Login

This feature logs the user off the phone at which they are logged on.For IP Office 4.0 and higher this feature cannot be used by a user who does not have a login code or by the default associated user of an extension unless they are set to forced login.

ü *36 ü Logof

ü Pre-IP Office 4.0

IP Office 4.0+: OptionalFor IP Office 4.0 and higher, the telephone number

field can be used to set the transferdestination number for a Centrex Transfer. In this

case the use of the short code ForcedAccount Code and Forced Authorization Code

are not supported and the Line Group Id mustmatch the outgoing line to the Centrex service

provider.

ü Flash

31. SHORT CODE FEATURES

document.xls Page 197

FNE û û û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü

Follow Me Here û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Follow Me To ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Forward Number ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

This feature cancels forwarding when the user's extension is busy. û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

This feature cancels forwarding when the user's extension is not answered. û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü üGroup Listen Off û û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü

Group Listen On û û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü

Headset Toggle Toggles between the use of a headset and the telephone handset. û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Hold Call û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Hold CW û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Hold Music û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Hunt Group Disable û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Hunt Group Enable û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Last Number Redial This feature allows an extension to redial the last number dialed. û û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

This short code feature is used for Mobile Call Control and one-X Mobile Client support.ü This number sets the required FNE function. For a list of supported

functions see one-X Mobile ControlCauses calls to the extension number specified to be redirected to the extension initiating the 'Follow Me Here'. If the redirected call receives a busy tone or is not answered, then the call behaves as though the User's extension had failed to answer. For further details see Follow Me in the Telephone Features section.

ü Extension to

redirect to the dialing extension.

ü *12*N#

ü Here+

Follow Me Here Cancel

Cancels any Follow Me set on the specified extension. This action can only be performed at the extension to which the Follow Me Here is targetted. For further details see Follow Me in the Telephone Features section.

ü Extension being

redirected to the dialing extension.

ü *13*N#

ü Here-

Causes calls to the extension to be redirected to the Follow Me destination extension specified. For further details see Follow Me in the Telephone Features section.

ü Target extension

number or blank (cancel Follow Me To)

ü *14*N#.

ü FolTo

Forward Hunt Group Calls On

Forward the user's hunt group calls to their forward number when the user has Forward Unconditional active. For further details see Forward Unconditional in the Telephone Features section.This option is only applied for calls to Sequential and Rotary type hunt groups. Calls from other hunt group types are not presented to the user when they have Forward Unconditional active. Note also that hunt group calls cannot be forwarded to another hunt group.

ü *50 ü FwdH+

Forward Hunt Group Calls Off

This feature cancels the forwarding of the user's hunt group calls. For further details see Forward Unconditional in the Telephone Features section. ü *51 ü

FwdH-

Sets the number to which the user's calls are redirected. This can be an internal or external number. The number is still subject to the user's call barring settings. For further details see Forward Unconditional in the Telephone Features section.This feature does not activate forwarding; it only sets the number for the forwarding destination.This number is used for all forward types; Forward Unconditional, Forward on Busy and Forward on No Answer, unless the user has a separate Forward on Busy Number set for forward on busy and forward on no answer functions.

ü Telephone

number.

ü *07*N#

ü wdNo

Forward On Busy Number

Sets the number to which the user's calls are forwarded when Forward on Busy or Forward on No Answer are on. If no Forward on Busy Number is set, those functions use the Forward Number.This feature does not activate the forwarding, it only sets the number for the forwarding destination.

ü Telephone

number.

ü *57*N#

ü FwBNo

Forward On Busy On

This feature enables forwarding when the user's extension is busy. It uses the Forward Number destination or, if set, the Forward on Busy Number destination.If the user has call appearance buttons programmed, the system will not treat them as busy until all the call appearance buttons are in use.For IP Office 3.2 and higher, Forward Internal (User | Forwarding) can also be used to control whether internal calls are forwarded.

ü *03 ü FwBOn

Forward On Busy Off ü *04 ü

FwBOf

Forward On No Answer On

This feature enables forwarding when the user's extension is not answered within the period defined by their No Answer Time. It uses the Forward Number destination or, if set, the Forward on Busy Number destination.For IP Office 3.2 and higher, Forward Internal (User | Forwarding) can also be used to control whether internal calls are forwarded.

ü *05 ü FwNOn

Forward On No Answer Off ü *06 ü

FwNOf

Forward Unconditional On

This feature enables forwarding of all calls, except group calls, to the Forward Number set for the user's extension. To also forward hunt group calls, Forward Hunt Group Calls On must also be used. For further details see Forward Unconditional in the Telephone Features section.For IP Office 3.2 and higher, Forward Internal (User | Forwarding) can also be used to control whether internal calls are forwarded.

ü *01 ü FwUOn

Forward Unconditional Off

This feature cancels forwarding of all calls from the user's extension. Note: This does not disable Forward on No Answer and or Forward on Busy if those functions are also on. For further details see Forward Unconditional in the Telephone Features section.

ü *02 ü FwUOf

Disables the group listen function for the user’s extension. See Group Listen On. ü GrpListen Off

Using group listen allows callers to be heard through the phone's handsfree speaker but to only hear the phone's handset microphone. When group listen is enabled, it modifies the hands free functionality of the short code user’s terminal in the following manner• When the user’s phone is placed in handsfree / speaker mode, the speech path from the connected party is broadcast on the phone speaker but the phone's base microphone is disabled.• The connected party can only hear speech delivered directly by the short code users handset microphone.This enables listeners local to the short code user’s phone to hear the connected party whilst limiting the connected party to hear only what is communicated via the user’s handset.• Group listen is not supported for IP phones or when using a phone's HEADSET button.• Currently connected calls are not affected by changes to this setting. If group listen is required it must be selected before the call is connected.

ü GrpListen On

ü HdSet

This uses the Q.931 Hold facility, and "holds" the incoming call at the ISDN exchange, freeing up the ISDN B channel. The Hold Call feature "holds" the current call to a slot. The current call is always automatically placed into slot 0 if it has not been placed in a specified slot. Only available if supported by the ISDN exchange.

ü Exchange hold slot

number or blank (slot 0).ü Hold

This uses the Q.931 Hold facility, and "holds" the incoming call at the ISDN exchange, freeing up the ISDN B channel. The Hold CW feature "holds" the current call to an exchange slot and answers the call waiting. The current call is always automatically placed into slot 0 if it has not been placed in a specified slot. Only available if supported by the ISDN exchange.

ü Exchange hold slot

number or blank (slot 0).

ü *27*N# (A-Law only)

ü HoldCW

This feature allows the user to check the system's music on hold. See Music On Hold for more information.

Optional.IP Office 4.2+ (not Small Office Edition) supports up

to 4 hold music sources, numbered 1 to 4. 1 represents the System Source . 2 to 4 represent the

Alternate Sources . If no number is specified, the default system source is assumed.

ü *34N; 4.2+ ü Music

This feature disables the user's membership of the specified hunt group. They will no longer receive call to that hunt group until their membership is enabled again. To use this feature, you must already belong to the hunt group. See also Hunt Group Enable.

ü Group number.

ü HGDis

This feature enables the user's membership of a hunt group so they can begin to receive calls to the specified hunt group. To use this feature, the user must already belong to the hunt group. This short code can not be used to add someone to a hunt group. This must be done within Manager's Hunt Group form. Previously in IP Office 3.2 the Set Hunt Group Night Service, Set Hunt Group Out of Service and Hunt Group Enable short code features toggled. That behaviour is not supported in 4.0 and higher.

ü Group number.

ü HGEna

31. SHORT CODE FEATURES

document.xls Page 198

MCID Activate û û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Off Hook Station û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü

Allows a user to switch on their outgoing call bar status. û û û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü

Park Call ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Private Call û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Private Call Off û û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Private Call On û û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Priority Call û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Record Message û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Relay On This feature closes the specified switch in the system's external output (EXT O/P) port. ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Relay Off This feature opens the specified switch in the system's external output (EXT O/P) port. ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Relay Pulse ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Resume Call û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Retrieve Call Retrieves a call previously held to a specific ISDN exchange slot. û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û û ü û û û û û û û

This feature should only be used in agreement with the ISDN service provider and the appropriate local legal authorities. It allows users with Can Trace Calls (User | Telephony | Supervisor Settings) set to trigger a malicious call trace of their previous call at the ISDN exchange. Refer to Telephone Features Malicious Call Tracing for further details.

Mobile Twinned Call Pickup

This short code feature allows the user to pickup a call ringing or connected at the destination of their mobile twinning number. This short code can only be used from the primary extension which is being used for the twinning operation.Note that the use of mobile twinning requires entry of a Mobile Twinning license and may be subject to a time profile.Enables or disables whether the user's extension acts as a fully hands free unit. Typically this is used when the answering and clearing of calls is done through an application such as Phone Manager. This feature is also configurable via Phone Manager.

ü "Y" for on or "N"

for off.

ü OHStn

Outgoing Call Bar Off

Allows a user to switch off their outgoing call bar status. The user or the short code must enter the users log in code if set in order to be successful.

ü The user's log in

code.

ü Q2 2008 maint.

Release

Outgoing Call Bar On

ü Q2 2008 maint.

Release

Parks the user's current call into the specified park slot number. The call can then be retrieved by other extensions (refer to the appropriate telephone user guide). While parked the caller hears music on hold if available.Park Timeout (System | Telephony | Telephony) controls how long a call will remain parked. When this expires the call will recall to the parking user if they are idle or when they next become idle. The recall call will continue ring and does follow any forwards or go to voicemail.The 'Unpark Call' feature can be used to retrieve calls from specific park slots.

ü Park slot number.If no park slot number is specified when this short code is used, the system automatically assigns a

park slot number based on the extension number of the user parking the call plus one digit 0 to 9.

ü *37*N# ü Park

Short codes using this feature toggle on or off private call status. When on, any subsequent calls cannot be intruded on, bridged into or silently monitored until the user's private call status is switched off.Note that use of private calls is separate from the user's intrusion settings. If a user is set to Cannot be Intruded, switching private calls off does not affect that status. To allow private calls to be used to full control the user status, Cannot be Intruded should be disabled for that user.Private call status can also be switched on or off using a short code features Private Call On and Private Call Off feature or a programmed button set to the Private Call action.Note that a user logging on or off causes privacy to be reset to off.

ü Optional. Number

to dial for private call.

Short codes using this feature turn off private call status for the user if set. The short code features Private Call and Private Call On can be used to turn private call on. Note that use of private calls is separate from the user's intrusion settings. If a user is set to Cannot be Intruded, switching private calls off does not affect that status. To allow private calls to be used to full control the user status, Cannot be Intruded should be disabled for that userShort codes using this feature turn on the private call settings for the user regardless of their Cannot Be Intruded setting. Any subsequent calls cannot be intruded on, bridged into or silently monitored until the user's private call status is switched off.Private call status can be switched off using a short code with the Private Call Off feature or a programmed button set to the Private Call action. To enable private call status for a single following call only the Private Call short code feature should be used.Note that a user logging on or off causes privacy to be reset to off.This feature allows the user to call another user even if they are set to 'do not disturb'. Priority calls to a user without DND will follow forwarding and follow me settings but will not go to voicemail.

ü Extension number.

ü Pcall

This short code feature is used to record hunt group announcements on Embedded Voicemail, see Hunt Group | Announcements. For IP Office Release 5+ it is also used to record mailbox user name prompts for the auto attendant Dial by Name function.

ü The hunt group

number followed by ".1" for announcement 1 or ".2" for

announcement 2.

ü *91N; & *92N;

ü Switch number (1

or 2).

ü *39 (Switch 1)

*42 (Switch 2)*9000*

ü Rely+

ü Switch number (1

or 2).

ü *40 (Switch 1)

*43 (Switch 2)ü Rely-

This feature closes the specified switch in the system's external output (EXT O/P) port for 5 seconds andthen opens the switch.

ü Switch number (1

or 2).

ü *41 (Switch 1)*44 (Switch 2)

ü Relay

Resume a call previously suspended to the specified ISDN exchange slot. The suspended call may be resumed from another phone/ISDN Control Unit on the same line.

ü Exchange suspend

slot number.

ü *23*N# (A-Law only)

üResum

ü

Exchange hold slot number.

ü *25*N# (A-law only) ü Retriv

Ring Back When Free

This feature sets a ringback on the specified extension. This sets a 'ringback when free' on an extension currently on a call or a 'ringback when next used' for an extension that is free but does not answer.When the target extension is next used or ends its current call, the users is rung and when they answer a call is made to the target extension.

ü Target extension

number.

ü RBak+

Secondary Dial Tone

Secondary dial tone is a system feature to generate a secondary dial tone after the user has begun dialing an external number. This dial tone is then played until the number dialing and an external trunk seized.For IP Office 4.0 and higher the use of this short code feature has been replaced by the Secondary Dial Tone check box option on ARS forms.For pre-4.0 IP Office systems secondary dial tone is triggered through the use of the secondary dial tone short code feature.

ü Digit which

triggers secondary dial tone.

ü (9) U-

Law only

31. SHORT CODE FEATURES

document.xls Page 199

Set Absent Text û ü û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Set Account Code ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û ü ü û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Set Inside Call Seq û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Set Ringback Seq û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Set Wrap Up Time û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü

û û û û û û û û û û ü ü ü

Suspend Call û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Suspend CW û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

This feature can be used to select the user's current absence text. This text is then displayed to internal callers who have suitable display phones or IP Office applications. It doesn't changes the users status.The text is displayed to callers even if the user has forwarded their calls or is using follow me. Absence text is supported across a Small Community Network (SCN).The absence text message is limited to 128 characters. Note however that most amount displayed will depend on the caller's device or application.

ü The telephone

number should take the format "y,n,text" where: • y = 0 or 1 to turn this feature on or off.

• n = the number of the absent statement to use, see the list below:

• 0 = None. • 1 = On vacation until.

• 2 = Will be back. • 3 = At lunch until. • 4 = Meeting until. • 5 = Please call.

• 6 = Dont disturb until. • 7 = With visitors until.

• 8 = With cust. til. • 9 = Back soon.

• 10 = Back tomorrow. • 11 = Custom.

• text = any text to follow the absent statement.

ü Absnt

This short code feature is used to allow system users to enter a valid account code prior to making a phone call. This short code feature is essential for allowing analog phone users to enter account codes. Once this short code is set up, any account code can be used in conjunction with it.

ü A valid account

code.

ü Acct.

Set Authorization Code

This short code feature is only available on systems configured to use authorization codes. See Authorization Codes. The feature is used to allow a user to enter a valid authorization code prior to making a phone call.This short code feature is essential for allowing analog phone users to enter authorization codes. Note that the authorization code must be associated with the user or the user rights to which the user belongs.

ü A valid

authorization code.

Set Hunt Group Night Service

This feature puts the specified hunt group into 'Night Service' mode.Previously in IP Office 3.2 the Set Hunt Group Night Service, Set Hunt Group Out of Service and Hunt Group Enable short code features toggled. That behaviour is not supported in 4.0 and higher.

ü Hunt group

extension number.ü *20*N#

ü HGNS+

Set Hunt Group Out Of Service

This feature manually puts the specified hunt group into 'Out of Service' mode. If a time profile has also been defined to control hunt group night service, the action may vary:• Pre-4.0 IP OfficeSet Hunt Group Out of Service cannot be used to override a hunt group put into night service by a time profile.• 4.0 IP Office and HigherThis option can be used to override a time profile and change a hunt group from night service to out of service. Previously in IP Office 3.2 the Set Hunt Group Night Service, Set Hunt Group Out of Service and Hunt Group Enable short code features toggled. That behaviour is not supported in 4.0 and higher.

ü Hunt group

extension number.For IP Office 4.0+, if left blank, the short code will

affect all hunt groups of which the user is a member.

ü HGOS+

This feature allows the user to select the ringing used on their extension for internal calls. The number entered corresponds to the ring pattern required. This is 0 for Default Ring, 1 for RingNormal, 2 for RingType1, etc. For more information on selectable ringing patterns, see Ring Tones.Use of this short code function is applicable to analog phone users only. The distinctive ring used by DS port phones is fixed by the phone type.

ü Number

corresponding to the desired ring pattern. See Ring Tones.

ü ICSeq

Set Mobile Twinning Number

This short code feature can be used to set a mobile twinning number. The destination can be any external number the user is able to dial normally. It should include any prefix if necessary.Note that the use of mobile twinning requires entry of a Mobile Twinning license and may be subject to a time profile.

ü Twinning

destination.

Set Mobile Twinning On

This short code feature turns on the user's mobile twinning. It requires a mobile twinning number to have been set for the user. That can be done through using the Set Mobile Twinning Number short code feature or through the User | Twinning tab within Manager.Note that the use of mobile twinning requires entry of a Mobile Twinning license and may be subject to a time profile.

Set Mobile Twinning Off

This short code feature turns off the user's mobile twinning.Note that the use of mobile twinning requires entry of a Mobile Twinning license and may be subject to a time profile.

Set No Answer Time

This short code feature allows the user to change their No Answer Time (User | Telephony | Call Settings)

ü Time in seconds.

ü NATim

Set Outside Call Seq

This feature allows the user to select the ringing used on their extension for external calls. The number entered corresponds to the ring pattern required. This is 0 for Default Ring, 1 for RingNormal, 2 for RingType1, etc. For more information on selectable ringing patterns, see Ring Tones. Use of this short code function is applicable to analog phone users only. The distinctive ring used by DS port phones is fixed by the phone type.

ü Number

corresponding to the desired ring pattern. See Ring Tones.

ü OCSeq

This feature allows the user to select the ringing used on their extension for ringback calls. The number entered corresponds to the ring pattern required. This is 0 for Default Ring, 1 for RingNormal, 2 for RingType1, etc. For more information on selectable ringing patterns, see Ring Tones.Use of this short code function is applicable to analog phone users only. The distinctive ring used by DS port phones is fixed by the phone type

ü Number

corresponding to the desired ring pattern. See Ring Tones.

ü RBSeq

Allows users to change their Wrap-up Time (User | Telephony | Call Settings) setting, which specifies the amount of time, after disconnecting from a call, before the user can take another call. • Other phones or applications monitoring the user's status will indicate the user as still being busy (on a call). • Hunt group calls will not be presented to the user. • If the user is using a single line set, direct calls also receive busy treatment. If the user is using a mutli-line set (multiple call appearances), direct calls to them will ring as normal. • It is recommended that this option is not set to less than the default of 2 seconds. 0 is used to allow immediate ringing. • For users set as an CCR Agent, the After Call Work Time (User | Telephony | Supervisor Settings) setting should be used.

ü Time in

seconds.

ü WUTim

Shutdown Embedded Voicemail

Allows the Embedded Voicemail service provided by an Avaya Memory card on IP406 V2, IP500 and IP500 V2 control unit to be shut down. To restart the service, a Startup Embedded Voicemail short code should be used.

The short code has the following effects:1. Immediately disconnect all current users within embedded voicemail. This is not a polite shutdown.2. Mark the embedded voicemail as inactive so that it will not receive any new calls.

ü Q2 2007 Maint.

Release

Startup Embedded Voicemail

Restarts the Embedded Voicemail service provided by an Avaya Memory card on IP406 V2, IP500 and IP500 V2 control unit.

This feature uses the Q.931 Suspend facility. It suspends the incoming call at the ISDN exchange, freeing up the ISDN B channel. The call is placed in exchange slot 0 if a slot number is not specified.

ü Exchange slot

number or blank (slot 0).

ü Suspe

This feature uses the Q.931 Suspend facility. Suspends the incoming call at the ISDN exchange and answer the call waiting. The call is placed in exchange slot 0 if a slot number is not specified. Only available when supported by the ISDN exchange.

ü

Exchange slot number or blank (slot 0).

ü *28*N# A-

Law onlyü SusCW

31. SHORT CODE FEATURES

document.xls Page 200

û û û û û û û ü ü ü ü

Toggle Calls û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Unpark Call ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Voicemail Collect ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Voicemail Node û û û û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Voicemail On û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Voicemail Off û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û ü û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

û ü û ü ü ü ü ü ü ü ü

Start After Call Work

This feature can be users who have been configured as CCR agents. It allows them to dial a short code to enter the After Call Work (ACW) state as reported by the IP Office Customer Call Reporter (CCR) application.

ü acwü

4Q 2008 Maint.

ReleaseThis feature cycles through each call that the user has on hold on the IP Office system. This feature is useful when a user with a single-line telephone has several calls on hold and needs to respond to each one in turn.

ü *29 ü Toggl

Retrieve a parked call from a specified system park slot. In pre-3.2 IP Office this feature was call Ride Call.

ü System park slot number.

ü *38*N# ü Ride

This feature connects to the voicemail system. Normally the telephone number field is used to indicate the name of the mailbox to be accessed, for example "?Extn201" or "#Extn201".

• ? indicates 'collect messages'.

• # indicates 'leave a message'. It also instructs the voicemail server to give a brief period of ringing before connecting the caller. The # can be omitted for immediate connection.

• " " quotation marks must be used to enclose the number being sent to the voicemail server. Any text not enclosed by quote marks will be treated as short code wildcards to be interpreted and replaced by the system.

When using Voicemail Pro, names of specific call flow start points can also be used to directly access those start points via a short code. In these cases, ? is not used and # is only used if ringing is required before the start point's call flow begins.

Note: Short codes using the Voicemail Collect feature, with either "Short Codes.name" and "#Short Codes.name" entries in the Telephone Number field are automatically converted to the Voicemail Node feature and name.

ü

See column to left.

ü *17 ü VMCol

Similar to Voicemail Collect but used for calls being directed to a Voicemail Pro Short Codes start point. If ringing is required before the start point call flow begins then a # should be included before the name. Useful if you have set up a short code start point with Voicemail Pro and want to give direct internal access to it.

ü

Voicemail Pro Short Code start point name without quotation marks.

This feature enables the user's voicemail mailbox to answer calls which ring unanswered or arrive when the user is busy. It does not disable the voicemail mailbox being used as the target for other functions such as call recording or messages forwarded from other mailboxes. For IP Office 3.2, the Voicemail On and Voicemail Ringback On short code features toggled. For IP Office 4.0 and higher, they no longer toggle.

ü *18 ü VMOn

This feature disables the user's voicemail box from answering calls. Note that this does not stop messages being forwarded to the mailbox from other mailboxes. ü *19 ü

VMOff

Voicemail Ringback On

This feature enables voicemail ringback to the user's extension. Voicemail ringback is used to call the user when they have new voicemail messages. The ringback takes place each time the extension is used. This feature is useful for users who do not have voicemail light/button indicators on their telephone.If the user has been configured to receive message waiting indication for any hunt groups, a separate voicemail ringback will occur for each such group and for the users own mailbox. For IP Office 3.2, the Voicemail On and Voicemail Ringback On short code features toggled. For IP Office 4.0 and higher, they no longer toggle.

ü *48 ü VMRB+

Voicemail Ringback Off

This feature disables voicemail ringback to the user's extension. This feature is also available on Phone Manager. ü *49 ü

VMRB-

32. SHORT CODE EXAMPLES

document.xls Page 201

Short Code Parameters - Understanding Short Codes

32. SHORT CODE EXAMPLES

document.xls Page 202

How IP Office Interprets Dialed Short Codes

32. SHORT CODE EXAMPLES

document.xls Page 203

Short Code Fields and Characters

32. SHORT CODE EXAMPLES

document.xls Page 204

32. SHORT CODE EXAMPLES

document.xls Page 205

Short Code Matching Examples

32. SHORT CODE EXAMPLES

document.xls Page 206

32. SHORT CODE EXAMPLES

document.xls Page 207

Sample Short Codes

33. SHORT CODE DEFAULTS

document.xls Page 208

Code Telephone Number Feature A-Law U-Law *00 Blank Cancel All Forwarding ü ü *01 Blank Forward Unconditional On ü ü *02 Blank Forward Unconditional Off ü ü *03 Blank Forward On Busy On ü ü *04 Blank Forward On Busy Off ü ü *05 Blank Forward On No Answer On ü ü *06 Blank Forward On No Answer Off ü ü *07*N# N Forward Number ü ü *08 Blank Do Not Disturb On ü ü *09 Blank Do Not Disturb Off ü ü *10*N# N Do Not Disturb Exception Add ü ü *11*N# N Do Not Disturb Exception Del ü ü *12*N# N Follow Me Here ü ü *13*N# N Follow Me Here Cancel ü ü *14*N# N Follow Me To ü ü *15 Blank Call Waiting On ü ü *16 Blank Call Waiting Off ü ü *17 ?U Voicemail Collect ü ü *18 Blank Voicemail On ü ü *19 Blank Voicemail Off ü ü *20*N# N Set Hunt Group Night Service ü ü *21*N# N Clear Hunt Group Night Service ü ü *22*N# N Suspend Call ü û *23*N# N Resume Call ü û *24*N# N Hold Call ü û *25*N# N Retrieve Call ü û *26 Clear CW ü û *27*N# N Hold CW ü û *28*N# N Suspend CW ü û *29 Blank Toggle Calls ü ü *30 Blank Call Pickup Any ü ü *31 Blank Call Pickup Group ü ü *32*N# N Call Pickup Extn ü ü *33*N# N Call Queue ü ü *34N; Blank Hold Music ü ü *35*N# N Extn Login ü ü *36 Blank Extn Logout ü ü *37*N# N Park Call ü ü *38*N# N Unpark Call ü ü *39 1 Relay On ü ü *40 1 Relay Off ü ü *41 1 Relay Pulse ü ü *42 2 Relay On ü ü *43 2 Relay Off ü ü *44 2 Relay Pulse ü ü *45*N# N Acquire Call ü ü *46 Blank Acquire Call ü ü *47 Blank Conference Add ü ü *48 Blank Voicemail Ringback On ü ü *49 Blank Voicemail Ringback Off ü ü *50 Blank Forward Huntgroup On ü ü *51 Blank Forward Huntgroup Off ü ü *52 Blank Cancel or Deny ü ü *53*N# N Call Pickup Members ü ü *57*N# N Forward On Busy Number ü ü *70 Blank Call Waiting Suspend ü û *70*N# N Dial Physical Extn By Number û ü

33. SHORT CODE DEFAULTS

document.xls Page 209

*71*N# N Dial Physical Extn By ID û ü *9000* "MAINTENANCE" Relay On ü ü *91N; N".1" Record Message ü ü *92N; N".2" Record Message ü ü 9N N Dial û ü ? . Dial ü û

For IP Office 4.2+, the default *34 short code for music on hold has changed to *34N;.

Default auto attendant short codes of the form *81XX, *82XX, *83XX and *84XX ar

added when an Embedded Voicemail auto attendant is added to the IP Office's configuration.

Additional short codes of the form *DSSN, *SDN, *SKN, *#N and **N may also visible. These are used by the IP Office system for internal functions and should not be removed or altered.

34. TAPI FUNCTIONS SUPPORTED

document.xls Page 210

TAPI Functions Supported on IP OfficeTAPI Functions Supported on IP OfficeTAPI Link Lite provides the following functionality for TAPI 2.1 • lineAddToConference • lineNegotiateTAPIVersion • lineAnswer • lineOpen • lineBlindtransfer • linePark • lineCompleteTransfer • lineRedirect • lineConfigDialog • lineRemoveFromConference • lineClose • lineSetAppPriority • lineDeallocateCall • lineSetAppSpecific • lineDial • lineSetCallPrivilege • lineDrop • lineSetStatusMessages • lineGetAddressCaps • lineSetupTransfer • lineGetAddressID • lineShutdown • lineGetAddressStatus • lineSwapHold • lineGetAppPriority • lineUnhold • lineGetCallInfo • lineUnpark • lineGetCallStatus • lineSetCallData • lineGetDevCaps • lineDevSpecific • lineGetID • lineGenerateDigits • lineHold • lineGenerateTone • lineInitialiseEx • lineMonitorDigits • lineMakeCall • lineMonitorTones

34. TAPI FUNCTIONS SUPPORTED

document.xls Page 211

TAPI 3.0 functions supportedThe following functions are supported using TAPI 3.0:ITTAPI ITAddress

Initialize Get_AddressNameShutdown Get_dialableAddressEnumerateAddresses get_ServiceProviderNameRegisterCallNotifications CreateCallPut_EventFilter

ITMediaSupportget_MediaTypes

ITCallInfo ITBasicCallControlget_Address Connectget_CallState Answerget_CallInfoString DisconnectSetCallInfoBuffer Hold

SwapHoldParkDirectUnparkBlindTransferTransfer

ITCallStateEvent ITCallNotificationEventget_Cause get_Callget_Stateget_Call

ITCallInfoChangeEvent ITCallHubEventget_Call get_Event

get_Call

Notes:TAPI Link Lite can be used from C, C++ and Delphi. Visual Basic cannot directly use TAPI 2.1, but does support TAPI 3.0 without any third-party tools.

TAPI Link Lite is provides detailed information on telephony events, including the ability to screen-pop based on CLI and/or DDI.

34. TAPI FUNCTIONS SUPPORTED

document.xls Page 212

Device-Specific DataThe following table shows the device specific data available via TAPI.

• Phone's extension number • Force login flag • Forward on busy flag • Login code flag • Forward on no answer flag • System phone flag • Forward unconditional flag • Absent message id • Forward hunt group flag • Absent message set flag • Do not disturb flag • Voicemail email mode • Outgoing call bar flag • User's extension number • Call waiting on flag • Users Locale • Voicemail on flag • Forward number • Voicemail ring-back flag • Follow me number • Number of voicemail messages • Absent text

• Do not disturb exception list • Outside call sequence number • Forward on busy number • Inside call sequence number • User's priority • Ring back sequence number • • No answer timeout period • No answer timeout period • • Wrap up time period • Can intrude flag • Cannot be intruded upon flag • X directory flag • X directory flag

• Number of unread voicemail

Number of groups the user is a member ofNumber of groups that the user is a member of that are currently outside their time profile

• Number of groups the user is currently disabled from

• Number of groups that the user is a member of that are currently out of service

Number of groups that the user is a member of that are currently on night service

34. TAPI FUNCTIONS SUPPORTED

document.xls Page 213

DevLink FieldsThe following table shows the device specific data available via DevLink.

# Field Data ( S Message ) # Field Data ( S Message )1 A call id 26 Voicemail disallow2 B call id 27 Sending complete3 A state 28 Bc.tc,bc.tm4 B state 29 Owner hunt group name5 A connected 30 Original hunt group name6 A is music 31 Original user name7 B connected 32 Target hunt group name8 B is music 33 Target user name9 A name 34 Target RAS name

10 B name 35 Is internal call11 B list (possible targets for the call) 36 Time stamp12 A slot ,channel 37 Connected time13 B slot , channel 38 Ring time14 Called party presentation & type 39 Connected duration15 Called party number 40 Ring duration16 Calling party presentation & type 41 Locale17 Calling party number 42 Park slot number18 Called sub address 43 Call waiting19 Calling sub address 44 Tag20 Dialled party type 45 Transferring21 Dialled party number 46 Sv active22 Keypad type 47 Sv quota used23 Keypad number 48 Sv quota time24 Ring attempt count 49 Account code25 Cause 50 Unique call identifier# Field Data ( D Message ) # Field Data ( A Message )1 A call id 1 A call id2 B call id 2 B call id3 Unique call identifier 3 Unique call identifier

35. IP Office Power Demo Kits

document.xls Page 214

IP Office Power Demo Kits

IP Office 500 Power DemoHardware

• IP Office 500 version 2 (IP500v2) Chassis• Combination Card with Analog Daughter Card• Combination Card with BRI Daughter Card (International Kits ONLY)• LAN Cable• 1416 Digital Telephone Set• 9508 Digital Telephone Set• 9641G IP Telephone Set• Button Module 12 for 9508 Digital set• Button Module DBM32 for 1416 Digital set• Power Supply for 9641G IP Set• System Secure Digital (SD) Card (MuLAW or ALAW)• CD disk containing the activation license keys for the applications

Application Software

(http://marketingtools.avaya.com/knowledgebase)

• IPO LIC PREFRD (VM PRO) RFA LIC:DS• IPO LIC R6 ADV EDITION• IPO LIC R6 PWR USER 5• IPO LIC R6 MOBILE WORKER 5• IPO LIC R6 TELEWORKER 5• IPO LIC R6 OFF WORKER 5• IPO LIC RECEPTIONIST RFA 1 LIC:DS• IPO LIC CUSTMR SVC AGT RFA 5 LIC:CU• IPO LIC PMGR PRO RFA 1 LIC:CU• IPO LIC PMGR SFTPHN RFA 1 LIC:CU• IPO LIC R6 AV IP ENDPOINT 5• IPO LIC IP500 VCE NTWKG ADD 4 LIC:CU • IPO LIC SIP TRNK RFA 5 (enables 5 SIP trunks)• IPO LIC IPSEC VPN RFA LIC:DS• IPO LIC AVAYA TTS RFA 1 LIC:CU (enables 1 TTS port)• IPO LIC NTWKD MSGING RFA LIC:DS• IPO LIC ACM CENTRAL VM LIC:DS• IPO LIC CTI RFA LIC:DS

Availability and Pricing

• One (1) IP Office 500v2 Power Demo Kit per Partner location.

For pricing, contact your Distributor.

Avaya Global Services does not provide installation or maintenance coverage ondemonstration equipment.

There are changes to the Power Demo Kits with the General Availabilty of IP Office Release 7.0. See Section 1.1 and Existing Power Demo Kits maybe be upgraded to IP Office Release 7.0 by completing Appendix B of this Product Update. As in the past, Appendix B licenses are provided free of charge.

The IP Office 500 Power Demo is designed to deliver complete demonstration capability through one orderable code. The following components are included:

NOTE: Excludes Power Lead. Must be ordered separately per country requirements.

The following applications are included and can be activated from the license numbers on the CD disk. An overview of these applications can be found in the IP Office Product Description located on the IP Office Knowledge Base

Research has shown that demonstrations positively improve sales results and education of sales teams. The Power Demo kit is attractively priced to support demonstration kit usage only. The value of the parts within the kits exceeds that of the items when purchased individually (in many cases nearly ten-fold). The number of kits purchased per Avaya Partner will be limited to the following:

35. IP Office Power Demo Kits

document.xls Page 215

IP Office Power Demo Breakdown<---- IP500 Power Demo material code and description

Monitoring and Control of Power Demo Kits

The number of kits will be restricted.• One (1) IP Office 500v2 Power Demo Kit per Partner location.

Application License Upgrades

Logistics and OrderingPricing and Material Codes

For pricing, contact your Distributor!

North AmericaMaterial Code Description

700500416 IP500 DEMO KIT US

APAC, EMEA, UKMaterial Code Description

700500417 IP500 DEMO KIT INTL

Exceptions

The price of the Demonstration kit is significantly less than if the parts were purchased separately. They should absolutely not be re-sold to end user sites. Both Avaya and the Distributor will be monitoring the sale of the kits. Avaya also reserves the right to audit a Partner location to validate the usage of the demonstration equipment. A Partner wishing to purchase the kit will be required to fill out a form available directly from their Distributor and have it countersigned by an Avaya Channel Account Manager or National Account Manager.

From time to time Avaya introduces new features and applications to IP Office. Some of these are enabled with a license ‘key’. Avaya wants to ensure Partners remain current and have the ability to demonstrate every application on IP Office. To apply for new licenses (free of charge) Partners are to complete the attached form (see Appendix B Additional licenses for Existing Demo Kits Authorization Form). Avaya CAM or NAM countersignature is required. Fax the form to your Distributor. The Distributor will then forward to Avaya sales order processing for license distribution.

Appendix B can be used to secure additional licenses once a license key swap has been completed. A license key swap is performed when transferring licenses from one previously purchased Power Demo unit (using the Serial, Parallel, USB, or Smart Card feature key) to IP Office 500v2 system (which uses the System Secure Digital card). Failure to successfully complete a key swap prior to adding new licenses could result in the new licenses being overwritten. Avaya CAM or NAM countersignature is required. Fax the form to your Distributor. The Distributor will then forward to Avaya sales order processing for license distribution.

The Power Demo kit is ordered as a single code. The equipment will be shipped to Distributors as one complete set of parts. Each box will be serialized. The hardware feature key and licence keys will be packaged together in a plastic bag and are contained within the unit.

Each Partner must complete the “Avaya Power Demo Authorization Form” to purchase these kits. See Appendix A. This form will require the signature of a Channel Account Manager (CAM) or National Account Manager (NAM) and will be closely monitored. The ordering process is detailed in the Logistics and Ordering section of this document.

The Power Demo Kit comes as pre-configured bundled package; Avaya cannot exchange equipment or make substitutions, the kit has been created to provide optimum demonstration capability. There are no provisions within in this program to purchase additional equipment at special pricing. Requests requiring additional equipment are to be directed to your Channel Account Manager (CAM) or National Account Manager (NAM).

35. IP Office Power Demo Kits

document.xls Page 216

Software Build

To upgrade existing IP Office Power Demo Kits and future Power Demo kits, Partners will need to do two things:

1. Complete Appendix B requesting the Upgrade License2. Download the most current level of software from support.avaya.com

Material Code Description700500928 IPO R7.0 USER/ADMIN SET DVD700501420 IPO R7.0 APPL SRVR DVD

For countries where IP Office Essential Edition – PARTNER® Version are supported, you may request the System Secure Digital (SD) Card – PARTNER Mode – strictly for demonstration purposes and PARTNER® ETR Card. This is done through the Special Bid Request (SBR) which is completed outside of this process. For tracking purposes, you will need to indicate that you will be submitting the SBR on Appendix A in STEP ONE.

For countries where IP Office Essential Edition – Norstar™ Version systems are supported in Middle East Africa, you may request the System Secure Digital (SD) Card – Norstar Mode – strictly for demonstration purposes. This is done through the Special Bid Request (SBR) which is processed by your CAM or National Account Manager. For tracking purposes, you will need to indicate that you will be submitting the SBR on Appendix A in STEP ONE.

The System SD card that is included in the IP Office 500v2 Power Demo Kit contains the base level of software for operational and demonstration purposes.

36. MERGEABLE LIST

document.xls Page 217

Mergeable Settings

Mergeable 3.2+ Pre-3.2

System − −- System X- LAN1/LAN2 X X- DNS X X- Voicemail X- Telephony X- VoIP X X- LDAP X X- System Events X X- CDR/SMDR √ X

- Twinning √ −Line X XControl Unit X XExtension XUser √ √Hunt Group √ √Short Code √ √Service √ √RAS √ √Incoming Call Route √ √WAN Port X XDirectory √ √Time Profile √ XFirewall Profile √ √IP Route √ √Least Cost Route √ √Account Code √ √License √ √Tunnel X XLogical LAN X XWireless X XUser Rights √ √Auto Attendant √ XAuthorization Code √ X

ARS √ −

The table below shows the configuration entries for which changes can be merged and those that require a system reboot. The Send Configuration menu shown when sending a configuration to the IP Office automatically indicates when the configuration is mergeable.

• *1 - 3.2 | System | SystemChanges to Locale, License Server IP Address and Favor RIP Routes over Static require a reboot.

√*1

• *2 - 3.2 | System | VoicemailChanges to Voicemail Type require areboot.√*2

√*3

• *3 - 3.2 | System | TelephonyChanges to Companding LAW and Busy Tone Detection require a reboot.

X*4 • *4 - 4.1+ | ExtensionFor IP Office 4.1+, Base Extension and Disable Speakerphone are mergeable.

36. MERGEABLE LIST

document.xls Page 218

E911 System X X

37. IP OFFICE PORTS

document.xls Page 219

IP Office Ports

Port Protocol FunctionSMTP TCP

Time UDP Time requests from the IP Office to a Time Server (RFC868)DNS UDP Domain Name Service responsesBOOTP/DHCP UDP DHCP Server OperationBOOTP/DHCP UDP DHCP Client OperationTFTP UDP File requests to the IP Office.TFTP UDP File requests by the IP Office.HTTP TCP HTTP File requests.SNMP UDP From SNMP applications.SNMP Trap UDP To addresses set in the IP Office configuration.LDAP TCP Lightweight Directory Access Protocol.IKE UDP Key exchange for IPSec protocol.RIP UDPRIP UDPL2TP UDP Layer 2 Tunneling protocolH.323 UDP H.323 DiscoveryH.323 RAS UDP H.323 Status. VoIP device registering with the IP Office.H.323/H.245 UDP H.323 Signalling. Data to a registered VoIP device.(UDP) UDP PC Wallboard to CCC Wallboard Server.SIP UDP

RTCPMon UDP RTCP Monitoring information from Avaya H323 phones.SIP UDP/TCP* SIP Line SignallingHTTP TCP Browser access to the Delta Server application.Enconf UDP

HTTP TCP Browser access to the IP Office ContactStore (VRL) application.

RTP/RTCP UDP

IPO Voicemail UDP To voicemail server address.IPO Solo Voicemail UDP From IP Office TAPI PC with Wave drive user support.IPO Monitor UDP From the IP Office Monitor application.IPO Voice Networking UDP

IPO PCPartner UDP

IPO TAPI UDP From an IP Office TAPI user PC.(UDP) UDP IP Office Manager and Upgrade WizardIPO BLF UDP

IPO License Dongle UDP To the License Server IP Address set in the IP Office config.

Econf UDP Conference Center Service to IP Office.Discovery TCP IP Office discovery from Manager.

TCP IP Office configuration settings access.TCP TLS Secure"TCP IP Office system status access.TCP IP Office security settings access.TCP TLS Secure"

The list below details many of the IP ports used by IP Office control units and IP Office applications. Many of these are standard ports for different IP traffic protocols.ç Indicates a port on the IP Office control unit.è indicates a port on the PC running an IP Office application.* Indicates that the port and or protocol can be changed.

è 25* Email system alarms from the IP Office to SMTP server. For IP Office 4.2 also used for Voicemail Email on Embedded Voicemail.

è 37ç 53ç 67è 68ç 69è 69ç 80

ç 161*è 162*è 389*ç 500è 520 To and from the IP Office to other RIP devices. For RIP1 and RIP2

(RIP1 compatible) the destination address is a subnetç 520ç 1701ç 1718ç 1719è 1720è 2127è 3478 Port used for STUN requests from the IP Office to the SIP

providerç 5005çè 5060è 8080è 8089 From the IP Office to the Conferencing Center Server Service.

User access to the conference center is direct via HTTP sessions.

è 8888

çè49152 to 53247*

Dynamically allocated ports used during VoIP calls for RTP and RTCP traffic. The port range can be adjusted through the System | Gatekeeper tab.

è 50791ç 50793ç 50794ç 50795 Small Community Network signalling (AVRIP) and BLF updates.

Each system does a broadcast every 30 seconds. BLF updates are sent required up a maximum of every 5 seconds.

ç 50796 From an IP Office application (for example Phone Manager or SoftConsole). Used to initiate a session between the IP Office and the application.

ç 50797è 50798è 50799 Broadcast to the IP Office LAN and the first 10 IP addresses

registered from other subnets.è 50800

ç 50801ç 50802ç 50804* Service Access

Protocolç 50805*ç 50808*ç 50812*ç 50813*

• CDR/SMDR from the IP Office is sent to the port number and IP address defined during configuration and using either TCP or UDP as selected.

37. IP OFFICE PORTS

document.xls Page 220

Application SpecifcIP Office Application Server

Port Component

IP Office ManagerPort Component Location - %ProgramFiles%\Avaya\IP Office\

IP Office Manager Manager\manager.exe

SoftConsolePort Component Location - %ProgramFiles%\Avaya\IP Office\

SoftConsole\SoftConsole.exe

Phone ManagerPort Component Location - %ProgramFiles%\Avaya\IP Office\

Phone Manager Phone Manager\PhoneManager.exe

Phone Manager VOIP Server Phone Manager\iClaritySvr.exe

Contact StorePort Component Location - %ProgramFiles%\Avaya\IP Office\

Contact Store Witness\tomcat5024\bin\tomcat5.exe

System MonitorPort Component Location - %ProgramFiles%\Avaya\IP Office\

UDP 50794 System Monitor Monitor\sysmonitor.exeTAPI2

Port Component Location - %ProgramFiles%\Avaya\IP Office\UDP 50797 TAPI2 TAPI\tspi2w.tspVoicemail Pro Service

Port DescriptionTCP 25 Used to listen for SMTP connections.UDP 37 Used to receive time requests (RFC 868).TCP 143 Used to service IMAP4 requests.UDP 50791 TCP 50791 Used to receive requests fromone-X Portal for IP Office.TCP 50791

707022

HTTP/HTTP AccessSFTP Access

TCP 50802TCP 50804TCP 50812UDP 50798

UDP 50796UDP 50799

SoftConsole

UDP 50796UDP 50799UDP 1719UDP 1720

TCP 8888UDP 50791UDP 50795

Used to receive requests from IP Office

Used to receive connections from

38. LOCALE CODES

document.xls Page 221

The locales supported in IP Office Essential Edition - Quick Version and IP Office Standard Version modes are:Argentina France Netherlands South AfricaAustralia Germany New Zealand SpainBahrain Greece Norway SwedenBelgium Hong Kong Oman SwitzerlandBrazil Hungary Pakistan TaiwanCanada Iceland Peru TurkeyChile India Poland United Arab EmiratesChina Italy Portugal United KingdomColombia Korea Qatar United StatesDenmark Kuwait Russia VenezuelaEgypt Mexico Saudi ArabiaFinland Morocco Singapore

The locales supported in IP Office Essential Edition - Norstar Version mode are:Bahrain Morocco Qatar TurkeyEgypt Oman Saudi Arabia United Arab EmiratesKuwait Pakistan South Africa

For detailed information about applications and languages use the link below

Supported Country LocalesWhen a new or defaulted system's configuration is first opened in Manager, the value set in the Locale field should always be checked and changed if

necessary. The system's Locale sets factors such as the default ringing patterns and caller display settings. The locale also controls the language that a voicemail server will use for prompts.

Users and incoming call routes can also be set to a locale. That locale will then override the system settings for calls to voicemail.

The following tables indicate locale settings used for different functions. Note that reference to a locale does not necessarily indicate support, availability or approval for system within that country.

Drill down to the country and you will see the language support options for the IP Office 7.0 suite of software. The language support options will differ for other system releases.

http://marketingtools.avaya.com/knowledgebase/businesspartner/ipoffice/mergedProjects/manager/using_locales.htm

39. RELEASE HISTORY

document.xls Page 222

IP Office Release History<--- Release 7.0 GA March 23, 2011

39. RELEASE HISTORY

document.xls Page 223

<--- Release 6.1 GA November 29, 2010

39. RELEASE HISTORY

document.xls Page 224

<--- Release 6.0 Q3 August 25, 2010 Maintenance Release

39. RELEASE HISTORY

document.xls Page 225

<--- Release 6.0 GA February 26, 2010

39. RELEASE HISTORY

document.xls Page 226

<--- Release 5 Q4 November 18, 2009 Maintenance Release

39. RELEASE HISTORY

document.xls Page 227

<--- Release 5 GA August 3, 2009

39. RELEASE HISTORY

document.xls Page 228

<--- Release 4.2 Q2 May 13, 2009 Service Pack

39. RELEASE HISTORY

document.xls Page 229

<--- Release 4.2 Q1 February 17, 2009 Service Pack<--- Release 4.2 Q4 November 12, 2008 Service Pack<--- Release 4.2. GA - August 11, 2008

39. RELEASE HISTORY

document.xls Page 230

<--- Release 4.1.x GA - December 17, 2007

39. RELEASE HISTORY

document.xls Page 231

<--- Release 4.0.10 - September 24, 2007 Maintenance Release

39. RELEASE HISTORY

document.xls Page 232

<--- Release 4.0.7 - June 29, 2007 Maintenance Release

39. RELEASE HISTORY

document.xls Page 233

<--- Release 4.0.x GA - February 26, 2007

39. RELEASE HISTORY

document.xls Page 234

<--- Release 3.2 - July 24, 2006

39. RELEASE HISTORY

document.xls Page 235

<--- Release 3.1 - November 7, 2005

39. RELEASE HISTORY

document.xls Page 236

<--- Release 3.0 - March 21, 2005

39. RELEASE HISTORY

document.xls Page 237

<--- Release 2.1 - May 31, 2004

39. RELEASE HISTORY

document.xls Page 238

<--- Release 2.0 - November 26, 2003

39. RELEASE HISTORY

document.xls Page 239

<--- Release 1.4 - June 16, 2003<--- Release 1.3.2 - February 28, 2003

39. RELEASE HISTORY

document.xls Page 240

<--- Release 1.3 - December 13, 2002

40. TRAINING

document.xls Page 241

Course Code Course Title

Avaya University IP Office Courses<--- ACSS - SME Communications (ACSS - 3000)

Updated ACSS - SME Communications Requirements and Curriculum for IP Office R6.1Take this Exam to earn the ACSS:

3000.3 Avaya Small & Medium Enterprise (SME) Communications Exam Certification Exam 1.5 hoursTake these courses to prepare for the Exam:

AVA00916WEN IP Office Hardware and Data Components Online Course 6 hoursATA01225IEN IP Office R6.0 Implementation Workshop Instructor Led Training 40 hoursATI02011AEN IP Office R6.0 Implementation Workshop (Assessment) Assessment 1 hour ATI02011ADE IP Office R6 Implementation Workshop (German Assessment) Assessment 1 hour ATI02011AES IP Office R6 Implementation Workshop (Spanish Assessment) Assessment 1 hour ATI02011AFR IP Office R6 Implementation Workshop (French Assessment) Assessment 1 hour ATI02011AIT IP Office R6 Implementation Workshop (Italian Assessment) Assessment 1 hour ATI00484IEN IP Office Advanced Applications and Troubleshooting Workshop Instructor Led Training 40 hours

These courses offer additional learning::ATU01201WEN IP Office Release 5 Technical Delta Online Course 3 hoursATU01201AEN IP Office Release 5 Technical Delta Assessment Assessment 0.5 hour

PresentationPresentation

ASC00126OEN Selling IP Office - Update Release 6.1 Online Course 1 hourASC00126OEN PresentationATU02142WEN IP Office Technical Delta Release 6.1 Online Course 2 hours

5S00002O ACSS Conversion Training Class Online Course 5 hours 5S00001W IP Office Technical Delta Release 7.0 Online Course 5 hours 5S00002O PDF File5S00002O PDF File5S00002O PDF File

<--- ACIS - SME Communications (ACIS - 6401)Take this Exam to earn the ACIS:

6401.1 Avaya IP Office Implementation Exam Certification Exam 2 hoursTake these courses to prepare for the Exam:

AVA00916WEN IP Office Hardware and Data Components Online Course 6 hoursATU02142WEN IP Office Technical Delta Release 6.1 Online Course 2 hoursATA01225IEN IP Office R6.0 Implementation Workshop Instructor Led Training 40 hours

5S00001W IP Office Technical Delta Release 7.0 Online Course 2.5 hours<--- IP Office Customer Trainer Toolkits <--- IP Office for Implement and Maintain

Please complete the following courses:AVA00916WEN IP Office Hardware and Data Components Online Course 6 hoursATC01221IEN IP Office Core Implementation Workshop Instructor Led Training 40 hours

ATA01225IEN IP Office R6.0 Implementation Workshop Instructor Led Training 40 hoursATI02011AEN IP Office R6.0 Implementation Workshop (Assessment) Assessment 1 hour ATI02011ADE IP Office R6 Implementation Workshop (German Assessment) Assessment 1 hour ATI02011AES IP Office R6 Implementation Workshop (Spanish Assessment) Assessment 1 hour ATI02011AFR IP Office R6 Implementation Workshop (French Assessment) Assessment 1 hour ATI02011AIT IP Office R6 Implementation Workshop (Italian Assessment) Assessment 1 hour

ATC00470WEN IP Office Customer Call Reporter - Implement Basic Online Course 4 hoursATC00470AEN IP Office Customer Call Reporter - Implement Basic Assessment Assessment 0.5 hour

AVA00484H00 IP Office Advanced Applications Workshop Instructor Led Training 24 hours

ATI00484IEN IP Office Advanced Applications and Troubleshooting Workshop Instructor Led Training 40 hoursAVA00484AEN IP Office Advanced Applications Workshop (Assessment) Assessment 1 hour ATU01201WEN IP Office Release 5 Technical Delta Online Course 3 hoursATU01201AEN IP Office Release 5 Technical Delta Assessment Assessment 0.5 hour

PresentationPresentation

ATU02142WEN IP Office Technical Delta Release 6.1 Online Course 2 hoursASC00126OEN Selling IP Office - Update Release 6.1 Online Course 1 hourASC00126OEN PresentationATC01973WEN Online Course 2 hours

All course curricula, enrolment and assessment is on the Avaya Learning Center portal at www.avaya-learning.com LINK:---> Avaya University

Delivery type / Type of Training

Length of Training

IP Office Release 6.0 Technical DeltaIP Office Essential Edition - PARTNER® Version

Selling IP Office - Update Release 6.1 via IP Office.alive

Avaya IP Office ACSS Exam Prep Delta Student Guide Part 1Avaya IP Office ACSS Exam Prep Delta Student Guide Part 2Avaya IP Office ACSS Exam Prep Delta Student Guide Part 3

IP Office Release 6.0 Technical DeltaIP Office Essential Edition - PARTNER® Version

Selling IP Office - Update Release 6.1 via IP Office.aliveIP Office Essential Edition - Norstar Version Installation Training (offered only in Middle East Africa)

40. TRAINING

document.xls Page 242

<--- APSS - SME Communications (APSS - 1000)<--- IP Office for Use

Customer Trainer ToolkitsAVA00619WEN IP Office Telephones End User Training Online Course 2 hoursAVA00921WEN IP Office Phone Manager and Soft Console User Training Online Course 2 hours

<--- IP Office Product DeltaIP Office Delta Training

ATU01201WEN IP Office Release 5 Technical Delta Online Course 3 hoursATU01201AEN IP Office Release 5 Technical Delta Assessment Assessment 0.5 hour

PresentationPresentation

ATU02142WEN IP Office Technical Delta Release 6.1 Online Course 2 hoursASC00126OEN Selling IP Office - Update Release 6.1 Online Course 1 hourASC00126OEN Presentation

1S00041O Selling IP Office - Update Release 7.0 Online Course 0.5 hour 1S00041O-WebAlive Presentation

5S00001W IP Office Technical Delta Release 7.0 Online Course 2.5 hours

IP Office Release 6.0 Technical DeltaIP Office Essential Edition - PARTNER® Version

Selling IP Office - Update Release 6.1 via IP Office.alive

Selling IP Office - Release 7.0 via Web.Alive

41. IP HARDPHONE POWER OPTIONS

document.xls Page 243

IP Office IP Hard Phone Power OptionsLocal Power OptionsIn order to prepare for changes in future EMC requirements, Avaya is announcing, effective July 2, 2007, the 1151D1 and 1151D2 Terminal Power Units for IP Phones.These new Power units will be for IP phones only and will be replacing the current 1151C1 and 1151C2 Power Unit versions on IP phones. Although we are announcing the new 1151D1 and 1151D2 units, the July ASD will still configure 1151C units. The 1151Ds will be available in ASD in August.

Note: The new 1151C1/C2 & 1151D1/D2 products will include a CAT5 cable. However, the old 1151B1 and 1151B2 included a standard North American power cord which is not included anymore (must be ordered separately or obtained elsewhere).<--- IP Phone Single Port POE Injector<--- 1151D1<--- 1151D2

41. IP HARDPHONE POWER OPTIONS

document.xls Page 244

<--- 1151C1<--- 1151C2<--- Local Power Brick Transformer

41. IP HARDPHONE POWER OPTIONS

document.xls Page 245

<--- Power Over Ethernet (POE)With Centralized Power, also known as Power over Ethernet (PoE), both power and data are carried over one CAT 5 Ethernet cable. Deploying the IP Telephones utilizing PoE eliminates the need for a local power supply, AC adapter and cables; thereby allowing power to be provided from the wiring closet/switch room where it can be easily connected to a UPS system.

The standards body governing PoE, Institute of Electrical and Electronic Engineers (IEEE) has ratified the standard which defines the specifications to deliver power over standard Ethernet cables. The PoE standard has been approved by the IEEE Standards Board on June 12, 2003 as “IEEE Std. 802.3af-2003”.

The key technical characteristics of the IEEE 802.3af-2003 standard for PoE are cited in the bullets below:• Power Sourcing Equipment (PSE) Output Voltage: 44 Vdc to 57 Vdc• Power Sourcing Equipment (PSE) Output Current: 350 mA max• Power Sourcing Equipment (PSE) Power: 15.4 W max• Powered Device (PD) maximum power draw allowed is 12.95 W• Powered Device (PD) will be ready to accept power from either set of pairs:• Spare Pairs (pins 4/5 and 7/8)• Signal / Data Pairs (pins 1/2 and 3/6)• Signature detection method will be the “Resistor” concept

<--- Avaya Ethernet Routing Switch 2500 Series

41. IP HARDPHONE POWER OPTIONS

document.xls Page 246

<--- Avaya Ethernet Routing Switch 4500 Series

42. 7.0 CD's & SOFTWARE BUILDS

document.xls Page 247

Version

IP Office Firmware 7.0.5IP Office Manager 9.0.5SSA Viewer 7.0.5Network Viewer 9.0.5SysMonitor 9.0.5UpgradeWiz 9.0.5

4.0.5

Java Run Time Environment (JRE) 6.0 Update 23 (1.6.0.23)Video Softphone 3.1 DEV 59616

IP Office Unit Firmware VersionIP500 7.0.5IP500V2 7.0.5Pots Module 7.0.5PotsV2 Module 7.0.5DCP Module 7.0.5DCPV2 Module 7.0.5SO Module 7.0.5ATM Module 7.0.5DS30A/16A Module 7.0.5

Version

2.9.1 (2.9 SP1)4625 2.9.1 (2.9 SP1)4620 (Not 4620SW) 2.34601, 4602D, 4602SW, 5601, 5602D & 5602SW 2.34601+, 4602+, 5601+ & 5602+ 2.9.1 (2.9 SP1)

Version

2.3

2.3.252

Version1603, 1608 & 1616 Boot Code 1.31603, 1608 & 1616 App 1.31616 Button Module 32 App 1.0.9

Version9620 & 9630 & 9640 & 9650 Boot Code 3.1.19620 & 9630 & 9640 & 9650 App 3.1.19608 - Kernel R6_1r289608 - Application R6_1r28

The build numbers are for R7.0 GA Release (7.0.5) March 23, 2011 and contains the following application builds

Admin CD Version - R7.01 DVD (700500928)

Call Status - ( Provided for use with IP Office Firmware older than 4.0 only )

4600/5600 H.323 Phone Firmware (Common Boot Code and App)

4610SW, 4620SW, 4621SW, 5610SW, 5620SW & 5621SW

4600/5600 VPN Phone Firmware (Separate Boot Code and App)

4610SW, 4620SW, 4621SW, 5610SW, 5620SW & 5621SW Boot Code 4610SW, 4620SW, 4621SW, 5610SW, 5620SW & 5621SW App1600 H.323 Phone Firmware (Separate Boot Code

and App)

9600 H.323 Phone Firmware (Separate Boot Code and App)

42. 7.0 CD's & SOFTWARE BUILDS

document.xls Page 248

9621, 9641 - Kernel R6_1r289621, 9641 - Application R6_1r28

42. 7.0 CD's & SOFTWARE BUILDS

document.xls Page 249

11x0 & 12x0 SIP Phone Firmware Version1120 SIP1120e04.01.13.001140 SIP1140e04.01.13.0012xx SIP12x004.01.13.00

DCP Phone Firmware Version2410, 2420, 5410, 5420 61403 Boot Code 031403 App 031408, 1416 Boot Code 251408, 1416 App R15 (vintage 15)9504, 9508 Application R27 (vintage 26)9504, 9508 Boot R14 (vintage 29)9504, 9508 Zarlink R0_07 (vintage 07)

DCP Phone Languages Version14xx R10_v09_Pack01

DCP Phone Font Files Version14xx Chinese (GB) R02_v01

IP DECT Phone Firmware VersionAvaya 3701 22.04.04Avaya 3711 91.24.31.04Avaya 3711 Global 91.24.36Avaya 3711 USB Driver 0.8

IP DECT ADMM Firmware/Tools VersionIP DECT - ADMM Firmware 1.1.13IP DECT - ADMM Java Configuration 1.1.13IP DECT - ADMM DECT Monitor 1.4

DECT R4 Phone Firmware VersionAvaya 3720 4.1.30Avaya 3725 4.1.30Avaya 3740 3.0.16Avaya 3749 3.0.16Avaya 3720 Template 0.4Avaya 3725 Template 0.4Avaya 3740 Template 0.1Avaya 3749 Template 0.1

Wi-Fi Phone Firmware/Tools Version3641/3645 117.056HAT 2.8.22.0AVPP 17x.039

42. 7.0 CD's & SOFTWARE BUILDS

document.xls Page 250

DECT R4 Firmware/Tools VersionDECT R4 - IPBS Boot Firmware 4.1.30DECT R4 - IPBS Firmware 4.1.30DECT R4 - AIWS Firmware 2.73

3.8.1DECT R4 - Rack Charger Firmware 1.3.11DECT R4 - Advanced Charger Firmware 1.3.11DECT R4 - Avaya 3720 Translation Tool 21DECT R4 - Avaya 3725, 3740,3749 Translation Tool 22DECT R4 - Avaya 3720 Downloadable Languages 21

22DECT R4 - Company Phonebook Tool 83720_v3.2.19.pkg is used in PDM 3.2.233725_v3.2.19.pkg is used in PDM 3.2.23374_v3.0.11.pkg is used in PDM 3.0.16

T3 IP Phone Firmware/Tools VersionT3 IP Phone Firmware T247T3 IP Admin Tool 3.08

User CD Version - 4.2.37 VersionPhoneManager - Application and Installer 4.2.36Softconsole - Application and Installer 4.2.23TAPI - Application 1.0.0.35TAPI - Installer 3.2.23Dev Link - Application 1.0.0.5Dev Link - Installer 3.2.8

VoiceMail Pro CD Version 6.0 VersionVoicemail Pro (GUI) 7.0.17Voicemail Pro Server 7.0.17Voicemail Pro Service 7.0.17VPIM Client 7.0.17VPIMDBSvr 7.0.17VPIMReceiver 7.0.17VPIMServer3 7.0.17IMSAdmin 7.0.17IMSServiceRestart 7.0.17UMSServer 7.0.17VMServer 7.0.17PHP Win32 Installer 5.2.6PHP Win32 VC9-x86 5.3.3

one-X Portal CD Versionone-X Portal CD 7.0.14.52

CCR CD VersionCCR CD 7.0.1.31

ContactStore CD VersionContactStore CD 7.8.16

Softphone CD VersionVideo Softphone CD 3.1(59616)

CTI – SDK CD Version

DECT R4 - WinPDM (Windows Portable Device Manager)

DECT R4 - Avaya 3725/3740/3749 Downloadable Languages

42. 7.0 CD's & SOFTWARE BUILDS

document.xls Page 251

CTI – SDK 1.5.4

42. 7.0 CD's & SOFTWARE BUILDS

document.xls Page 252

Application Sever DVD VersionApplication Sever 7.0.10.2

Data Migration Manager VersionData Migration Manager 2.0.20

Note: * The firmware of the 2402/5402 cannot be upgraded.

43. IP Office DevConnect

document.xls Page 253

Application Overview DevConnect Partner Country

Solution Industry

E911

Appl

icat

ion

Suit

e

Atte

ndan

t Co

nsol

e

Billi

ng

Call

Acco

unti

ng

Call

Cont

rol-R

outi

ng

Call/

Cont

act

Cent

er

Conf

eren

cing

Com

mun

icat

ions

Con

tinu

ity

Corp

orat

e H

otel

ing

CRM

Cust

om A

pplic

atio

n D

evel

opm

ent

Dat

a Re

port

ing/

War

ehou

sing

Fax

Serv

er

Hel

p D

esk

Infr

astr

uctu

re

Infr

astr

uctu

re M

anag

emen

t

Man

aged

Ser

vice

s

Mes

sagi

ng

Mob

ility

Mul

ti-m

edia

Con

tact

Cen

ter

Mul

ti-v

endo

r In

tegr

atio

n

Prop

erty

Man

agem

ent

Qua

lity

Mon

itor

ing/

Man

agem

ent

Reco

rdin

g Vo

ice-

Dig

ital

Scre

en P

op

SIP

Endp

oint

s

SIP

Trun

ks

Secu

rity

Spee

ch R

ecog

niti

on

Serv

ice

Prov

ider

Acc

ess

Trun

king

Uni

fied

Com

mun

icat

ions

/fax

ser

vers

Uni

fied

Mes

sagi

ng

Voic

e M

ail-U

nifie

d M

assa

ging

Wal

l Boa

rds

Wor

kfor

ce M

anag

emen

t

Bank

ing

Fina

nce

Gov

ernm

ent-

Fede

ral

Gov

ernm

ent-

Stat

e &

Loc

al

Hea

lthc

are

Hig

her

Educ

atio

n

Hos

pita

lity

Insu

ranc

e

Lega

l

Man

ufac

turi

ng

Reta

il

Tele

com

mun

icat

ions

Tran

spor

tati

on

Uti

litie

s

Switzerland

√ √ √ √ √ √

Canada

√ √ √ √ √

Canada

√ √ √ √ √

Canada

√ √ √ √

PC/PSAP (IP Office 2.1)A software-based PSAP system that satisfies Public PSAP requirements (ANI / ALI / CAD / MAPPING).Also addresses needs of the Private & Hybrid campus PSAP (security).

Amcom Software10400 Yellow Circle DriveEden Prairie, MN 55343

United States952 829-7445

www.amcomsoft.com/

United States

911 Enable provides enterprises and SMBs with simple to deploy, easy to manage E911 solutions that meet the needs of IP-based communications networks. 911 Enable?s solutions include an E911 call routing service, automated phone tracking appliance and security desk notification system.

These solutions have been established according to FCC, CRTC, and NENA i2 standards, helping organizations reduce liability concerns and meet E911 regulations. In 2005, 911 Enable pioneered the first fully integrated E911 solution for enterprise IP phone systems, and has been delivering products and services focused on IP telephony ever since. Today, 911 Enable routes more than 20,000 9-1-1 calls per month and is trusted by over 1000 organizations across the US and Canada.

911 Enable5101 BuchanSuite # 510

Montreal, QC H4P 2R9Canada

1-877-862-2835514-745-8616

arrow www.911enable.com

United States / Canada

NovaAlert(IPO) using SIPWith NovaAlert you can process information from a variety of extraneous systems in order to then alert or inform the responsible people in a targeted fashion. In this respect the NovaAlert system already supports many different. The information and events that are signalled via the various input interfaces to the server can be subsequently distributed via existing output interfaces (information paths). In this way the NovaAlert alerting server helps you to reach and inform the responsible people at the right time. By means of this rapid and reliable distribution of information NovaAlert can optimise your reaction time in an emergency (alert) and contribute to avoiding major damage and the associated costs. The NovaAlert system is modular in structure, which enables it to be incorporated into both smaller and very large projects. This modularity also provides optimum value for money.

NovaLink GmbHBusiness Tower

Zuercherstrasse 310Frauenfeld, 8500

Switzerland +41 52 762 66 66

FAX +41 52 762 66 99 www.novalink.ch

Revolution Web Call Accounting (IPO)Revolution Web Compliant with Avaya IP Office Solution. Revolution Web Call Accounting is a dynamic browser-based communications management solution that can be deployed in minutes. Revolution Web can allocate telecom expenses to individuals or departments. It is equipped with an embedded SQL database engine, built-in Web server and automated reporting. Revolution Web can monitor incoming and outgoing calls in real-time. Alarms and reports can be scheduled for emergency 911 notification, toll fraud or misuse reporting. Revolution Web can be deployed in virtually any enterprise.

Resource Software International Ltd.

40 King Street West, Suite 300Oshawa, Ontario L1H 1A4

Canada 905 576-4575

FAX 905 576-4705 www.telecost.com

Igeacare Apolo Event Notification System (ENS)The apolo ENS GUI interface allows ease of communication with standard analog, digital and/or IP telephony desk sets. It provides intuitive operation and eliminates the need for specialized training. The system provides real-time event notification and acknowledgement on any visual display. The console can also allow for priority audible tone and automated speech notification.

IgeaCare System91 Granton Drive

Richmond Hill, ON L4B-2N5Canada

905 707 1669FAX 905 707 1775

www.igeacare.com

Igeacare nursecall with apollo,Igeacom 300,301,500,501,MP501,600,601,700 (IPO)The core of the solution is the communications server, linking various functions and systems together. Dial tone, provided by the server, handles the nurse call function. Emergency calls are placed from the resident’s or patient’s room by means of a red-colored momentary push button, red emergency button located directly on main unit, hard-wired pull cords, or wireless peripherals including a pendant and pull cord. These emergency calls are then routed using the server’s flexible programming to any networked desk, wireless telephones or pocket pagers ringing in sequence or together. During the call process, the room number, origin, level of urgency, and name of resident, if requested, are displayed on telephones/pagers programmed to receive emergency calls from that location.

IgeaCare System91 Granton Drive

Richmond Hill, ON L4B-2N5Canada

905 707 1669FAX 905 707 1775

www.igeacare.com

43. IP Office DevConnect

document.xls Page 254

Application Overview DevConnect Partner Country

Solution Industry

E911

Appl

icat

ion

Suit

e

Atte

ndan

t Co

nsol

e

Billi

ng

Call

Acco

unti

ng

Call

Cont

rol-R

outi

ng

Call/

Cont

act

Cent

er

Conf

eren

cing

Com

mun

icat

ions

Con

tinu

ity

Corp

orat

e H

otel

ing

CRM

Cust

om A

pplic

atio

n D

evel

opm

ent

Dat

a Re

port

ing/

War

ehou

sing

Fax

Serv

er

Hel

p D

esk

Infr

astr

uctu

re

Infr

astr

uctu

re M

anag

emen

t

Man

aged

Ser

vice

s

Mes

sagi

ng

Mob

ility

Mul

ti-m

edia

Con

tact

Cen

ter

Mul

ti-v

endo

r In

tegr

atio

n

Prop

erty

Man

agem

ent

Qua

lity

Mon

itor

ing/

Man

agem

ent

Reco

rdin

g Vo

ice-

Dig

ital

Scre

en P

op

SIP

Endp

oint

s

SIP

Trun

ks

Secu

rity

Spee

ch R

ecog

niti

on

Serv

ice

Prov

ider

Acc

ess

Trun

king

Uni

fied

Com

mun

icat

ions

/fax

ser

vers

Uni

fied

Mes

sagi

ng

Voic

e M

ail-U

nifie

d M

assa

ging

Wal

l Boa

rds

Wor

kfor

ce M

anag

emen

t

Bank

ing

Fina

nce

Gov

ernm

ent-

Fede

ral

Gov

ernm

ent-

Stat

e &

Loc

al

Hea

lthc

are

Hig

her

Educ

atio

n

Hos

pita

lity

Insu

ranc

e

Lega

l

Man

ufac

turi

ng

Reta

il

Tele

com

mun

icat

ions

Tran

spor

tati

on

Uti

litie

s

√ √

√ √ √

Canada

√ √ √ √ √ √

Australia

√ √ √ √

Sweden

√ √ √ √

Germany

√ √ √

XTEND Communications Corp. pc/psap is a PC and LAN based system, which has the capabilities to extract ANI information from calls arriving from E-911 trunks and retrieve the call’s corresponding ALI (Automatic Location Information) information.

XTEND Communications Corp. Customer Service Center at (212) 951-7670. Technical support email can be

sent to [email protected].

United States

Telcomp PickUpIp application provides Caller ID capabilities to a single computer, or to a network of computers via the Telcomp PickUp application. The Telcomp PickUpEm application provides 911 emergency alert messages to be directed at a central console. All three of these applications work in conjunction with the Telcomp TcIpOff connection server application.

Customer Service Center (407) 889-7377

United Kingdom

Broadvox Go SIP Trunking (NextPoint)GO! SIP Trunking is a VoIP/SIP Trunking service that includes unlimited local and long distance calling, discounted international and toll-free, DIDs, E911, local number porting and enhanced local numbers for remote offices and telecommuting workers. Business continuity and dynamic load balancing is available. Broadband connectivity includes DSL, T1 and DS3.

Broadvox, LLC1950 N. Stemmons Hwy, Suite 3031

Dallas, TX 75207United States 214 646 8000

FAX 216 373 4876 www.broadvox.com

United States

Visual RapportResource Software International Visual Rapport is a visual communication console that provides desktop dialing, telephone status / presence, instant messaging, email, screen pop, call logging, and file transfer. Visual Rapport is a desktop productivity suite providing real time display of employee telephone status, instant messaging, desktop dialing, email integration, call logging, file transfer and screen-pop integration. Visual Rapport is pre-configured with an extensive library of scripts that communicate with many commercial contact management and database applications (i.e., Microsoft Outlook, Maximizer, Goldmine, Act) and unique in-house custom applications. Visual Rapport offers an integrated scripting engine that gives customers the ability to tailor their system with such features as time logging, account code prompting, URL screen pop and call accounting integration.

Resource Software International Ltd.

40 King Street West, Suite 300Oshawa, Ontario L1H 1A4

Canada 905 576-4575

FAX 905 576-4705 www.telecost.com

Unified Communications SuiteThe CyTrack UC Suite features 9 modules including :CyTrack CyDesk - Telephone Unified Communications & CTICyTrack CyRecord - Integrated & Flexible Voice RecordingCyTrack CyCall - Multi-Media Outbound & Tele-Marketing Call CentreCyTrack CyConsole Unified Communications for Front Desk OperatorsCyTrack CyReport Call Accounting & Business Intelligence ReportingCyTrack CyQ - Multi-Media Super Highway Inbound Call Centre

CyTrack Technologies155 Varsity Parade

Varsity LakesGold Coast, QLD 4227

Australia +61 7 5553 9800 www.cytrack.com

Vision 80/20 for IP Office Vision 80/20 is a widely used application for managing presence information as well as to provide attendant functionality and voicemail for small

companies and large enterprises. Vision 80/20 is a complete application combining attendant console, APBX/PBX-integration and an interface for users to

administer their extension/profile via a web application.

Visionutveckling ABGardesvagen 1

STENUNGSUND, SE 44431SWEDEN

+46 303 729200+46 303 729260

arrow www.visionutv.se

The ESTOS Remote CallControlGateway integrates Microsoft Office Communications Server and Microsoft

Office Communicator with TAPI- and most CSTA-compliant PBX systems via SIP and uaCSTA. It reduces the need to

upgrade to new telecommunications infrastructure, extending investment protection for a businesses’ existing

communications technology.

ESTOS GmbH Petersbrunner Str. 3a 82319 Starnberg Germany Phone: +49

(8151) 368 561-77 Fax: +49 (8151) 368 561-99 Mail: [email protected] or:

http://www.estos.de/metanavigation/kontakt/e-mail.html

43. IP Office DevConnect

document.xls Page 255

Application Overview DevConnect Partner Country

Solution Industry

E911

Appl

icat

ion

Suit

e

Atte

ndan

t Co

nsol

e

Billi

ng

Call

Acco

unti

ng

Call

Cont

rol-R

outi

ng

Call/

Cont

act

Cent

er

Conf

eren

cing

Com

mun

icat

ions

Con

tinu

ity

Corp

orat

e H

otel

ing

CRM

Cust

om A

pplic

atio

n D

evel

opm

ent

Dat

a Re

port

ing/

War

ehou

sing

Fax

Serv

er

Hel

p D

esk

Infr

astr

uctu

re

Infr

astr

uctu

re M

anag

emen

t

Man

aged

Ser

vice

s

Mes

sagi

ng

Mob

ility

Mul

ti-m

edia

Con

tact

Cen

ter

Mul

ti-v

endo

r In

tegr

atio

n

Prop

erty

Man

agem

ent

Qua

lity

Mon

itor

ing/

Man

agem

ent

Reco

rdin

g Vo

ice-

Dig

ital

Scre

en P

op

SIP

Endp

oint

s

SIP

Trun

ks

Secu

rity

Spee

ch R

ecog

niti

on

Serv

ice

Prov

ider

Acc

ess

Trun

king

Uni

fied

Com

mun

icat

ions

/fax

ser

vers

Uni

fied

Mes

sagi

ng

Voic

e M

ail-U

nifie

d M

assa

ging

Wal

l Boa

rds

Wor

kfor

ce M

anag

emen

t

Bank

ing

Fina

nce

Gov

ernm

ent-

Fede

ral

Gov

ernm

ent-

Stat

e &

Loc

al

Hea

lthc

are

Hig

her

Educ

atio

n

Hos

pita

lity

Insu

ranc

e

Lega

l

Man

ufac

turi

ng

Reta

il

Tele

com

mun

icat

ions

Tran

spor

tati

on

Uti

litie

s

√ √ √ √ √ √ √

√ √

√ √ √ √ √ √

√ √ √ √ √ √

Synthesys (for IPO)Synthesys is a suite of products that gives non-technical staff the tools to manage the contact center and the people in it. With SYNTHESYS you can unify front end through SOA type software framework, streamline multiple front end processes without programming, fix maximum of silent calls yet optimizing agent productivity, gather field service requests from clients and dispatch them to field staff. All via one seamless system. The wide-ranging functionality is presented in an easy-to-use drag-and-drop windows environment offers call flow scripts to guide the agentsâ?? interactions. Call list creation and queuing manages outbound operations. Teams are created and user accounts and permissions are set up. CRM functionality maximises the value of historical customer data, supporting conversations. Multiple channels of contact are managed, including telephone, email, post, SMS, live chat, and interactive forms. CTI links the telephony system and the software automating many processes to reduce call-handling times. Reporting and workflow supports the efficient running of contact center operations.

Noetica Ltd7-11 St Johns Hill

London, SW11 1TNUnited Kingdom

44 207 326 8500 FAX 44 207 801 9515

www.noetica.com

United Kingdom

Adaptive Contact CentreThe Adaptive Contact Centre is a suite of modules. Each can be run independently or can be a part of a comprehensive multichannel contact centre. Adaptive CTI Professional is a fully featured CTI product. It can be used to screen-pop non TAPI compliant applications and can be used in a Citrix or Terminal Services environment.

New Media Software LtdPO Box 299

Eastleigh, Hampshire SO50 7WRUnited Kingdom

+44 (0)845 612 4000FAX +44 (0)845 612 4001 www.nms-adaptive.com

United Kingdom

VeraSMART (IP Office 2.1)The VeraSMART® Communications Management Suite is a Telecom Expense Management (TEM) application platform for managing complex communications networks comprised of converged IP and TDM premises-based technologies, mobile and remote workers, and wireless devices. With support for sourcing, ordering and provisioning, inventory and invoice management, usage and dispute management, VeraSMART can help you optimize TEM processes, automate workflows, improve productivity, and reduce costs. A robust, flexible reporting engine makes it easy to extract the data you need to make informed business decisions and improve network security. Configurable 3D dashboards let you monitor key data trends at a glance. VeraSMART deploys quickly, is easy to maintain, and has low TCO. With modular, scalable architecture, VeraSMART can be configured to match the needs of any organization. VeraSMART can be deployed as a premise-based licensed solution, hosted software as a service (SaaS), or as part of a BPO solution. Available through the GSA.

Veramark Technologies Inc.3750 Monroe Ave

Pittsford, NY 14534United States

585-381-6000 FAX 585-383-6800

www.veramark.com

United States

Tiger 2020 Pro with Avaya IP OfficeThe Tiger 2020 Pro Voice Traffic Management and Voice Network Security modules provide a total solution for effective voice traffic management, voice network control and voice cost control. The Tiger 2020 Pro offers a wide range of Reports including Departmental Cost & Usage, Dialled Number Analysis, Comparative Carrier Cost Analysis & Exception Reporting. Traffic Reports include Grade of Service and Trunk Utilisation reports aiding the future planning to convergence. The optional Voice Network Security Module provides a pro-active management tool capable of detecting fraudulent activity on company telephone networks. Real-time call data is continually compared against sets of bench mark call data to assess whether the limits have been exceeded, ensuring that immediate action can be taken in the event of a potential fraudulent activity which could have serious financial and network resource implications.

Tiger Communications77-79 Christchurch Road

Ringwood, Hampshire BH24 1DHUnited Kingdom

+44 (1425) 891000FAX +44 (01425) 461484 www.tigercomms.com

United Kingdom

43. IP Office DevConnect

document.xls Page 256

Application Overview DevConnect Partner Country

Solution Industry

E911

Appl

icat

ion

Suit

e

Atte

ndan

t Co

nsol

e

Billi

ng

Call

Acco

unti

ng

Call

Cont

rol-R

outi

ng

Call/

Cont

act

Cent

er

Conf

eren

cing

Com

mun

icat

ions

Con

tinu

ity

Corp

orat

e H

otel

ing

CRM

Cust

om A

pplic

atio

n D

evel

opm

ent

Dat

a Re

port

ing/

War

ehou

sing

Fax

Serv

er

Hel

p D

esk

Infr

astr

uctu

re

Infr

astr

uctu

re M

anag

emen

t

Man

aged

Ser

vice

s

Mes

sagi

ng

Mob

ility

Mul

ti-m

edia

Con

tact

Cen

ter

Mul

ti-v

endo

r In

tegr

atio

n

Prop

erty

Man

agem

ent

Qua

lity

Mon

itor

ing/

Man

agem

ent

Reco

rdin

g Vo

ice-

Dig

ital

Scre

en P

op

SIP

Endp

oint

s

SIP

Trun

ks

Secu

rity

Spee

ch R

ecog

niti

on

Serv

ice

Prov

ider

Acc

ess

Trun

king

Uni

fied

Com

mun

icat

ions

/fax

ser

vers

Uni

fied

Mes

sagi

ng

Voic

e M

ail-U

nifie

d M

assa

ging

Wal

l Boa

rds

Wor

kfor

ce M

anag

emen

t

Bank

ing

Fina

nce

Gov

ernm

ent-

Fede

ral

Gov

ernm

ent-

Stat

e &

Loc

al

Hea

lthc

are

Hig

her

Educ

atio

n

Hos

pita

lity

Insu

ranc

e

Lega

l

Man

ufac

turi

ng

Reta

il

Tele

com

mun

icat

ions

Tran

spor

tati

on

Uti

litie

s

Switzerland

√ √ √ √ √

France

√ √ √ √

√ √ √ √

√ √ √ √

Canada

√ √ √ √ √ √

NovaAlert(IPO) using S0 and PRI/QSIGWith NovaAlert you can process information from a variety of extraneous systems in order to then alert or inform the responsible people in a targeted fashion. In this respect the NovaAlert system already supports many different. The information and events that are signalled via the various input interfaces to the server can be subsequently distributed via existing output interfaces (information paths). In this way the NovaAlert alerting server helps you to reach and inform the responsible people at the right time. By means of this rapid and reliable distribution of information NovaAlert can optimise your reaction time in an emergency (alert) and contribute to avoiding major damage and the associated costs. The NovaAlert system is modular in structure, which enables it to be incorporated into both smaller and very large projects. This modularity also provides optimum value for money.

NovaLink GmbHBusiness Tower

Zuercherstrasse 310Frauenfeld, 8500

Switzerland +41 52 762 66 66

FAX +41 52 762 66 99 www.novalink.ch

NOVAHOP (on IPO)NovaProHop CS software suite is a PC-based application suite that provides an end user interface with Avaya IP Office in a Healthcare environment. The suite is able to manage one or several Avaya IP Offices, and works as a client/server application to meet the requirements of hospitals or retirement homes. It is widely used in hospitals and retirement homes in France. With this application, you provide your patients with an extensive telephone service, including several billing capabilities according to the type of hospitalization (long stay, retirement, ?), the possibility to follow your patient over several stays (keeep its DID number, its confidential key, its phone credit,?), and to include in his billing television costs, and other expenses like newspapers or any item that you would like to sell. Tailored to meet your needs, you will be able to fine tune the software behaviour to match your internal procedures. This application covers the whole hospitality field, from the small retirement home up to the biggest multi thousand beds hospitals, with simultaneous users ranging from one to more than a hundred. As a manager, you will be able to supervise your telephony costs, optimize the quality of your switchboard, and perform all the statistics and reports your board of directors will ever need. Furthermore, it has

SLIT31 rue de Cuire

LYON, France 69004France

+33472101650 www.slit.fr

ProfitWatch (IP Office)ProfitWatch for Hotels offers flexible and sophisticated guest pricing and billing options for hotels wishing to generate revenue from guest and convention telephone calls. Available in standalone, web-enabled and client/server versions, ProfitWatch is the perfect telemanagement and billing solution for hotels of all sizes. Current customers include Starwood Hotels, InterContinental Hotels Group, Hilton, Marriott International and Choice Hotels.

Metropolis Technologies, Inc.6278 N Federal Hwy #413Fort Lauderdale, FL 33308

United States 954-941-1010

FAX 954-301-0819 www.metropolis.com

United States

OfficeWatch Call Accounting for Business (IP Office)Metropolis creates the powerful, user-friendly telemanagement solution OfficeWatch for Business. OfficeWatch integrates seamlessly with the IP Office and helps users improve employee productivity, control telephone costs, monitor trunk traffic, and archive historical phone call data. Businesses can also use OfficeWatch to recoup costs for the phone system by billing tenants and/or clients for usage. Some businesses currently using OfficeWatch include law firms, clinics, assisted living facilities, schools, banks, call centers, retail stores and municipalities.

Metropolis Technologies, Inc.6278 N Federal Hwy #413Fort Lauderdale, FL 33308

United States 954-941-1010

FAX 954-301-0819 www.metropolis.com

United States

Shadow Call Management SoftwareShadow CMS is a fully-scalable communication management solution allowing administrators to forecast, monitor and allocate communications management expenses. It also provides metrics for facility planning, customer service, workforce management and bill back. Shadow CMS interfaces with Avaya telephone systems for real-time data retrieval. The information is processed, assigned a cost and delivered to property management systems for billing integration.

Resource Software International Ltd.

40 King Street West, Suite 300Oshawa, Ontario L1H 1A4

Canada 905 576-4575

FAX 905 576-4705 www.telecost.com

43. IP Office DevConnect

document.xls Page 257

Application Overview DevConnect Partner Country

Solution Industry

E911

Appl

icat

ion

Suit

e

Atte

ndan

t Co

nsol

e

Billi

ng

Call

Acco

unti

ng

Call

Cont

rol-R

outi

ng

Call/

Cont

act

Cent

er

Conf

eren

cing

Com

mun

icat

ions

Con

tinu

ity

Corp

orat

e H

otel

ing

CRM

Cust

om A

pplic

atio

n D

evel

opm

ent

Dat

a Re

port

ing/

War

ehou

sing

Fax

Serv

er

Hel

p D

esk

Infr

astr

uctu

re

Infr

astr

uctu

re M

anag

emen

t

Man

aged

Ser

vice

s

Mes

sagi

ng

Mob

ility

Mul

ti-m

edia

Con

tact

Cen

ter

Mul

ti-v

endo

r In

tegr

atio

n

Prop

erty

Man

agem

ent

Qua

lity

Mon

itor

ing/

Man

agem

ent

Reco

rdin

g Vo

ice-

Dig

ital

Scre

en P

op

SIP

Endp

oint

s

SIP

Trun

ks

Secu

rity

Spee

ch R

ecog

niti

on

Serv

ice

Prov

ider

Acc

ess

Trun

king

Uni

fied

Com

mun

icat

ions

/fax

ser

vers

Uni

fied

Mes

sagi

ng

Voic

e M

ail-U

nifie

d M

assa

ging

Wal

l Boa

rds

Wor

kfor

ce M

anag

emen

t

Bank

ing

Fina

nce

Gov

ernm

ent-

Fede

ral

Gov

ernm

ent-

Stat

e &

Loc

al

Hea

lthc

are

Hig

her

Educ

atio

n

Hos

pita

lity

Insu

ranc

e

Lega

l

Man

ufac

turi

ng

Reta

il

Tele

com

mun

icat

ions

Tran

spor

tati

on

Uti

litie

s

Switzerland

√ √ √ √

√ √ √

√ √ √ √ √ √

√ √ √ √ √ √

NovaTax(IPO)NovaTax helps you to have keep communications in your company under control, and provides you with a precise overview. With NovaTax you know where it may be necessary to take action. Find out how long your customers have to wait before being put through. Is your infrastructure correctly designed or are individual connections overloaded or even designed on to large a scale? NovaTax helps you to simply evaluate and clearly represent these decisive factors and questions of today's business environment. Have the relevant data sent to you by email on a daily basis or evaluate the call data on the client yourself. In this way you can receive detailed reports on your call data, thereby reducing your telephone costs.

NovaLink GmbHBusiness Tower

Zuercherstrasse 310Frauenfeld, 8500

Switzerland +41 52 762 66 66

FAX +41 52 762 66 99 www.novalink.ch

Report (for IPO)Report is compliant with Avaya IP Office Solution. Report allows for the automation of many tasks, thus minimizing the management overheads while maximizing the effective usage of the system within the organization. User Benefits: Large and comprehensive range of reports available in both Summary and Itemized formats. All reports can be previewed on screen with zoom and page search facilities, allowing a quick review of the largest of reports. Each extension can be named and placed into departments/groups. Groups can then become part of other groups to create a group hierarchy. Reports can then be chosen which use the group hierarchy to present summary or itemized call information. Cost, response & traffic reports include full analysis capabilities. Account reports allow for call cost uplift and professional charges.

Oak Telecom7 Albany ParkCabot Lane

Poole, Dorset BH17 7BXUnited Kingdom

+44 1202 607000FAX +44 1202 607001

www.oak.co.uk

United Kingdom

eCAS call accounting solution (IP Office)VeraSMART eCAS Call Accounting is a Web browser-based solution that helps organizations gain control over their telecom activity, reduce costs, and improve productivity. Compatible with TDM, IP or hybrid networks, VeraSMART eCAS makes it easy to collect, analyze, and report on call activity and expenses, providing the data necessary to make informed business decisions. Configurable 3D dashboards let you monitor key data trends at a glance. In addition, VeraSMART eCAS includes a powerful reporting engine that offers a wide variety of reports that can be configured to meet the needs of any organization. Features include online presentation with drill-down capability, column sorting, and dynamic charts that automatically adjust to sort criteria. Reports are easily disseminated using our exclusive EZ-Burst feature that supports automated email distribution of selected portions of a single report to designated individuals. The right reports reach the right recipients, maximizing the value the information while ensuring security.

Veramark Technologies Inc.3750 Monroe Ave

Pittsford, NY 14534United States

585-381-6000FAX 585-383-6800

www.veramark.com

United States

Tiger Innovation 2020 with Avaya IP OfficeWhen something is this easy to use and this intuitive, we understand why it might be taken for granted. That's the way it should be. Technology, at its best, is transparent. TIGER InnOvation 2020 is specifically designed for the hospitality industry. We've combined voice mail, automated attendant, and wake-up calls into one powerful system. TIGER InnOvation 2020 provides an extensive set of features that turn your guest phones into complete information centres. While your guests will appreciate its benefits, you'll enjoy increased productivity and profitability. TIGER InnOvation 2020 will interface with your existing equipment, so there's no need to replace your phone system. It's so dependable and seamless, you'll forget it's there. BENEFITS . Guest Voice Messaging eliminates the need for message taking and delivery, freeing up valuable staff time. . Staff Voice Messaging creates more efficient staff communications. Special instructions, work schedules and maintenance orders can all be communicated through InnOvation 2020. . Call Forwarding means neither guests nor staff need ever miss a call. InnOvation 2020's built-in InnConnect feature allows callers the option to connect to another number, such as a

Tiger Communications77-79 Christchurch Road

Ringwood, Hampshire BH24 1DHUnited Kingdom

+44 (1425) 891000FAX +44 (01425) 461484 www.tigercomms.com

United Kingdom

43. IP Office DevConnect

document.xls Page 258

Application Overview DevConnect Partner Country

Solution Industry

E911

Appl

icat

ion

Suit

e

Atte

ndan

t Co

nsol

e

Billi

ng

Call

Acco

unti

ng

Call

Cont

rol-R

outi

ng

Call/

Cont

act

Cent

er

Conf

eren

cing

Com

mun

icat

ions

Con

tinu

ity

Corp

orat

e H

otel

ing

CRM

Cust

om A

pplic

atio

n D

evel

opm

ent

Dat

a Re

port

ing/

War

ehou

sing

Fax

Serv

er

Hel

p D

esk

Infr

astr

uctu

re

Infr

astr

uctu

re M

anag

emen

t

Man

aged

Ser

vice

s

Mes

sagi

ng

Mob

ility

Mul

ti-m

edia

Con

tact

Cen

ter

Mul

ti-v

endo

r In

tegr

atio

n

Prop

erty

Man

agem

ent

Qua

lity

Mon

itor

ing/

Man

agem

ent

Reco

rdin

g Vo

ice-

Dig

ital

Scre

en P

op

SIP

Endp

oint

s

SIP

Trun

ks

Secu

rity

Spee

ch R

ecog

niti

on

Serv

ice

Prov

ider

Acc

ess

Trun

king

Uni

fied

Com

mun

icat

ions

/fax

ser

vers

Uni

fied

Mes

sagi

ng

Voic

e M

ail-U

nifie

d M

assa

ging

Wal

l Boa

rds

Wor

kfor

ce M

anag

emen

t

Bank

ing

Fina

nce

Gov

ernm

ent-

Fede

ral

Gov

ernm

ent-

Stat

e &

Loc

al

Hea

lthc

are

Hig

her

Educ

atio

n

Hos

pita

lity

Insu

ranc

e

Lega

l

Man

ufac

turi

ng

Reta

il

Tele

com

mun

icat

ions

Tran

spor

tati

on

Uti

litie

s

√ √ √

√ √ √ √ √ √

Canada

√ √ √ √ √

India

√ √ √ √

Tiger Hotel Pro with Avaya IP OfficeTIGER HOTEL PRO is the key to maximising telephony & data revenue whilst improving Guest Satisfaction. Designed specifically for the hospitality sector, TIGER HOTEL PRO contains a suite of features that help the hotelier encourage guests to use the telephone services and facilities available, not only within their rooms but also throughout the hotel. This technology allows for easy profiling of telephone call patterns to determine viable incentives such as: HAPPY HOUR on phone calls in an otherwise quiet period. VOLUME DISCOUNTS for guests with a high call usage requirement. GROUP DISCOUNTS for guests wishing to call home. LONG DURATION incentives for guests wishing to chat or stay on-line. SPECIAL RATES for frequently dialled numbers. FIXED SERVICE CHARGES to Freephone or Lo-call numbers CALL ACCOUNTING - Unlimited Guest Tariffs - Exception Charging - Time Based Tariff - Unit Based Tariff - Sliding Scale Rate - Independent Data and Fax Rates - Separate Conference and Booth Rates INTEGRATED SOLUTIONS - At the core of TIGER HOTEL PRO is a powerful generic integration engine designed to handle inter-connectivity of any system using all of the communications available today and planned for the future. This engine allows us to implement bi-directional

Tiger Communications77-79 Christchurch Road

Ringwood, Hampshire BH24 1DHUnited Kingdom

+44 (1425) 891000FAX +44 (01425) 461484 www.tigercomms.com

United Kingdom

CallSWEET! LiveCall SWEET! Live is a first-rate real-time contact center management solution that helps businesses increase overall efficiency, cut costs and improve customer service by monitoring and reporting on various real-time aspects of a contact center, from agent status and hunt group call activity to speed of answer and calls in queue. Additional features include alarms, live chat and wall boards. Call SWEET! Live also provides robust historical reporting through its layered call accounting application, Call SWEET!. Call SWEET! Live is highly scalable to meet the needs of any size company and versatile enough to fit any industry.

DATEL Software Solutions515 Pleasant Valley Road

Trafford, PA 15085United States

724-744-1380FAX 724-744-9847

www.datel-group.com

United States

CASH+ Call Accounting (IPO)CASH+ Call Accounting software systems monitor and report telecommunication activity. CASH+ Software collects incoming and outgoing telephone data generated by the phone switch and is used to control operation expenses, distribute costs and increase employee productivity. Call Detail Recording (CDR), Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) or telephone data collected typically includes date, time, call duration, calling/destination parties, call authorization, account code and line/trunk information. CASH+ Software uses this data to provide cost, caller identification, location information and more for report summary and detail generation. CASH+ Call Accounting software is customizable to size of company and can be used in virtually all different kinds of industries.

Hansen Software Corp.Suite 300, 1855 Kirschner Road

http://www.runaware.com/clients/hansensw/cashplus/

Kelowna, BC V1Y 4N7Canada

877-795-2274 250-861-9177

www.hansensoftware.com

PSwitchView for IP OfficePSwitchView (PSV) is Windows based Telephone call analysis software. It establishes communications with most of the PBX systems available in the open market. The computer running PSwitchView needs to be wired to PBX permanently. This could be over office LAN in case of IP based PBX or a separate cable from serial/USB port of computer to serial port of PBX. PSwitchView once activated, remains in touch with PBX and collects the call event information as soon as any call event occurs at any of the extensions or trunks. These events are processed and stored in the database instantly. Deployment of PSwitchView provides various analyses. It keeps track of all the events happening at each telephone extension from the PBX. These recorded events are processed and presented in the form of various MIS leading to controlled communication cost and reduced misuse. Features: 1. Incoming, outgoing, and intercom calls monitoring 2. Extensions and PSTN / TIE lines monitoring 3. Extension-wise call details 4. Department-wise telephone cost utilization. 5. Reference document for reconciling against bills 6. Monitor actual cost visa-a-vis allocated budgets with respect to Extensions / departments 7. Highlight expensive and long duration calls 8. Distinguish official and personal

Telesoft601 - Aditya, Parleshwar Road,

Opp Parleshwar Temple, Vile Parle East,Mumbai, Maharashtra 400097

India +91-22-26155141

FAX +91-22-26154923 www.telesoft.in

43. IP Office DevConnect

document.xls Page 259

Application Overview DevConnect Partner Country

Solution Industry

E911

Appl

icat

ion

Suit

e

Atte

ndan

t Co

nsol

e

Billi

ng

Call

Acco

unti

ng

Call

Cont

rol-R

outi

ng

Call/

Cont

act

Cent

er

Conf

eren

cing

Com

mun

icat

ions

Con

tinu

ity

Corp

orat

e H

otel

ing

CRM

Cust

om A

pplic

atio

n D

evel

opm

ent

Dat

a Re

port

ing/

War

ehou

sing

Fax

Serv

er

Hel

p D

esk

Infr

astr

uctu

re

Infr

astr

uctu

re M

anag

emen

t

Man

aged

Ser

vice

s

Mes

sagi

ng

Mob

ility

Mul

ti-m

edia

Con

tact

Cen

ter

Mul

ti-v

endo

r In

tegr

atio

n

Prop

erty

Man

agem

ent

Qua

lity

Mon

itor

ing/

Man

agem

ent

Reco

rdin

g Vo

ice-

Dig

ital

Scre

en P

op

SIP

Endp

oint

s

SIP

Trun

ks

Secu

rity

Spee

ch R

ecog

niti

on

Serv

ice

Prov

ider

Acc

ess

Trun

king

Uni

fied

Com

mun

icat

ions

/fax

ser

vers

Uni

fied

Mes

sagi

ng

Voic

e M

ail-U

nifie

d M

assa

ging

Wal

l Boa

rds

Wor

kfor

ce M

anag

emen

t

Bank

ing

Fina

nce

Gov

ernm

ent-

Fede

ral

Gov

ernm

ent-

Stat

e &

Loc

al

Hea

lthc

are

Hig

her

Educ

atio

n

Hos

pita

lity

Insu

ranc

e

Lega

l

Man

ufac

turi

ng

Reta

il

Tele

com

mun

icat

ions

Tran

spor

tati

on

Uti

litie

s

France

√ √ √ √

Russia√

√ √ √

France√

NOVAHotel (on IPO)Nova Hotel software suite is a PC-based application suite that provides an end user interface with Avaya IP Office in a Hospitality environment. The suite is able to manage one or several Avaya IP Offices, and works as a web application to meet the requirements of hotels. It is widely used in hotels in France. With this application, your desk attendants will be able to manage the arrival of individual guests or groups, bill customers at the end of their stay, or move them between rooms, at the ease of a mouseclick. As a manager, you will be able to follow the telephony costs of your phone installation, perform statistics on your incoming or outgoing calls, in order to optimize the quality of your reception desk. The NovaHotel Suite can be linked with all major front office of the hotel branch, including Fidelio and Amadeus, with which validation has been awarded to us.

SLIT31 rue de Cuire

LYON, France 69004France

+33472101650 www.slit.fr

TriVium CallAnalyst is an application that facilitates reporting, costing, and analyzing acustomer’s phone system. It collects call records from the IP Office server via the SMDR(Station Message Detailed Record) log file.

TriVium(503) [email protected].

For sales support, call (877) 439-9338.United States

Trisys TAPIT EX Call Accounting for Business software is a call management and accounting software package designed to report on the phone activity of a business. TAPIT EX works with the Call Detail Record (CDR) / Station Message Detail Reporting (SMDR) information output by Avaya IP Office Delta Server.

TAPIT EX:• Phone: (973) 360-2300 option 3

• E-mail: [email protected]• Web: http://www.trisys.com/TechSupp.htm

United States

CTI Data Solutions Proteus Enterprise 6.1 is a call logging system that records Station Messaging Detail Records (SMDR) outputted by Avaya IP Office to the Avaya IP Office Delta Server over an IP network connection. Proteus Enterprise provides information about telephone usage through a range of reports that can be printed or saved to a number of popular file formats for further analysis.

http://support.ctidata.co.uk.Email: [email protected]: +44 (0) 84 5123 2761

United Kingdom

LightNet Complex IPO Play! Statistics collects statistical information of all calls in an Avaya IP Office and accumulates the information in a database, which can then be viewed using a Web browser.

LightNet Complex Support at +7 (495) 2324848 or by sending e-mail to

[email protected].

CallSWEET!Call SWEET! collects and reports on the Station Message Detail Reporting (SMDR) information written to comma-separated files by Avaya IP Office Delta Server.

DATEL Software Solutions515 Pleasant Valley Road

Trafford, PA 15085United States

724-744-1380FAX 724-744-9847

www.datel-group.com

United States

Tri-Line’s TIM Enterprise is a Windows-based call analysis software program that collects and reports on the Station Message Detail Reporting (SMDR) information generated by Avaya IP Office Delta Server.

Phone: +44 20 7265 2626E-mail: [email protected]: http://www.tri-line.com/ Address: 9-10 Telfords Yard

The Highway LONDON E1W 2BS England

United Kingdom

Tri-Line’s TIM Plus is a Windows-based call analysis software program that collects and reports on the Station Message Detail Reporting (SMDR) information generated by Avaya IP Office Delta Server.

Phone: +44 20 7265 2626E-mail: [email protected]: http://www.tri-line.com/ Address: 9-10 Telfords Yard

The Highway LONDON E1W 2BS England

United Kingdom

Tri-Line’s TIM Professional is a Windows-based call analysis software program that collects and reports on the Station Message Detail Reporting (SMDR) information generated by Avaya IP Office Delta Server.

Phone: +44 20 7265 2626E-mail: [email protected]: http://www.tri-line.com/ Address: 9-10 Telfords Yard

The Highway LONDON E1W 2BS England

United Kingdom

Oak Telecom aiOffice call management software is a call management and reporting software package designed to report on the phone activity of a business. aiOffice works with the Station Message Detail Reporting (SMDR) records outputted by Avaya IP Office Delta Server. aiOffice collects, stores and processes these SMDR records to provide usage analysis, call costing and billing capabilities.

Technical support:• Phone: 0870 2000 247

• E-mail: [email protected]• Web: www.oak.co.uk

United Kingdom

Imagine Soft CLARity with Avaya IP Office. CLARity is a call accounting program which processes Call Detail Records generated by IP Office

424, Rue Paradis 13008 Marseille - FRANCE - Tél. +33 (0)4 91 32 74 00 -

Fax. +33 (0)4 91 32 74 01 - [email protected]

43. IP Office DevConnect

document.xls Page 260

Application Overview DevConnect Partner Country

Solution Industry

E911

Appl

icat

ion

Suit

e

Atte

ndan

t Co

nsol

e

Billi

ng

Call

Acco

unti

ng

Call

Cont

rol-R

outi

ng

Call/

Cont

act

Cent

er

Conf

eren

cing

Com

mun

icat

ions

Con

tinu

ity

Corp

orat

e H

otel

ing

CRM

Cust

om A

pplic

atio

n D

evel

opm

ent

Dat

a Re

port

ing/

War

ehou

sing

Fax

Serv

er

Hel

p D

esk

Infr

astr

uctu

re

Infr

astr

uctu

re M

anag

emen

t

Man

aged

Ser

vice

s

Mes

sagi

ng

Mob

ility

Mul

ti-m

edia

Con

tact

Cen

ter

Mul

ti-v

endo

r In

tegr

atio

n

Prop

erty

Man

agem

ent

Qua

lity

Mon

itor

ing/

Man

agem

ent

Reco

rdin

g Vo

ice-

Dig

ital

Scre

en P

op

SIP

Endp

oint

s

SIP

Trun

ks

Secu

rity

Spee

ch R

ecog

niti

on

Serv

ice

Prov

ider

Acc

ess

Trun

king

Uni

fied

Com

mun

icat

ions

/fax

ser

vers

Uni

fied

Mes

sagi

ng

Voic

e M

ail-U

nifie

d M

assa

ging

Wal

l Boa

rds

Wor

kfor

ce M

anag

emen

t

Bank

ing

Fina

nce

Gov

ernm

ent-

Fede

ral

Gov

ernm

ent-

Stat

e &

Loc

al

Hea

lthc

are

Hig

her

Educ

atio

n

Hos

pita

lity

Insu

ranc

e

Lega

l

Man

ufac

turi

ng

Reta

il

Tele

com

mun

icat

ions

Tran

spor

tati

on

Uti

litie

s

√ √ √ √ √

√ √ √ √

√ √ √ √

√ √ √ √ √ √

√ √ √ √ √

√ √ √ √ √ √

√ √ √

Proteus for IP OfficeProteus is an intelligent communications management software application that provides the user information on the usage and costs of their telecommunications system. Proteus also monitors and reports on email, internet and mobile communication and can alert the user to certain call patterns and fraudulent activity.

Proteus for IP Office333 North Alabama Street

Suite 240Indianapolis, IN 46204

United States 317-262-4636

FAX 317-262-4849 www.ctigroup.com

United States

Call Finder (IPO)The CallFinder DID-to-analog adapter allows a non-DID enabled PBX or key telephone system to support analog DID services through standard analog station or CO port connections. It enables the phone system to directly route incoming calls to end-user extensions. The CallFinder DID-to-analog adapter has two DID ports and two programmable FXS/FXO ports and offers a web interface for system configuration and management.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc.2205 Woodale Drive

Mounds View, MN 55112United States

888-288-5470 FAX 763-785-9874

www.multitech.com

United States

Sip Trunks-Avaya IP OfficeClub Supplies managed SIP trunks to both avaya voice platforms. The service allows the reseller/dealer to deliver an increased connectivity service level at a reduced cost to the end user whilst maintaing the features and benefits of ISDN

Club CommunicationsChestnut House

BowbridgeStroud, GLOS GL5 2LA

United Kingdom 01453760240

www.club-comms.co.uk

United Kingdom

e-IVR Expanded (IP Office 3.1)The e-IVR Expanded configuration builds on the Application Portal (the development platform that runs VXML, IVR, Fax, CTI and Web applications) and features an impressive suite of value-added self-service applications. These Enterprise Class applications are Speech Recognition enabled and include strong Data Locator and Form Filler capabilities, Fax-On-Demand, an extension manager Name Dialer, inbound and outbound Call Recording, as well as Web based applications.

Computer Instruments9901 West 87th Street

Overland Park, KS 66212United States

1-888-451-0851FAX 913-492-1483

www.instruments.com

United States

e-IVR Premium (IP Office 3.1)This software bundle includes voice enabled automated attendant, name dialer, audio bulletin board, fax-on-demand, survey form filler, data locator, and unified messaging. In addition to these telephony solutions the suite features enhanced contact center applications such as estimated wait time, position in queue and dynamic announcements. Also included in this offer are IP Web phone applications for 911 dial alert and internal broadcast paging and drivers to provide CTI (screen pop) functionality. Several stand alone self-service Web applications are included – CallMeBackNow!, FaxMeBackNow!, Web forms and Web locators. Supported development environments are VXML 2.1, Visual Basic, C++, .Net (Expandable from 1 to 384 RTU port licenses per sever).

Computer Instruments9901 West 87th Street

Overland Park, KS 66212United States

1-888-451-0851FAX 913-492-1483

www.instruments.com

United States

Zeacom Communications Center 5.0 (IP Office)Zeacom delivers Unified Communications (UC) solutions, by seamlessly unifying telephony and computer applications into high-end functionality such as Rich Presence, Intelligent Mobility and Conferencing. Zeacom has rolled out its solutions to some 2500 organizations worldwide. A Zeacom solution is extremely cost-effective as it runs on one server, providing a single user application and one administrative interface; delivering advanced UC functionality to businesses with up to 2500 desktops.

Zeacom18022 CowanSuite #110

Irvine, CA 92614United States

800-513-9002FAX 949-252-0469 www.zeacom.com

United States

Zeacom Contact Center makes decisions about when, and to whom, calls should be delivered based upon caller profile, agent skills, time of day, number dialed and wait times. Zeacom Contact Center also provides real-time and historical statistics, advises callers of their place in queue and offers Interactive Voice Response (IVR) functions. It also includes voicemail and auto attendant capabilities.

Zeacom18022 CowanSuite #110

Irvine, CA 92614United States

800-513-9002FAX 949-252-0469 www.zeacom.com

United States

43. IP Office DevConnect

document.xls Page 261

Application Overview DevConnect Partner Country

Solution Industry

E911

Appl

icat

ion

Suit

e

Atte

ndan

t Co

nsol

e

Billi

ng

Call

Acco

unti

ng

Call

Cont

rol-R

outi

ng

Call/

Cont

act

Cent

er

Conf

eren

cing

Com

mun

icat

ions

Con

tinu

ity

Corp

orat

e H

otel

ing

CRM

Cust

om A

pplic

atio

n D

evel

opm

ent

Dat

a Re

port

ing/

War

ehou

sing

Fax

Serv

er

Hel

p D

esk

Infr

astr

uctu

re

Infr

astr

uctu

re M

anag

emen

t

Man

aged

Ser

vice

s

Mes

sagi

ng

Mob

ility

Mul

ti-m

edia

Con

tact

Cen

ter

Mul

ti-v

endo

r In

tegr

atio

n

Prop

erty

Man

agem

ent

Qua

lity

Mon

itor

ing/

Man

agem

ent

Reco

rdin

g Vo

ice-

Dig

ital

Scre

en P

op

SIP

Endp

oint

s

SIP

Trun

ks

Secu

rity

Spee

ch R

ecog

niti

on

Serv

ice

Prov

ider

Acc

ess

Trun

king

Uni

fied

Com

mun

icat

ions

/fax

ser

vers

Uni

fied

Mes

sagi

ng

Voic

e M

ail-U

nifie

d M

assa

ging

Wal

l Boa

rds

Wor

kfor

ce M

anag

emen

t

Bank

ing

Fina

nce

Gov

ernm

ent-

Fede

ral

Gov

ernm

ent-

Stat

e &

Loc

al

Hea

lthc

are

Hig

her

Educ

atio

n

Hos

pita

lity

Insu

ranc

e

Lega

l

Man

ufac

turi

ng

Reta

il

Tele

com

mun

icat

ions

Tran

spor

tati

on

Uti

litie

s

√ √ √

√ √ √ √ √ √

√ √ √ √

√ √ √ √

CallMedia (for IPO)Callmedia's software product suite handles inbound and outbound multi-media channels to receive and manage calls, emails, faxes and SMS messages from customers while simultaneously enabling users to pro-actively contact customers and prospects. By blending all these different media types and contact methods across all company agents, Callmedia enables better and more balanced levels of customer service and ensures high staff utilization by automatically reacting to changes in demand levels. By integrating fully with a client's line of business applications, Callmedia integrates fully with business applications so as to improve contact center performance.

Callmedia Ltd.6 Manor Court

Barnes Wallis RoadFareham, Hampshire PO15 5TH

United Kingdom +44 (0) 1489 553553

FAX +44 (0) 1489 553554 www.callmedia.uk.com

United Kingdom

e-IVR Application Portal (IP Office 3.1)The software bundle includes an automated attendant, audio bulletin board, fax-on-demand, survey form filler, and a data locator. In addition to these telephony solutions the suite features enhanced call center applications such as dynamic announcements for callers in queue. Also included in the bundle are the drivers to provide CTI screen pop functionality. Several stand-alone self-service Web applications are included – CallMeBackNow!, FaxMeBackNow!, web forms andweb locators (Expandable from 1 to 384 RTU port licenses per server).

Computer Instruments9901 West 87th Street

Overland Park, KS 66212United States

1-888-451-0851FAX 913-492-1483

www.instruments.com

United States

Avaya IP Office SIP Trunk with AT&T IP Flexible Reach and Business in a Box

This document provides a configuration guide to assist administrators in connecting Avaya IP Office SIP with SIP

trunk connections to AT&T Flexible Reach and AT&T Business in a Box. AT&T IP Flexible Reach is a managed

Voice over IP communication solution that supports inbound and outbound calling on your data network giving

you local, U.S. long distance and international reach for your U.S. sites. IP Office is a highly modular IP telephone

system designed to meet the needs of home offices, standalone businesses, and networked branch and head

offices for small and medium enterprises. The award-winning IP Office gives growing companies a complete

solution for telephony, messaging, networking, conferencing, customer management, and unified

communications. The combined solution leverages the power of AT&T IP Flexible Reach SIP network services with AVAYA IP Office to provide small and medium businesses a

converged communications solution that can help businesses reduce costs, increase productivity, and

improve customer service.

AT&T55 Corporate Dr.

Bridgewater, NJ 07869United States908-658-2123908-658-2449

arrow www.att.com

United States

Avaya IP Office SIP Trunk with AT&T IP Flexible Reach and Business in a Box

This document provides a configuration guide to assist administrators in connecting Avaya IP Office SIP with SIP

trunk connections to AT&T Flexible Reach and AT&T Business in a Box. AT&T IP Flexible Reach is a managed

Voice over IP communication solution that supports inbound and outbound calling on your data network giving

you local, U.S. long distance and international reach for your U.S. sites. IP Office is a highly modular IP telephone

system designed to meet the needs of home offices, standalone businesses, and networked branch and head

offices for small and medium enterprises. The award-winning IP Office gives growing companies a complete

solution for telephony, messaging, networking, conferencing, customer management, and unified

communications. The combined solution leverages the power of AT&T IP Flexible Reach SIP network services with AVAYA IP Office to provide small and medium businesses a

converged communications solution that can help businesses reduce costs, increase productivity, and

improve customer service.

AT&T55 Corporate Dr.

Bridgewater, NJ 07869United States908-658-2123908-658-2449

arrow www.att.com

United States

43. IP Office DevConnect

document.xls Page 262

Application Overview DevConnect Partner Country

Solution Industry

E911

Appl

icat

ion

Suit

e

Atte

ndan

t Co

nsol

e

Billi

ng

Call

Acco

unti

ng

Call

Cont

rol-R

outi

ng

Call/

Cont

act

Cent

er

Conf

eren

cing

Com

mun

icat

ions

Con

tinu

ity

Corp

orat

e H

otel

ing

CRM

Cust

om A

pplic

atio

n D

evel

opm

ent

Dat

a Re

port

ing/

War

ehou

sing

Fax

Serv

er

Hel

p D

esk

Infr

astr

uctu

re

Infr

astr

uctu

re M

anag

emen

t

Man

aged

Ser

vice

s

Mes

sagi

ng

Mob

ility

Mul

ti-m

edia

Con

tact

Cen

ter

Mul

ti-v

endo

r In

tegr

atio

n

Prop

erty

Man

agem

ent

Qua

lity

Mon

itor

ing/

Man

agem

ent

Reco

rdin

g Vo

ice-

Dig

ital

Scre

en P

op

SIP

Endp

oint

s

SIP

Trun

ks

Secu

rity

Spee

ch R

ecog

niti

on

Serv

ice

Prov

ider

Acc

ess

Trun

king

Uni

fied

Com

mun

icat

ions

/fax

ser

vers

Uni

fied

Mes

sagi

ng

Voic

e M

ail-U

nifie

d M

assa

ging

Wal

l Boa

rds

Wor

kfor

ce M

anag

emen

t

Bank

ing

Fina

nce

Gov

ernm

ent-

Fede

ral

Gov

ernm

ent-

Stat

e &

Loc

al

Hea

lthc

are

Hig

her

Educ

atio

n

Hos

pita

lity

Insu

ranc

e

Lega

l

Man

ufac

turi

ng

Reta

il

Tele

com

mun

icat

ions

Tran

spor

tati

on

Uti

litie

s

Switzerland

√ √ √ √ √ √

Switzerland

√ √ √ √ √ √

Switzerland

√ √ √ √ √ √

√ √ √ √ √

NovaAlert(IPO) using H.323With NovaAlert you can process information from a variety of extraneous systems in order to then alert or inform the responsible people in a targeted fashion. In this respect the NovaAlert system already supports many different. The information and events that are signalled via the various input interfaces to the server can be subsequently distributed via existing output interfaces (information paths). In this way the NovaAlert alerting server helps you to reach and inform the responsible people at the right time. By means of this rapid and reliable distribution of information NovaAlert can optimise your reaction time in an emergency (alert) and contribute to avoiding major damage and the associated costs. The NovaAlert system is modular in structure, which enables it to be incorporated into both smaller and very large projects. This modularity also provides optimum value for money.

NovaLink GmbHBusiness Tower

Zuercherstrasse 310Frauenfeld, 8500

Switzerland +41 52 762 66 66

FAX +41 52 762 66 99 www.novalink.ch

NovaMail(IPO) using S0 and PRI/QSIGWith NovaMail your customers can reach you by telephone at any time, and you can serve them by means of the quickest route. This increases your customers' satisfaction and reduces your employees' workload. You are currently busy or in transit and consequently you cannot take your customer's call in person. In such cases NovaMail undertakes this task, and with your personal and individual outgoing messages the customers discovers whether you are present or not. By means of the individual voice message the customer can decide whether he or she wishes to be connected to a representative or will leave you a message. If there is a message for you, you will be informed of this via a variety of routes. By means of the integration in your IT environment you will receive an email as soon as a voice message is present, or, for example, have an SMS sent to you. Listen to the message remotely or at your workplace and decide immediately what to do with it. Forward the message to a colleague for processing or deal with it yourself by calling back.

NovaLink GmbHBusiness Tower

Zuercherstrasse 310Frauenfeld, 8500

Switzerland +41 52 762 66 66

FAX +41 52 762 66 99 www.novalink.ch

NovaMail(IPO) using H.323With NovaMail your customers can reach you by telephone at any time, and you can serve them by means of the quickest route. This increases your customers' satisfaction and reduces your employees' workload. You are currently busy or in transit and consequently you cannot take your customer's call in person. In such cases NovaMail undertakes this task, and with your personal and individual outgoing messages the customers discovers whether you are present or not. By means of the individual voice message the customer can decide whether he or she wishes to be connected to a representative or will leave you a message. If there is a message for you, you will be informed of this via a variety of routes. By means of the integration in your IT environment you will receive an email as soon as a voice message is present, or, for example, have an SMS sent to you. Listen to the message remotely or at your workplace and decide immediately what to do with it. Forward the message to a colleague for processing or deal with it yourself by calling back.

NovaLink GmbHBusiness Tower

Zuercherstrasse 310Frauenfeld, 8500

Switzerland +41 52 762 66 66

FAX +41 52 762 66 99 www.novalink.ch

Fast Iron, Software version 4.2 - with IP OfficeInteroperability compliance of a converged VoIP and Data network solution using Brocade FastIron Switches along with Avaya IP Office and Avaya IP Telephones. Compliance testing emphasis was placed on verifying voice quality in a converged VoIP and Data network scenario. QoS based on Layer 2 Priority and Layer 3 Differentiated Services will be implemented across the network to prioritize voice traffic over the LAN. Compliance testing includes throughput, link aggregation, rapid spanning tree, load balancing, OSPF, Direct Media and codec’s G.711 and G.729

Brocade1745 Technology Drive

San Jose, CA 95110United States

(408) 207-1333FAX (408) 586 1900 www.brocade.com

United States

43. IP Office DevConnect

document.xls Page 263

Application Overview DevConnect Partner Country

Solution Industry

E911

Appl

icat

ion

Suit

e

Atte

ndan

t Co

nsol

e

Billi

ng

Call

Acco

unti

ng

Call

Cont

rol-R

outi

ng

Call/

Cont

act

Cent

er

Conf

eren

cing

Com

mun

icat

ions

Con

tinu

ity

Corp

orat

e H

otel

ing

CRM

Cust

om A

pplic

atio

n D

evel

opm

ent

Dat

a Re

port

ing/

War

ehou

sing

Fax

Serv

er

Hel

p D

esk

Infr

astr

uctu

re

Infr

astr

uctu

re M

anag

emen

t

Man

aged

Ser

vice

s

Mes

sagi

ng

Mob

ility

Mul

ti-m

edia

Con

tact

Cen

ter

Mul

ti-v

endo

r In

tegr

atio

n

Prop

erty

Man

agem

ent

Qua

lity

Mon

itor

ing/

Man

agem

ent

Reco

rdin

g Vo

ice-

Dig

ital

Scre

en P

op

SIP

Endp

oint

s

SIP

Trun

ks

Secu

rity

Spee

ch R

ecog

niti

on

Serv

ice

Prov

ider

Acc

ess

Trun

king

Uni

fied

Com

mun

icat

ions

/fax

ser

vers

Uni

fied

Mes

sagi

ng

Voic

e M

ail-U

nifie

d M

assa

ging

Wal

l Boa

rds

Wor

kfor

ce M

anag

emen

t

Bank

ing

Fina

nce

Gov

ernm

ent-

Fede

ral

Gov

ernm

ent-

Stat

e &

Loc

al

Hea

lthc

are

Hig

her

Educ

atio

n

Hos

pita

lity

Insu

ranc

e

Lega

l

Man

ufac

turi

ng

Reta

il

Tele

com

mun

icat

ions

Tran

spor

tati

on

Uti

litie

s

√ √ √ √

√ √ √ √ √ √

√ √

Broadvox Go SIP Trunking (NextPoint)GO! SIP Trunking is a VoIP/SIP Trunking service that includes unlimited local and long distance calling, discounted international and toll-free, DIDs, E911, local number porting and enhanced local numbers for remote offices and telecommuting workers. Business continuity and dynamic load balancing is available. Broadband connectivity includes DSL, T1 and DS3.

Broadvox, LLC1950 N. Stemmons Hwy, Suite 3031

Dallas, TX 75207United States 214 646 8000

FAX 216 373 4876 www.broadvox.com

United States

telephony applications serversDAX Systems Tower, 2U and 4U servers provide businesses with a cost-effective and highly reliable platform for IP telephony applications. The servers now are compliance-tested by Avaya for compatibility with Avaya IP Office, a secure, easy-to-use converged voice and data system for small and mid-sized businesses. The tower chassis features a 3 GHz processor, up to 4 GB DDR II memory, up to 3 hot-swap RAID drives with removable carriers and 3 full-length expansion slots. It includes an internal PCI fax/modem and a 430 watt power supply. The 2U platform is a 24-port rack-mountable server with a 2.8 GHz processor, up to 8 GB DDR II memory, up to 6 hot-swap RAID drives and 2 full-length expansion slots. It includes an internal PCI fax/modem and dual 500 watt hot-swap power supplies. The 4U platform is a 48-port rack-mountable server with a 3.6 GHz processor, up to 8 GB DDR II, up to 8 hot-swap RAID drives and 5 full-length expansion slots. It includes dual 800 watt hot-swap power supplies

DAX Systems, Inc.343 New Road

Parsippany, NJ 07054United States

973-227-8111FAX 973-227-8197

www.daxsystems.com

United States

CA Business Protection SuiteThe CA Business Protection Suite for Microsoft Small Business Server Standard Edition provides total data protection for your business by combining CA's award-winning data security, storage and desktop migration technologies into a comprehensive solution that protects your critical IT assets, while reducing risk, system downtime and IT management costs. Uniquely designed to strengthen and simplify small- and medium-sized businesses IT environments, it provides a single installation process and a fully integrated, desktop-based management console that centralizes and simplifies security, storage and data migration. This cost-effective, easy-to-manage solution will help ensure your IT assets are secure and available, enabling you to focus on those more strategic issues like running and growing your business.

CA100 Staples Dr.

Framingham, MA 01702United States

508 628-8000FAX 508-820-4361

www.ca.com

United States

ReliaTel fault and performance management application (IP Office)ReliaTel comprehensively monitors and manages diverse voice and data networks across multi-vendor TDM, IP Telephony and Unified Communications networks and expands this reach into SMB market segments that have installed IP Office. Using ReliaTel, Channel Partners can leverage a single cost-effective solution to manage the entire voice environment, and significantly lower annual voice network maintenance costs with no additional staff, infrastructure upgrades, or major hardware purchases. And, ReliaTel fits seamlessly into all network environments, with extensive connectivity options, agent-less monitoring and automated management that reduce administration and maintenance overhead. Plus, using ReliaTel's optional analysis and reporting facility, you'll have the operational statistics, traffic, and performance reports you need to identify bottlenecks and maintenance issues that negatively impact your service levels. You'll also get the critical insight you need to plan preventative maintenance and upgrades that may eliminate costly repairs or service outages.

Tone Software Corporation1735 South Brookhurst St.

Anaheim, CA 92804United States

800 833-8663FAX 714 991-1831 www.tonesoft.com

United States

DV 2000 (IP Office 4.0.61103)DuVoice DV4 and DV2000 provide voice mail and automated attendant for hospitality applications on Avaya IP Office Solution. DV4 and DV2000 interface with most popular Property Management Systems (PMS) and use the TAPI link to the Avaya IP Office to provide a middleware solution between the Avaya IP Office and the PMS. InnDesk provides a web enabled guest management tool for multiple hotel staff memebers.

DuVoice608 State Street South

Suite 100Kirkland, WA 98033

United States 800-888-1057

FAX 425-889-8799 www.duvoice.com

United States

43. IP Office DevConnect

document.xls Page 264

Application Overview DevConnect Partner Country

Solution Industry

E911

Appl

icat

ion

Suit

e

Atte

ndan

t Co

nsol

e

Billi

ng

Call

Acco

unti

ng

Call

Cont

rol-R

outi

ng

Call/

Cont

act

Cent

er

Conf

eren

cing

Com

mun

icat

ions

Con

tinu

ity

Corp

orat

e H

otel

ing

CRM

Cust

om A

pplic

atio

n D

evel

opm

ent

Dat

a Re

port

ing/

War

ehou

sing

Fax

Serv

er

Hel

p D

esk

Infr

astr

uctu

re

Infr

astr

uctu

re M

anag

emen

t

Man

aged

Ser

vice

s

Mes

sagi

ng

Mob

ility

Mul

ti-m

edia

Con

tact

Cen

ter

Mul

ti-v

endo

r In

tegr

atio

n

Prop

erty

Man

agem

ent

Qua

lity

Mon

itor

ing/

Man

agem

ent

Reco

rdin

g Vo

ice-

Dig

ital

Scre

en P

op

SIP

Endp

oint

s

SIP

Trun

ks

Secu

rity

Spee

ch R

ecog

niti

on

Serv

ice

Prov

ider

Acc

ess

Trun

king

Uni

fied

Com

mun

icat

ions

/fax

ser

vers

Uni

fied

Mes

sagi

ng

Voic

e M

ail-U

nifie

d M

assa

ging

Wal

l Boa

rds

Wor

kfor

ce M

anag

emen

t

Bank

ing

Fina

nce

Gov

ernm

ent-

Fede

ral

Gov

ernm

ent-

Stat

e &

Loc

al

Hea

lthc

are

Hig

her

Educ

atio

n

Hos

pita

lity

Insu

ranc

e

Lega

l

Man

ufac

turi

ng

Reta

il

Tele

com

mun

icat

ions

Tran

spor

tati

on

Uti

litie

s

Canada

√ √ √ √

Canada

√ √ √ √ √ √

√ √ √ √

√ √ √ √

√ √ √ √

Canada

√ √ √ √

Sweden

√ √ √

√ √ √ √

CallAttendant Office TAPI WAVE integrationObjectworld's award-winning CallAttendant Office delivers a feature-rich unified communications application, including features such as call-flow management, unified messaging for Microsoft Exchange, Lotus Domino and IMAP4 servers, database IVR, fax server, text-to-speech, and more

ObjectWorld Inc./ADTRAN308 Legget Drive

Ottawa, Ontario K2K1Y6Canada

613-599-9698FAX 613-599-7457

www.objectworld.com Telephony Office-LinX Voice Mail, Automated Attendant, and Speech Enabled AAThe esnatech SIP based application server provides businesses with a real-time communication suite. Through features such as multilingual speech-enabled auto attendant, Unified messaging, text-to-speech, fax server and intelligent mobility to any wireless device. It unifies Presence management, Messaging, and mobility into one unifed communication solution for small to mid size enterprises.

Esna Technologies Inc.30 West Beaver Creek

Suite 101Richmond Hill, Ontario L4B 3K1

Canada 905-707-9700

FAX 905-707-9170 www.esnatech.com

PICKUP Screen Pop for IP OfficePICKUP is a CTI middleware that allows features such as CALLER ID screen pops to be integrated into any end user application in most computer environments. The solution provides improved customer service by automating customer lookup based upon CALLER ID. Additionally PICKUP can provide 911 alerting and notification via the LAN or WAN tomultiple locations for Avaya IP Office. TCDIAL offers data-scrape dialing capability for any application via the TAPI Light Link in IP Office. This includes custom databases and browser based applications.

Telcomp, IncP.O. Drawer 2065Apopka, FL 32704

United States 407-889-7377

FAX 407-880-2543 www.telcomp.com

United States

VoIP VPN using Edgemarc 4500 Series (IPO)The EdgeMarc 4500 Series combines multiple voice and data features into a single, easy to use converged networking router. It includes models that have up to 4 T1 WAN interfaces or a single ethernet WAN, a 4 port managed VLAN switch, call quality probe optional 802.11 Wireless Access Point and optional integrated analog phone and line ports. Designed for SOHO and small to medium enterprise deployment the 4500 Series contains models that support 2, 5, 10 or 30 concurrent WAN VoIP calls.

Edgewater Networks2895 Northwestern Parkway

Santa Clara, CA 95051United States 408 351 7200

FAX 408.727.6430 www.edgewaternetworks.com

United States

Multi Tech Fax serverWith the FaxFinder® fax server, users can receive faxes as emails and send from any application that can print. It even delivers faxes over a Wide Area Network WAN) to the desktop of remote offices and field sales people. The FaxFinder connects directly to an Avaya IP Office system or Partner ACS.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc.2205 Woodale Drive

Mounds View, MN 55112United States

888-288-5470FAX 763-785-9874

www.multitech.com

United States

UC Server Standard Edition (TAPI/Analog) with Centralized VoicemailObjectworld's award-winning CallAttendant Office delivers a feature-rich unified communications application, including features such as call-flow management, unified messaging for Microsoft Exchange, Lotus Domino and IMAP4 servers, database IVR, fax server, text-to-speech, and more.

ObjectWorld Inc./ADTRAN308 Legget Drive

Ottawa, Ontario K2K1Y6Canada

613-599-9698FAX 613-599-7457

www.objectworld.com

Konftel 300 for IP OfficeKonftel 300 The Conference phone is high end and well suited for large and medium conference rooms. The product has some unique new features such as: - Conference Guide - Call recording to SD card - Wideband 7kHz - Line selection with 3 combined line interfaces: Analog, USB (for Softphones) and connection to Mobile phones like ie. Nokia Smart Phone N95.

KONFTELDoebelnsgatan 19

Box 268Umea, S-90330

Sweden +46-90706470

FAX +46-90131435 www.konftel.com

Telephonetics IP based audio servicesTelephonetics IP-based Audio Services Compliant with ï?ºï€ Avaya IP Office Solution. Telephonetics IP Message Management Application is a turnkey system to create, load and manage voice prompts or messages in Avaya Voicemail Pro. Its Web interface allows customers to easily create new prompts or scripts. This proprietary CRM application enables Telephonetics to remotely load and change multiple messages over the Internet and track the message changes cost effectively.

Telephonetics Inc.2841 Corporate WayMiramar, FL 33029

United States 800-446-5366

FAX 954.556.5990 avaya.telephonetics.com

United States

43. IP Office DevConnect

document.xls Page 265

Application Overview DevConnect Partner Country

Solution Industry

E911

Appl

icat

ion

Suit

e

Atte

ndan

t Co

nsol

e

Billi

ng

Call

Acco

unti

ng

Call

Cont

rol-R

outi

ng

Call/

Cont

act

Cent

er

Conf

eren

cing

Com

mun

icat

ions

Con

tinu

ity

Corp

orat

e H

otel

ing

CRM

Cust

om A

pplic

atio

n D

evel

opm

ent

Dat

a Re

port

ing/

War

ehou

sing

Fax

Serv

er

Hel

p D

esk

Infr

astr

uctu

re

Infr

astr

uctu

re M

anag

emen

t

Man

aged

Ser

vice

s

Mes

sagi

ng

Mob

ility

Mul

ti-m

edia

Con

tact

Cen

ter

Mul

ti-v

endo

r In

tegr

atio

n

Prop

erty

Man

agem

ent

Qua

lity

Mon

itor

ing/

Man

agem

ent

Reco

rdin

g Vo

ice-

Dig

ital

Scre

en P

op

SIP

Endp

oint

s

SIP

Trun

ks

Secu

rity

Spee

ch R

ecog

niti

on

Serv

ice

Prov

ider

Acc

ess

Trun

king

Uni

fied

Com

mun

icat

ions

/fax

ser

vers

Uni

fied

Mes

sagi

ng

Voic

e M

ail-U

nifie

d M

assa

ging

Wal

l Boa

rds

Wor

kfor

ce M

anag

emen

t

Bank

ing

Fina

nce

Gov

ernm

ent-

Fede

ral

Gov

ernm

ent-

Stat

e &

Loc

al

Hea

lthc

are

Hig

her

Educ

atio

n

Hos

pita

lity

Insu

ranc

e

Lega

l

Man

ufac

turi

ng

Reta

il

Tele

com

mun

icat

ions

Tran

spor

tati

on

Uti

litie

s

√ √ √ √

Canada

√ √

Switzerland

√ √ √

Canada

√ √

√ √ √ √

√ √ √

Syntelate (on IPO)SynTelate is customer interaction management software that enables line of business managers to create intuitive customer dialogs that enhance agent effectiveness and provide consistent customer experiences through an icon based GUI interface that requires no programing experience on the part of the designer. synTelate addresses requirements such as scripting,callflow,workflow,and integration with exsisting databases and applications. White Paper avaiable on request.

synTelate Corp.3rd Floor Granite House

31 Stockwell StreetGLASGOW, Scotland G1 4RZ

United Kingdom +44 141 552 8800

FAX +44 141 553 1894 www.syntelate.com

United Kingdom

CallAttendant Office acting as centralized voicemailObjectworld's award-winning CallAttendant Office delivers a feature-rich unified communications application, including features such as call-flow management, unified messaging for Microsoft Exchange, Lotus Domino and IMAP4 servers, database IVR, fax server, text-to-speech, and more.

ObjectWorld Inc./ADTRAN308 Legget Drive

Ottawa, Ontario K2K1Y6Canada

613-599-9698 FAX 613-599-7457

www.objectworld.com

NovaConf (IPO) using using S0 and PRI/QSIG, H.323/QSIG, or SIPNovaConf is a conference system, offerig a variety of scheduling options: Dial In, Dial Out, Ad Hoc. A link to Microsoft Outlook and a WebClient are available.

NovaLink GmbHBusiness Tower

Zuercherstrasse 310Frauenfeld, 8500

Switzerland +41 52 762 66 66

FAX +41 52 762 66 99 www.novalink.ch

Phybridge UniPhyer

Phybridge provides companies a choice when deploying VoIP to utilize their existing telephony wiring instead of upgrading their LAN. The Phybridge UniPhyer solution

enables all IP PBX providers a non-disruptive plug and play installation on CAT3 wiring with significantly lower costs than traditional deployments. This methodology offers guaranteed QOS with POE all over a single twisted pair

resulting in less complexity, cost and time requirements.

Phybridge Inc.3495 Laird Rd

Unit 12Mississauga, Ontario L5L 5S5

Canada90590136339055698984

arrow www.phybridge.com

IP Office ContactStore

IP Office ContactStore allows you to acquire more value from telephony contacts by complementing the voice

recording capabilities of Avaya VoiceMail Pro. With IP Office ContactStore, authorized users across the enterprise with

minimal investment in training can use this intuitive browser-based application to retrieve calls based on search

filters including start date/time, duration of call, name of the party calling, and the target or dialed number. IP Office ContactStore is sold exclusively by Avaya and its business

partners.

Verint330 South Service Road

Melville, NY 11747United States

1-800-4-VERINT1-800-483-7468

arrow www.verint.com

United States

vTechnologies vCTISuite is an easy to use Contact Center Automation Tool that integrates IP Office, CRM

applications and Contact Center applications. vCTISuite is a synergistic application suite that acts as a “glue” to

decrease Agent Time per Call by increasing access to Caller Information as well allowing On-Demand

modification to the Call Routing List. In other words, vCTISuite presents Caller information to Contact Center Agents as the Caller is routed to the Agent’s extension. vCTISuite also automates such time consuming tasks as Call Tracking and Outbound Calling as well as offering a

secure Notepad feature for Supervisors.

vTechnologies http://www.vtechnet.com/

vTechnologies Technical Support at: • Phone: 800-782-6171

• E-mail: [email protected]

United States

OAISYS NetSuite is a business productivity software suite designed for small and mediumsizedcompanies. OAISYS NetSuite features include trunk side call recording, intelligent callrouting using ANI and DNIS and a desktop phone application to allow users to make, receiveand manage calls on their existing telephone.

Oaisys7965 S. Priest

Suite 105Tempe, AZ 85284

United States480-496-9040480-496-9015

arrow www.oaisys.com

United States

iQ NetSolutions VistaPoint Enterprise is a complete client/server suite of computer telephony applications providing desktop call control for users.

Sales Office: 1-209-245-5500 x1103e-mail: [email protected]

Support: 1-209-245-5500 x1401e-mail: [email protected]

http://www.iqnsi.com/

United States

43. IP Office DevConnect

document.xls Page 266

Application Overview DevConnect Partner Country

Solution Industry

E911

Appl

icat

ion

Suit

e

Atte

ndan

t Co

nsol

e

Billi

ng

Call

Acco

unti

ng

Call

Cont

rol-R

outi

ng

Call/

Cont

act

Cent

er

Conf

eren

cing

Com

mun

icat

ions

Con

tinu

ity

Corp

orat

e H

otel

ing

CRM

Cust

om A

pplic

atio

n D

evel

opm

ent

Dat

a Re

port

ing/

War

ehou

sing

Fax

Serv

er

Hel

p D

esk

Infr

astr

uctu

re

Infr

astr

uctu

re M

anag

emen

t

Man

aged

Ser

vice

s

Mes

sagi

ng

Mob

ility

Mul

ti-m

edia

Con

tact

Cen

ter

Mul

ti-v

endo

r In

tegr

atio

n

Prop

erty

Man

agem

ent

Qua

lity

Mon

itor

ing/

Man

agem

ent

Reco

rdin

g Vo

ice-

Dig

ital

Scre

en P

op

SIP

Endp

oint

s

SIP

Trun

ks

Secu

rity

Spee

ch R

ecog

niti

on

Serv

ice

Prov

ider

Acc

ess

Trun

king

Uni

fied

Com

mun

icat

ions

/fax

ser

vers

Uni

fied

Mes

sagi

ng

Voic

e M

ail-U

nifie

d M

assa

ging

Wal

l Boa

rds

Wor

kfor

ce M

anag

emen

t

Bank

ing

Fina

nce

Gov

ernm

ent-

Fede

ral

Gov

ernm

ent-

Stat

e &

Loc

al

Hea

lthc

are

Hig

her

Educ

atio

n

Hos

pita

lity

Insu

ranc

e

Lega

l

Man

ufac

turi

ng

Reta

il

Tele

com

mun

icat

ions

Tran

spor

tati

on

Uti

litie

s

Sweden

√ √

France√ √

France

√ √ √ √

√ √

ClearOne Communication Chat 50 is a portable audio peripheral that connects to a wide variety of devices for hands-free communications and audio playback. A personal solution for road warriors and others who want rich full-duplex audio that is portable and economical.

www.clearone.comCustomer Support at (800) 945-7730 email to [email protected]

United States

Envox CT Connect is a Computer Telephony Integration (CTI) middleware platform that provides call control and monitoring functionality through various application programming interfaces to end user applications.

Envox/ Syntellecthttp://www.envox.com/software/envox-

ct-connect.aspAmericas +1 508 898 2600

[email protected] +44 1252 61 8888 [email protected]

Asia Pacific +65 6358 2241 [email protected]

United States

The SoLo Server runs on a Microsoft Server and enables users of telephones controlled by IP Office to use their mobile telephones in a cooperative manner with their desk telephones.

SoSoftware SARoute des Plaines-Du-Loup 321018 Lausanne (Switzerland)Phone + 41 (0)216437766

Fax + 41 (0)216437765

[email protected] CallRex is a packet-based VoIP call recording and monitoring solution designed specifically for small and medium-sized companies.

Technical support http://www.telrex.comTelrex Customer Support Center:

• Phone: (425) 827-6156• E-mail: [email protected]

United States

Trivium SonicView is a packet-based VoIP call recording solution that uses the events from Avaya IP Office to record calls for monitored users with Avaya IP Telephones.

TriVium(503) [email protected].

For sales support, call (877) 439-9338.United States

Infoblox DNSone module provides DHCP and TFTP services in an Avaya IP Office IP Telephony Infrastructure.

http://www.infoblox.com/support or • Phone: 888-463-6259 or 408-716-

4300, ext. 1 • E-mail: [email protected]

United States

Enterasys Dynamic Intrusion Response (DIR) is a Secure Networks Solution that detects abnormal behavior on the enterprise network, and then intervenes to quarantine the offending user or deviant device. Dynamic Intrusion Response isolates and categorizes security vulnerabilities, identifies the source and automatically reconfigures the network to mitigate the threat. The enterprise network can be protected against both known and undocumented security risks.

Enterasys Secure Networks Solutions, contact the Enterasys

Technical Support at 800-872-8440. Technical support email can be sent to

[email protected]. Additional information can be found in the Enterasys Support website at

http://www.enterasys.com/services/support.

United States

Imagine Soft Meteor SE with Avaya IP Office. Meteor SE is used in hospitality industries to assist with check in/check out and telephone usage authorization.

424, Rue Paradis 13008 Marseille - FRANCE - Tél. +33 (0)4 91 32 74 00 -

Fax. +33 (0)4 91 32 74 01 - [email protected]

Nova WEBHotel software suite is a PC-based application suite that provides an end user interfacewith Avaya IP Office in a Hospitality environment. The suite is able to manage one or severalAvaya IP Offices, and works as a web application to meet the requirements of hotels. It is widelyused in hotels in France.

SLIT31 rue de Cuire

LYON, France 69004France

+33472101650 www.slit.fr

Kirk IP600 Wireless Server is a wireless Digital Enhanced Cordless Telecommunications (DECT) solution capable of communicating standard H.323 with Avaya IP Office. The Kirk IP600 Wireless Server combines wireless DECT with H.323 IP telephony. Each Kirk IP600 Wireless Server can register up to thirty wireless DECT phones and handle up to six simultaneous calls. Only the following basic call features are supported: Place/Receive call, Hold and Transfer.

http://www.kirktelecom.com. United States

Skutch Electronics AS-801 Promotion on Hold Segregator. This solution is for customers who are using Key System operation with Analog Lines and want different messages played for different lines. The Skutch Electronics AS-801 Promotion on Hold Segregator uses the existing external Music on Hold connection on the Avaya IP Office to provide this capability.

http://www.skutchelectronics.com. United States

MultiTech MultiVOIP FX is a gateway that provides connectivity between legacy analog voice/fax endpoints and a VoIP infrastructure.

Phone: (763) 717-5863Web: https://support.multitech.com

United States

The emFAST FACSys Fax Messaging Suite is a fax family solution that uses the SIP trunk interface with T.38 fax from Avaya IP Office to send and receive fax.

Toll Free +1 (866) 436-3278Direct +1 (416) 283-8411Fax +1 (416) 208-6770

E-mail [email protected]

United States / Canada

43. IP Office DevConnect

document.xls Page 267

Application Overview DevConnect Partner Country

Solution Industry

E911

Appl

icat

ion

Suit

e

Atte

ndan

t Co

nsol

e

Billi

ng

Call

Acco

unti

ng

Call

Cont

rol-R

outi

ng

Call/

Cont

act

Cent

er

Conf

eren

cing

Com

mun

icat

ions

Con

tinu

ity

Corp

orat

e H

otel

ing

CRM

Cust

om A

pplic

atio

n D

evel

opm

ent

Dat

a Re

port

ing/

War

ehou

sing

Fax

Serv

er

Hel

p D

esk

Infr

astr

uctu

re

Infr

astr

uctu

re M

anag

emen

t

Man

aged

Ser

vice

s

Mes

sagi

ng

Mob

ility

Mul

ti-m

edia

Con

tact

Cen

ter

Mul

ti-v

endo

r In

tegr

atio

n

Prop

erty

Man

agem

ent

Qua

lity

Mon

itor

ing/

Man

agem

ent

Reco

rdin

g Vo

ice-

Dig

ital

Scre

en P

op

SIP

Endp

oint

s

SIP

Trun

ks

Secu

rity

Spee

ch R

ecog

niti

on

Serv

ice

Prov

ider

Acc

ess

Trun

king

Uni

fied

Com

mun

icat

ions

/fax

ser

vers

Uni

fied

Mes

sagi

ng

Voic

e M

ail-U

nifie

d M

assa

ging

Wal

l Boa

rds

Wor

kfor

ce M

anag

emen

t

Bank

ing

Fina

nce

Gov

ernm

ent-

Fede

ral

Gov

ernm

ent-

Stat

e &

Loc

al

Hea

lthc

are

Hig

her

Educ

atio

n

Hos

pita

lity

Insu

ranc

e

Lega

l

Man

ufac

turi

ng

Reta

il

Tele

com

mun

icat

ions

Tran

spor

tati

on

Uti

litie

s

√ √ √

Russia

(www.doro.com) √

(www.grandstream.com) √

(www.counterpath.com) √

www.innovaphone.com √

www.nokia.com √

√√

Voice Print Digital Voice Logger (DVL) is a call recording solution offering digital call recording, monitoring, and retrieval.

Voice: (805) 389-5201. email: [email protected]

United States

The iVoice Speech-Enabled Auto Attendant (SE-AA) is a stand-alone auto attendant that enables businesses to incorporate speech recognition into their current communication systems without duplicating voice mail applications.

(732) 441-7700 and dial x217 or say “Tech Support”

Email [email protected] States

VoxGrid Call Recording System is a voice activated general recording integrated device. This product enables the user to record telephone calls occurring at his/her extension for later review and retrieval.

http://www.voxgrid.comPhone: 973-220-1478

E-mail: [email protected] States

Braxtel Fluency Communicator IVR provides a wide range of customer interaction capabilities for the creation of dynamic, flexible IVR applications with an easy to use graphical call flow designer.

US (800) 589-2477EU [email protected]

United States and

Europe

DuVoice DV4/DV8/DV2000 system is a Windows XP-based hospitality messaging system that provides a hotel with messaging for three classes of service: guest, extended stay guest, and staff.

Voice: (425) 250-2393email: [email protected]

United States

LightNet Complex IPO InPhoneMachine is an application designed for the automated delivery of voice messages to a group of users in a minimal period of time without the need for a human operator to use Avaya IP Office to place notification calls to both internal and external users.

LightNet Complex Support at +7 (495) 2324848 or by sending e-mail to

[email protected].

Teledex SIP: Hotel phones:• LD4200: Large screen Hotel phone (Tested sample LD4210S)

Phone: (800) 794-8353Web: http://www.teledex.com

United States

Teledex iPhone SIP ND2000 Series and SIP NDC2000 are SIP-based IP telephones that integrate with Avaya IP Office as SIP endpoints.

Phone: (800) 794-8353Web: http://www.teledex.com

United States

Patton Single line ATA are SIP-based analog telephone adaptors that integrate with Avaya IP Office as SIP endpoints.

www.patton.com United States

DORO IP 810C are SIP-based Desktop telephones that integrate with Avaya IP Office as SIP endpoints.

United States

Grandstream GXP 2000 and GXP2020 are SIP-based Desktop telephones that integrate with Avaya IP Office as SIP endpoints.

United States

Polycom Soundpoint 320 and 601 are SIP-based IP Desktop phones that integrate with Avaya IP Office as SIP endpoints.

Phone: (978) 292-5000http://www.polycom.com/support/

index.htmlUnited States

Counterpath X-Lite and Eyebeam are SIP-based Softphones that integrate with Avaya IP Office as SIP endpoints.

United States

Innovaphone IP22 IP24 IP28 are SIP-based analog telephone adaptors that integrate with Avaya IP Office as SIP endpoints.

United States

Nokia SIP client is a SIP-based mobile phone client installed on Nokia smart phones that integrate with Avaya IP Office as SIP endpoints.

United States

Snom m3 IP DECT phone is a SIP-based cordless telephone that integrates with Avaya IP Office as a SIP endpoint.

Phone: (978) 998-7882Web: http://www.snom.com

United States

Teledex iPhone SIP LD4200 Series are SIP-based IP telephones that integrate with Avaya IP Office as SIP endpoints.

Phone: (800) 794-8353Web: http://www.teledex.com

United States

ClearOne MAX IP and MAXAttach IP are SIP-based VoIP tabletop conferencing phones that integrate with Avaya IP Office as SIP endpoints.

Phone: (800) 283-5936Email: [email protected]

United States

Polycom SoundStation IP 6000 and 7000 are SIP-based IP conference phones that integrate with Avaya IP Office as SIP endpoints.

Phone: (978) 292-5000Web:

http://www.polycom.com/support/index.html

United States

Snom 3x0 VoIP phones are SIP-based phones that integrate with Avaya IP Office as SIP endpoints.

Phone: (978) 998-7882Web: http://www.snom.com

United States

Snom 820 VoIP telephone is a SIP-based phone that integrates with Avaya IP Office as a SIP endpoint. Phone: (978) 998-7882

Web: http://www.snom.comUnited States

Snom MeetingPoint is a SIP-based conference telephone that integrates with Avaya IP Office as a SIP endpoint. Phone: (978) 998-7882

Web: http://www.snom.comUnited States

SIP Trunking Using Verizon Business IP Trunk SIP Trunk Service Offer Session Initiation Protocol (SIP) trunking between the Verizon Business IP Trunk SIP Trunk Service Offer and an Avaya IP Office solution.

Verizon Business Configurationhttp://www.verizonbusiness.com/us/

products/voip/trunking/.

43. IP Office DevConnect

document.xls Page 268

Application Overview DevConnect Partner Country

Solution Industry

E911

Appl

icat

ion

Suit

e

Atte

ndan

t Co

nsol

e

Billi

ng

Call

Acco

unti

ng

Call

Cont

rol-R

outi

ng

Call/

Cont

act

Cent

er

Conf

eren

cing

Com

mun

icat

ions

Con

tinu

ity

Corp

orat

e H

otel

ing

CRM

Cust

om A

pplic

atio

n D

evel

opm

ent

Dat

a Re

port

ing/

War

ehou

sing

Fax

Serv

er

Hel

p D

esk

Infr

astr

uctu

re

Infr

astr

uctu

re M

anag

emen

t

Man

aged

Ser

vice

s

Mes

sagi

ng

Mob

ility

Mul

ti-m

edia

Con

tact

Cen

ter

Mul

ti-v

endo

r In

tegr

atio

n

Prop

erty

Man

agem

ent

Qua

lity

Mon

itor

ing/

Man

agem

ent

Reco

rdin

g Vo

ice-

Dig

ital

Scre

en P

op

SIP

Endp

oint

s

SIP

Trun

ks

Secu

rity

Spee

ch R

ecog

niti

on

Serv

ice

Prov

ider

Acc

ess

Trun

king

Uni

fied

Com

mun

icat

ions

/fax

ser

vers

Uni

fied

Mes

sagi

ng

Voic

e M

ail-U

nifie

d M

assa

ging

Wal

l Boa

rds

Wor

kfor

ce M

anag

emen

t

Bank

ing

Fina

nce

Gov

ernm

ent-

Fede

ral

Gov

ernm

ent-

Stat

e &

Loc

al

Hea

lthc

are

Hig

her

Educ

atio

n

Hos

pita

lity

Insu

ranc

e

Lega

l

Man

ufac

turi

ng

Reta

il

Tele

com

mun

icat

ions

Tran

spor

tati

on

Uti

litie

s

www.windstream.com √

Plantronics Savi Office and Plantronics EHS APV-65 Adapter with Avaya 5400 and 5600 Series Telephones The Plantronics Savi Office is a wireless headset solution. In the compliance testing, Plantronics Savi Office used the Plantronics EHS APV-65 Adapter to provide wireless communications for Avaya 5400 and 5600 Series Telephones with Avaya IP Office.

Phone: (800) 544-4660, +1 (831) 426-5858

Web: http://www.plantronics.com/north_ameri

ca/en_US/support/

AdvaTel InTouch 2.0 with Avaya IP Office 6.1 AdvaTel InTouch is an add-in application for Microsoft Office Outlook which runs on the user's Windows-based PC and integrates IP Office call management and control with Outlook, MSN, Yahoo! and Skype. It enables the user to optimize communications by providing consolidated presence information and by presenting a variety of communication options such as voice, email, Short Message Service (SMS) and instant messaging.

Phone: +61 3 86958695Web: http://www.advatel.com.au/Email: [email protected]

Xima Chronicall Realtime Module with Avaya IP Office Xima Chronicall is a call reporting application, and the Realtime Module is an optional module that provides real-time user status. In the compliance testing, the Xima Chronicall Realtime Module used the TFTP service and System Monitor interface from Avaya IP Office to obtain initial and real-time user status to produce real-time user status reporting.

Phone: (888) 944-XIMAEmail: [email protected]

Web: http://www.ximasoftware.com/support

Xima Chronicall Recording Library Module with Avaya IP Office Using Voicemail Pro Xima Chronicall is a call reporting application, and the Recording Library Module is an optional module that provides the call recording wave files from Avaya IP Office Voicemail Pro via the Xima Chronicall web interface.

Phone: (888) 944-XIMAEmail: [email protected]

Web: http://www.ximasoftware.com/support

Xima Chronicall with Avaya IP Office Xima Chronicall is a call reporting application. In the compliance testing, Xima Chronicall used the TFTP service and System Monitor interface from Avaya IP Office to obtain configured system resources and call information to produce cradle to grave and call historical reporting.

Phone: (888) 944-XIMAEmail: [email protected]

Web: http://www.ximasoftware.com/support

Valcom PagePro IP with Avaya IP Office The Valcom PagePro IP is a SIP-based paging device that integrates with Avaya IP Office as SIP endpoints.

Phone: (800) VALCOM1Email: [email protected]

SIP Trunking Using Verizon Business IP Contact Center VoIP Inbound and Avaya IP Office Release 6.1 The Avaya IP Office solution consists of an Avaya IP Office 500 Release 6.1 Preferred Edition, Avaya Voicemail Pro, Avaya IP Office Softphone, and Avaya H.323, digital, and analog endpoints. The new configurable SIP capabilities of IP Office Release 6.1, such as support for SIP REFER, and support for DNS SRV for determining the Verizon SIP signaling parameters, are intentionally not used in this document. These new capabilities are not used so that the Verizon Business certification of IP Office Release 6 can apply to IP Office Release 6.1 as well.

http://marketingtools.avaya.com/knowledgebase/businesspartner/ipoffice/mergedProjects/manuals/appnotes/VZB-IPCC-IPOR61.pdf

Valcom Talkback IP Speakers with Avaya IP Office Using the Valcom Talkback IP Speaker devices with Avaya IP Office. Tested with the VIP-148L, VIP-160, VIP-172L, VIP-422 and VIP-431-DS.

Phone: (800) VALCOM1Email: [email protected]

Windstream SIP Trunking with Avaya IP Office Windstream SIP Trunking provides PSTN access via a SIP trunk between the enterprise and the Windstream network as an alternative to legacy analog or digital trunks. This approach generally results in lower cost for the enterprise.

Technicolor TB30 SIP PhonesThe Technicolor TB30 is a VoIP phone that can be used in both large and small enterprises. It features full duplex and high definition (HD) sound to deliver acoustic performance.

Telephone - Obtain the country specific hotline from here:

http://www.thomsonbroadbandpartner.com//telephony-solutions/support/contact-

us.phpE-mail - Submit a request for

assistance from here:http://

www.thomsonbroadbandpartner.com/telephony-solutions/thomson-telecom/

contact-us.php

43. IP Office DevConnect

document.xls Page 269

Application Overview DevConnect Partner Country

Solution Industry

E911

Appl

icat

ion

Suit

e

Atte

ndan

t Co

nsol

e

Billi

ng

Call

Acco

unti

ng

Call

Cont

rol-R

outi

ng

Call/

Cont

act

Cent

er

Conf

eren

cing

Com

mun

icat

ions

Con

tinu

ity

Corp

orat

e H

otel

ing

CRM

Cust

om A

pplic

atio

n D

evel

opm

ent

Dat

a Re

port

ing/

War

ehou

sing

Fax

Serv

er

Hel

p D

esk

Infr

astr

uctu

re

Infr

astr

uctu

re M

anag

emen

t

Man

aged

Ser

vice

s

Mes

sagi

ng

Mob

ility

Mul

ti-m

edia

Con

tact

Cen

ter

Mul

ti-v

endo

r In

tegr

atio

n

Prop

erty

Man

agem

ent

Qua

lity

Mon

itor

ing/

Man

agem

ent

Reco

rdin

g Vo

ice-

Dig

ital

Scre

en P

op

SIP

Endp

oint

s

SIP

Trun

ks

Secu

rity

Spee

ch R

ecog

niti

on

Serv

ice

Prov

ider

Acc

ess

Trun

king

Uni

fied

Com

mun

icat

ions

/fax

ser

vers

Uni

fied

Mes

sagi

ng

Voic

e M

ail-U

nifie

d M

assa

ging

Wal

l Boa

rds

Wor

kfor

ce M

anag

emen

t

Bank

ing

Fina

nce

Gov

ernm

ent-

Fede

ral

Gov

ernm

ent-

Stat

e &

Loc

al

Hea

lthc

are

Hig

her

Educ

atio

n

Hos

pita

lity

Insu

ranc

e

Lega

l

Man

ufac

turi

ng

Reta

il

Tele

com

mun

icat

ions

Tran

spor

tati

on

Uti

litie

s

√ √

√ √

Cablevision Optimum Voice SIP Trunking Optimum Voice SIP Trunking provides PSTN access via a SIP trunk between the enterprise and the Cablevision cable network as an alternative to legacy analog or digital trunks. This approach generally results in lower cost for the enterprise.

For technical support on Optimum Voice SIP Trunking, contact Cablevision

using the Customer Service links at www.optimumbusiness.com

IP Office to Cisco Unified Communications Manager SIP Trunk Configuring a SIP trunk between Avaya IP Office Releaee 6 and Cisco Unified Communications Manager (CUCM) release 7.1(5).Empix evolve Presence Server and Empix evolve xtphone Client with Avaya IP Office Empix evolve Presence Server is a workgroup coordination program which provides presence information for group members and distributes telephone control among group members.

Empix evolve srl +39 0733 866 [email protected]

http://www.empixevolve.com

Empix evolve Fax Server with Avaya IP Office Empix evolve Fax Server allows PC clients to send and receive Fax messages, each client with its own Fax number.

Empix evolve srl+39 0733 866 870

[email protected]://www.empixevolve.com

AdvaTel InTouch with Avaya IP Office 6.0 InTouch is an add-in application for Microsoft Office Outlook which runs on the user's Windows-based PC and integrates IP Office call management and control with Outlook, MSN, Yahoo! and Skype. It enables the user to optimize communications by providing consolidated presence information and by presenting a variety of communication options such as voice, email, Short Message Service (SMS) and instant messaging.

Phone: +61 3 86958695Web: http://www.advatel.com.au/Email: [email protected]

Algo 8180 SIP Audio Alerter with Avaya IP Office Algo 8180 SIP Audio Alerter is a SIP-based device that can register with Avaya IP Office as two separate SIP endpoints, one for loud ringing and one for voice paging.

Phone: (877) 884-2546Web:

http://www.algosolutions.com/support/support.html

Email: [email protected] evolve Connect2 Server with Avaya IP Office Empix evolve Connect2 Server is a mobility enhancement program which provides the users of local IP Office extensions with the means to use their mobile handsets to make and receive calls via IP Office.

Empix evolve srl+39 0733 866 870

[email protected]://www.empixevolve.com

Empix evolve Skypetophone with Avaya IP Office Empix evolve Skypetophone is a Skype connectivity program which provides Skype access to local IP Office extensions, allowing them to make and receive calls from Skype endpoints.

Empix evolve srl+39 0733 866 870

[email protected] http://www.empixevolve.com

Skype SIP Service and Avaya IP OfficeThese Application Notes describe the steps to configure trunking using the Session Initiation Protocol (SIP) between the Skype SIP Service and Avaya IP Office. The Avaya solution consists of Avaya IP Office and various Telephones.

https://partner.avaya.com/ptlWeb/getfile?docID=MTAwMTE0MzI4

Yealink T-28 SIP Phones to interoperate with Avaya IP Office The Yealink T-28 is an executive SIP phone with an extra large LCD screen designed for the office environment. It supports six VoIP accounts and up to 16 programmable function keys providing many call features such as call hold, transfer, conference, call waiting etc. It has high definition (HD) voice quality and power over Ethernet (PoE).

Phone: + 44-161-763-2023E-mail: [email protected]: http://www.yealink.co.uk

Yealink T-26 SIP Phones to interoperate with Avaya IP Office The Yealink T-26 is an advanced SIP phone with an extra large LCD screen designed for the office environment. It supports three VoIP accounts and up to thirteen programmable function keys providing many call features such as call hold, transfer, conference, call waiting etc. It has high definition (HD) voice quality and power over Ethernet (PoE). It supports up to six expansion modules.

Phone: + 44-161-763-2023E-mail: [email protected]: http://www.yealink.co.uk

Yealink T-22 SIP Phones to interoperate with Avaya IP Office The Yealink T-22 is a standard office IP phone, with a large LCD screen, suitable for small and large office environments. It supports three SIP accounts each with a stand-alone configuration. It has three programmable function keys and four soft keys and XML Phonebook. It has high definition (HD) voice quality and power over Ethernet (PoE).

Phone: + 44-161-763-2023E-mail: [email protected]: http://www.yealink.co.uk

43. IP Office DevConnect

document.xls Page 270

Application Overview DevConnect Partner Country

Solution Industry

E911

Appl

icat

ion

Suit

e

Atte

ndan

t Co

nsol

e

Billi

ng

Call

Acco

unti

ng

Call

Cont

rol-R

outi

ng

Call/

Cont

act

Cent

er

Conf

eren

cing

Com

mun

icat

ions

Con

tinu

ity

Corp

orat

e H

otel

ing

CRM

Cust

om A

pplic

atio

n D

evel

opm

ent

Dat

a Re

port

ing/

War

ehou

sing

Fax

Serv

er

Hel

p D

esk

Infr

astr

uctu

re

Infr

astr

uctu

re M

anag

emen

t

Man

aged

Ser

vice

s

Mes

sagi

ng

Mob

ility

Mul

ti-m

edia

Con

tact

Cen

ter

Mul

ti-v

endo

r In

tegr

atio

n

Prop

erty

Man

agem

ent

Qua

lity

Mon

itor

ing/

Man

agem

ent

Reco

rdin

g Vo

ice-

Dig

ital

Scre

en P

op

SIP

Endp

oint

s

SIP

Trun

ks

Secu

rity

Spee

ch R

ecog

niti

on

Serv

ice

Prov

ider

Acc

ess

Trun

king

Uni

fied

Com

mun

icat

ions

/fax

ser

vers

Uni

fied

Mes

sagi

ng

Voic

e M

ail-U

nifie

d M

assa

ging

Wal

l Boa

rds

Wor

kfor

ce M

anag

emen

t

Bank

ing

Fina

nce

Gov

ernm

ent-

Fede

ral

Gov

ernm

ent-

Stat

e &

Loc

al

Hea

lthc

are

Hig

her

Educ

atio

n

Hos

pita

lity

Insu

ranc

e

Lega

l

Man

ufac

turi

ng

Reta

il

Tele

com

mun

icat

ions

Tran

spor

tati

on

Uti

litie

s

√ √

Yealink T-20 SIP Phones to interoperate with Avaya IP Office The Yealink T-20 is an entry-level SIP phone with a small LCD screen designed for environments in which basic business features are required. It supports two VoIP accounts with stand-alone configuration and five hard keys for controlling the various call functions. It has high definition (HD) voice quality and power over Ethernet (PoE) is optional.

Phone: + 44-161-763-2023E-mail: [email protected]: http://www.yealink.co.uk

Yealink T-18 SIP Phones to interoperate with Avaya IP Office The Yealink T-18 is a simple SIP phone which provides many basic features such as call hold, transfer, conference, call waiting etc. It also provides voicemail.

Phone: + 44-161-763-2023E-mail: [email protected]: http://www.yealink.co.uk

Configuring PAETEC Dynamic IP SIP Trunk Service using the BroadSoft Platform with Avaya IP Office and SIP Registration PAETEC Dynamic IP SIP Trunk Service provides PSTN access via a SIP trunk connected to the PAETEC Voice over Internet Protocol (VoIP) network as an alternative to legacy analog or digital trunks. This approach generally results in lower cost for the enterprise.

For technical support on the Dynamic IP SIP Trunk Service, contact PAETEC using the Customer Care links at www.paetec.com.

Configuring Altavox Communications SIP Trunking Service with Avaya IP Office using SIP Registration The Altavox Communications SIP Trunking service provides PSTN access to enterprise sitesconnected to the Altavox Communications network via a SIP trunk as an alternative to legacyanalog or digital trunks. This approach generally results in lower cost for the enterprise.

For technical support on Altavox Communications SIP Trunking service,

contact AltavoxCommunications using the contact and support links at http://www.altavox.net.

Configuring Citels Portico TVA with Avaya IP Office Portico TVATM SIP Handset Gateway is a network appliance that allows for digital telephones to register with IP Office as SIP endpoints. Emphasis of testing was placed on verifying the gateways ability to interoperate with Avaya IP Office and with Avaya 2400 Series digital telephones, while delivering SIP functionality to Avaya Meridian and NorStar telephones, and Siemens OptiPoint telephones.

Web: http://www.citel.com/Company/Contact.asp Telephone: 1-888-454-5828 (7/24 – without ticket); 1-206-957-6270 (7/24 –

with ticket)Email: [email protected]

Tidal Communications tNet Business VoIP with Avaya IP Office Tidal Communications tNet Business VoIP provides PSTN access via a SIP trunk connected to the Tidal Communications Voice Over Internet Protocol (VoIP) network as an alternative to legacy analog or digital trunks. This approach generally results in lower cost for the enterprise.

For technical support on tNet Business VoIP, contact Tidal Communications

using the contact and support links at www.tidalcom.com.

KnoahSoft Harmony with Avaya IP Office KnoahSoft Harmony can provide monitoring, recording, quality assurance, reporting, and analytic features for contact centers.

Phone: (650) 385-6795Email: [email protected]

Web: http://www.knoahsoft.com/support.html

Telecor VS-600 Staff Call Station with Avaya IP Office The VS-600 Staff Call Station is a device that seamlessly integrates all the functions of a traditional nurse call system, providing instant two-way speech between residents and staff. The device is essentially an analog speaker telephone, primarily for retirement/assisted living residents to call staff; with capabilities such as programmable multiple call destination points for initial and redirection of residents calls to staff.

Phone: 1-800-464-3274E-mail: [email protected]

Iristel SIP Trunking Service with Avaya IP Office The Iristel SIP Trunking service provides PSTN access via a SIP trunk connected to the Iristel Voice Over Internet Protocol (VoIP) network as an alternative to legacy analog or digital trunks.

For technical support on the Iristel SIP Trunking service, contact Iristel using

the contact and support links at www.iristel.com

Telephonetics IP Messaging Utility with Avaya IP Office Using External Music On Hold Telephonetics IP Messaging Utility provided customized and PC-based audio contents via the external Music On Hold interface for held calls in Avaya IP Office.

Telephonetics Inc.2841 Corporate WayMiramar, FL 33029

United StatesPhone: (800) 446-5366 x5995

FAX 954.556.5990 [email protected]

43. IP Office DevConnect

document.xls Page 271

Application Overview DevConnect Partner Country

Solution Industry

E911

Appl

icat

ion

Suit

e

Atte

ndan

t Co

nsol

e

Billi

ng

Call

Acco

unti

ng

Call

Cont

rol-R

outi

ng

Call/

Cont

act

Cent

er

Conf

eren

cing

Com

mun

icat

ions

Con

tinu

ity

Corp

orat

e H

otel

ing

CRM

Cust

om A

pplic

atio

n D

evel

opm

ent

Dat

a Re

port

ing/

War

ehou

sing

Fax

Serv

er

Hel

p D

esk

Infr

astr

uctu

re

Infr

astr

uctu

re M

anag

emen

t

Man

aged

Ser

vice

s

Mes

sagi

ng

Mob

ility

Mul

ti-m

edia

Con

tact

Cen

ter

Mul

ti-v

endo

r In

tegr

atio

n

Prop

erty

Man

agem

ent

Qua

lity

Mon

itor

ing/

Man

agem

ent

Reco

rdin

g Vo

ice-

Dig

ital

Scre

en P

op

SIP

Endp

oint

s

SIP

Trun

ks

Secu

rity

Spee

ch R

ecog

niti

on

Serv

ice

Prov

ider

Acc

ess

Trun

king

Uni

fied

Com

mun

icat

ions

/fax

ser

vers

Uni

fied

Mes

sagi

ng

Voic

e M

ail-U

nifie

d M

assa

ging

Wal

l Boa

rds

Wor

kfor

ce M

anag

emen

t

Bank

ing

Fina

nce

Gov

ernm

ent-

Fede

ral

Gov

ernm

ent-

Stat

e &

Loc

al

Hea

lthc

are

Hig

her

Educ

atio

n

Hos

pita

lity

Insu

ranc

e

Lega

l

Man

ufac

turi

ng

Reta

il

Tele

com

mun

icat

ions

Tran

spor

tati

on

Uti

litie

s

√ √

√ √

√ √ √

DuVoice 5.0 with Avaya IP Office DuVoice used the SIP User, TAPI and configuration web service interfaces from Avaya IP Office to provide automated attendant, voicemail, wake-up call, do not disturb, name and user profile template change, and room clean status indication features.

Phone: (425) 250-2393Email: [email protected]

Xarios Call Recorder on IP Office BRI Trunk This application note describes a Xarios Call Recorder operating with Avaya IP Office BRI trunks

Support is available via the distributor or direct from

http://www.xarios.com/support.Ascom wireless i75 VoWiFi Handset with Avaya IP Office a solution for supporting wireless interoperability betweenthe Ascom wireless i75 VoWiFi Handsets with Avaya IP Office in a converged Voice over IPand Data Network.Ascom wireless SIP handsets registered to the Avaya IP Office.

Ascom global technical support:Phone: +46 31 559450

Email: [email protected]

Configuring the Xarios Call Recorder Attached to an IP Office PRI Trunk This application note describes a Xarios Call Recorder doing call recording on IP Office PRI trunks.

Support is available via the distributor or direct from

http://www.xarios.com/support.

Configuring SIP Trunking between Metaswitch MetaSphere CFS and Avaya IP Office This application note describes the steps required to configure SIP trunking between a Metaswitch MetaSphere Call Feature Server (CFS) and an IP Office.

For technical support for Metaswitch, contact your Metaswitch Networks

support representative.

SIP Trunking between Comdasys Mobile Convergence Solution and IP Office Describes the steps for configuring trunking using the Session Initiation Protocol (SIP) between the Comdasys Mobile Convergence Solution and Avaya IP Office. Comdasys Mobile Convergence Solution allows GSM telephones with a wireless LAN interface to be assigned a telephone extension on Avaya IP Office.

Support is available via the Comdasys distributor network.

DuVoice with Avaya IP Office Describes the configuration steps required for the DuVoice hospitality messaging system and Avaya IP Office Release 6.0. Provides automated attendant, voicemail, wake-up call, do not disturb, name and user profile template change, room clean status indication, and 911 alerting features.

Phone: (425) 250-2393Email: [email protected]

Configuring SIP Trunking to Belgacom SIP Service These Application Notes describe the steps to configure trunking using the Session Initiation Protocol (SIP) between the Belgacom SIP Service and Avaya IP Office. The Avaya solution consists of Avaya IP Office and various IP Telephones.

Support is available at:http://www.belgacom.be/private/hbsres/

jsp/dynamic/homepage.jsp Prior registration is required, which can be

done athttp://www.belgacom.be/private/en/jsp/

dynamic/productCategory.jsp?dcrName=hbsres_cockpit

dvsAnalytics Encore with Avaya IP Office This application note describes the configuration steps required for dvsAnalytics Encore to interoperate with Avaya IP Office. dvsAnalytics Encore is a call recording solution.

Phone: (800) 910-4564Email: [email protected]

43. IP Office DevConnect

document.xls Page 272

Application Overview DevConnect Partner Country

Solution Industry

E911

Appl

icat

ion

Suit

e

Atte

ndan

t Co

nsol

e

Billi

ng

Call

Acco

unti

ng

Call

Cont

rol-R

outi

ng

Call/

Cont

act

Cent

er

Conf

eren

cing

Com

mun

icat

ions

Con

tinu

ity

Corp

orat

e H

otel

ing

CRM

Cust

om A

pplic

atio

n D

evel

opm

ent

Dat

a Re

port

ing/

War

ehou

sing

Fax

Serv

er

Hel

p D

esk

Infr

astr

uctu

re

Infr

astr

uctu

re M

anag

emen

t

Man

aged

Ser

vice

s

Mes

sagi

ng

Mob

ility

Mul

ti-m

edia

Con

tact

Cen

ter

Mul

ti-v

endo

r In

tegr

atio

n

Prop

erty

Man

agem

ent

Qua

lity

Mon

itor

ing/

Man

agem

ent

Reco

rdin

g Vo

ice-

Dig

ital

Scre

en P

op

SIP

Endp

oint

s

SIP

Trun

ks

Secu

rity

Spee

ch R

ecog

niti

on

Serv

ice

Prov

ider

Acc

ess

Trun

king

Uni

fied

Com

mun

icat

ions

/fax

ser

vers

Uni

fied

Mes

sagi

ng

Voic

e M

ail-U

nifie

d M

assa

ging

Wal

l Boa

rds

Wor

kfor

ce M

anag

emen

t

Bank

ing

Fina

nce

Gov

ernm

ent-

Fede

ral

Gov

ernm

ent-

Stat

e &

Loc

al

Hea

lthc

are

Hig

her

Educ

atio

n

Hos

pita

lity

Insu

ranc

e

Lega

l

Man

ufac

turi

ng

Reta

il

Tele

com

mun

icat

ions

Tran

spor

tati

on

Uti

litie

s

Configuring SIP Trunking between the COLT VoIP Access SIP Service and an Avaya IP Office Telephony Solution This application note describes the steps to configure trunking using the Session Initiation Protocol (SIP) between the COLT VoIP Access SIP Service and Avaya IP Office. The Avaya solution consists of Avaya IP Office, and various IP Telephones.

Austria(+43) 1 20 500 500

0800 880 990Belgium

(+32) 2 790 16 290800 50701Switzerland

(+41 ) 44 560 07200800 560 560

Denmark(+45) 70 27 35 59

France(+33) 1 70995600

0800 948 888Germany

(+49) 69 56606 31150800 855 4444

Ireland(+34) 9355 02568

1800 944040Italy

(+39) 0230 329 5500800 909 377Netherlands

(+31 ) 20 888 24330800 265 8023

Portugal(+351) 211 200 222

808 780 222Spain

(+34) 913 206018901 888400

Sweden(+46) 8781 8333

UK(+44) 203 140 2023

NET Tenor DX with Avaya IP Office Using ISDN PRI T1 QSIG These application notes describe the configuration steps required for NET Tenor DX to interoperate with Avaya IP Office. The NET Tenor DX is a VoIP gateway that supports ISDN PRI, H.323, and SIP protocols. The compliance testing focused on using the ISDN PRI T1 QSIG trunk interface between Avaya IP Office and NET Tenor DX.

Phone: (510) 574-4312Email: [email protected]

Web: http://www.net.com

Configuration procedures for the HP ProCurve switch to provide inline Power over Ethernet connectivity to Avaya IP telephones.ProCurve 2626-PWR Switch by HP Supporting Power over Ethernet with Avaya Communication Manager, Avaya IP Office, Avaya one-X Quick Edition G10 PSTN Gateway, Avaya AP-8 Access Point and Avaya IP Telephones

For technical support on HP products, consult the support pages at

http://www.hp.com/rnd

Configuring a Small to Medium Size Business VoIP and Data Network Solution Consisting of HP ProCurve Networking Switches and an Avaya Telephony Infrastructure using Avaya IP OfficeThis application note describes the configuration of a Voice over IP (VoIP) and data network solution using HP ProCurve Networking 2610 and 2520 Series Switches with an Avaya Telephony Infrastructure using Avaya IP Office. Emphasis was placed on verifying the prioritization of VoIP traffic and voice quality in a Multi-Site converged VoIP and Data network scenario.

For technical support on ProCurve products, consult the support

pages at: http://www.procurve.com/customer

care/support

44. AVAYA Useful Links

document.xls Page 273

Useful Avaya Links & E-mails

Site Link/E-MailThe following links require connection to the Internet!

These links are subject to change!

Avaya Home Page:Main Avaya home page http://www.avaya.com/

Avaya Support SiteFor documentation and software downloads http://support.avaya.com/IP Office Knowledge Base:For all IP Office Documentation http://marketingtools.avaya.com/knowledgebase/Avaya Business Partner Portal:Access to Avaya Business Enterprise Portal, SSO Login required!

http://partner.avaya.com

Avaya eBusiness Tools Registration Info:Access to a web-based tool that will provide you with the ability to configure an IPO. EC Voice Configuration Tool SSO Login required and registration!

How to Register for EC Business Tools

Avaya eBusiness Tools:Access to a web-based tool that will provide you with the ability to configure an IPO. EC Voice Configuration Tool SSO Login required!

https://app8.avaya.com/ec/ecportal.asp

IP Office Demo Request Link:Thank you for your interest in Avaya Small-Medium Enterprise solutions. To request a demonstration of our IP Office solution, please complete the fields (at the link) as completely as possible. The information you share with u

IP Office Demo Request

Avaya Partner Marketing Central:Web-based tool that will provide you with easy access to marketing materials and customizable templates today. SSO Login required!

https://pmc.avaya.com/ui/home.aspx

Avaya DevConnect site:Main page for the Avaya DevConnect program developer and partner program. Access IP Office SDKs, API documentation and other developer oriented resources. Locate solution partners and compliance test Application Notes. and White Pa

www.avaya.com/devconnect

SMB Product Matrices:• IP Office Matrix• PRTNER ACS Matrix

Page down to bottom of page!

http://portal.avaya.com/ptlWeb/spCP/CS2004121417415743009

Magic on Hold BP site:You'll find one place to view and download all of the PDF equipment brochures, manuals, as well as general brochures for end users and dealers.

http://www.magic-on-hold.com/avaya/

Avaya UPS Sizing Tool:Site to assist with designing UPS systems. http://powerquality.eaton.com/AVAYA/Default.asp

Avaya Paging Solutions Site:Main site for Avaya Paging Solution Brochures and Documentation.

http://www.paging-solutions.com/

Avaya Paging Wiring Diagram Builder Site:The Wiring Diagram Builder is designed so that if you select an invalid configuration it should let you know. But it's not perfect, so be nice.

Paging Wiring Diagram Builder

Avaya Headset Selector Wizard: (Plantronics)Main page for Avaya Headset information. http://www.plantronics.com/us/compatibility-guide/phone-details.jsp?_requestid=165048

Avaya University:Access to Avaya University training home page. http://www.avaya-learning.com/SMB Marketing IP Office Soft Phone Trial:To request an IP Office Soft Phone trial. Once approved by Marketing, the BP will to sent the appropriate software CD and policy files to install on their Customer's PC/Laptop. This is only to assist in closing

https://partner.avaya.com/ptlWeb/getfile?docID=MDAzOTUwNjY0

Avaya ATAC Pre-Sales Support Registration Form:Individuals, who work for Avaya Authorized Business Partners, need to be registered with the ATAC to receive Hotline and e-mail Pre-Sales technical support. This link will take you to the registration form.

https://atac.avaya.com/BP_Reg.asp

Proposal Tools and SupportIf you're an Avaya or channel partner sales team member who's received an RFP/RFI/RFQ, and you're looking for assistance and/or direction in answering it. You've come to the right place! Links to the following support forms, inf

Avaya Proposal Tools and Support